]> git.ipfire.org Git - thirdparty/binutils-gdb.git/blame - ld/ld.texi
Also support '^=' in linker script expressions
[thirdparty/binutils-gdb.git] / ld / ld.texi
CommitLineData
252b5132
RH
1\input texinfo
2@setfilename ld.info
d87bef3a 3@c Copyright (C) 1991-2023 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
252b5132 4@syncodeindex ky cp
dff70155 5@c man begin INCLUDE
252b5132
RH
6@include configdoc.texi
7@c (configdoc.texi is generated by the Makefile)
c428fa83 8@include bfdver.texi
dff70155 9@c man end
252b5132
RH
10
11@c @smallbook
12
ff5dcc92
SC
13@macro gcctabopt{body}
14@code{\body\}
15@end macro
16
0285c67d
NC
17@c man begin NAME
18@ifset man
19@c Configure for the generation of man pages
20@set UsesEnvVars
21@set GENERIC
0285c67d 22@set ARM
ac145307 23@set C6X
b8891f8d 24@set CSKY
49fa1e15 25@set H8300
0285c67d 26@set HPPA
0285c67d 27@set M68HC11
7fb9f789 28@set M68K
833794fc 29@set MIPS
3c3bdf30 30@set MMIX
2469cfa2 31@set MSP430
35c08157 32@set NDS32
78058a5e 33@set NIOSII
fa1477dc 34@set PDP11
2a60a7a8
AM
35@set POWERPC
36@set POWERPC64
49fa1e15 37@set Renesas
b4cbbe8f 38@set S/390
49fa1e15
AM
39@set SPU
40@set TICOFF
2ca22b03 41@set WIN32
e0001a05 42@set XTENSA
0285c67d
NC
43@end ifset
44@c man end
45
9160ea82
AM
46@ifnottex
47@dircategory Software development
48@direntry
252b5132 49* Ld: (ld). The GNU linker.
9160ea82
AM
50@end direntry
51@end ifnottex
252b5132 52
0e9517a9 53@copying
e49e529d
JM
54This file documents the @sc{gnu} linker LD
55@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
56@value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
57@end ifset
58version @value{VERSION}.
252b5132 59
d87bef3a 60Copyright @copyright{} 1991-2023 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
252b5132 61
cf055d54 62Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
793c5807 63under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3
cf055d54
NC
64or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation;
65with no Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no
66Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the license is included in the
36f63dca 67section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
0e9517a9 68@end copying
252b5132
RH
69@iftex
70@finalout
71@setchapternewpage odd
71ba23f6 72@settitle The GNU linker
252b5132 73@titlepage
71ba23f6 74@title The GNU linker
252b5132 75@sp 1
e49e529d
JM
76@subtitle @code{ld}
77@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
78@subtitle @value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
79@end ifset
252b5132
RH
80@subtitle Version @value{VERSION}
81@author Steve Chamberlain
82@author Ian Lance Taylor
252b5132
RH
83@page
84
85@tex
86{\parskip=0pt
704c465c 87\hfill Red Hat Inc\par
3ac23310 88\hfill nickc\@redhat.com, doc\@redhat.com\par
71ba23f6 89\hfill {\it The GNU linker}\par
252b5132
RH
90\hfill Edited by Jeffrey Osier (jeffrey\@cygnus.com)\par
91}
92\global\parindent=0pt % Steve likes it this way.
93@end tex
94
95@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
0285c67d 96@c man begin COPYRIGHT
d87bef3a 97Copyright @copyright{} 1991-2023 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
252b5132 98
0285c67d 99Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
793c5807 100under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.3
0285c67d
NC
101or any later version published by the Free Software Foundation;
102with no Invariant Sections, with no Front-Cover Texts, and with no
103Back-Cover Texts. A copy of the license is included in the
36f63dca 104section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
0285c67d 105@c man end
252b5132 106
252b5132
RH
107@end titlepage
108@end iftex
4ecceb71 109@contents
252b5132
RH
110@c FIXME: Talk about importance of *order* of args, cmds to linker!
111
84ec0e6d 112@ifnottex
252b5132 113@node Top
71ba23f6 114@top LD
e49e529d
JM
115This file documents the @sc{gnu} linker ld
116@ifset VERSION_PACKAGE
117@value{VERSION_PACKAGE}
118@end ifset
119version @value{VERSION}.
252b5132 120
cf055d54 121This document is distributed under the terms of the GNU Free
793c5807
NC
122Documentation License version 1.3. A copy of the license is included
123in the section entitled ``GNU Free Documentation License''.
cf055d54 124
252b5132
RH
125@menu
126* Overview:: Overview
127* Invocation:: Invocation
128* Scripts:: Linker Scripts
bf6d8037 129* Plugins:: Linker Plugins
252b5132
RH
130@ifset GENERIC
131* Machine Dependent:: Machine Dependent Features
132@end ifset
133@ifclear GENERIC
134@ifset H8300
135* H8/300:: ld and the H8/300
136@end ifset
c2dcd04e
NC
137@ifset Renesas
138* Renesas:: ld and other Renesas micros
252b5132 139@end ifset
36f63dca
NC
140@ifset ARM
141* ARM:: ld and the ARM family
142@end ifset
93fd0973
SC
143@ifset M68HC11
144* M68HC11/68HC12:: ld and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
145@end ifset
7ca01ed9
NC
146@ifset HPPA
147* HPPA ELF32:: ld and HPPA 32-bit ELF
148@end ifset
7fb9f789
NC
149@ifset M68K
150* M68K:: ld and Motorola 68K family
151@end ifset
833794fc
MR
152@ifset MIPS
153* MIPS:: ld and MIPS family
154@end ifset
2a60a7a8
AM
155@ifset POWERPC
156* PowerPC ELF32:: ld and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
157@end ifset
158@ifset POWERPC64
159* PowerPC64 ELF64:: ld and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
160@end ifset
b4cbbe8f
AK
161@ifset S/390
162* S/390 ELF:: ld and S/390 ELF Support
163@end ifset
49fa1e15
AM
164@ifset SPU
165* SPU ELF:: ld and SPU ELF Support
166@end ifset
74459f0e
TW
167@ifset TICOFF
168* TI COFF:: ld and the TI COFF
169@end ifset
2ca22b03
NC
170@ifset WIN32
171* Win32:: ld and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
172@end ifset
e0001a05
NC
173@ifset XTENSA
174* Xtensa:: ld and Xtensa Processors
175@end ifset
252b5132
RH
176@end ifclear
177@ifclear SingleFormat
178* BFD:: BFD
179@end ifclear
180@c Following blank line required for remaining bug in makeinfo conds/menus
181
182* Reporting Bugs:: Reporting Bugs
183* MRI:: MRI Compatible Script Files
704c465c 184* GNU Free Documentation License:: GNU Free Documentation License
370b66a1 185* LD Index:: LD Index
252b5132 186@end menu
84ec0e6d 187@end ifnottex
252b5132
RH
188
189@node Overview
190@chapter Overview
191
192@cindex @sc{gnu} linker
193@cindex what is this?
0285c67d 194
0879a67a 195@ifset man
0285c67d 196@c man begin SYNOPSIS
ff5dcc92 197ld [@b{options}] @var{objfile} @dots{}
0285c67d
NC
198@c man end
199
200@c man begin SEEALSO
201ar(1), nm(1), objcopy(1), objdump(1), readelf(1) and
202the Info entries for @file{binutils} and
203@file{ld}.
204@c man end
205@end ifset
206
207@c man begin DESCRIPTION
208
ff5dcc92 209@command{ld} combines a number of object and archive files, relocates
252b5132 210their data and ties up symbol references. Usually the last step in
ff5dcc92 211compiling a program is to run @command{ld}.
252b5132 212
ff5dcc92 213@command{ld} accepts Linker Command Language files written in
252b5132
RH
214a superset of AT&T's Link Editor Command Language syntax,
215to provide explicit and total control over the linking process.
216
0285c67d
NC
217@ifset man
218@c For the man only
ece2d90e 219This man page does not describe the command language; see the
71ba23f6
NC
220@command{ld} entry in @code{info} for full details on the command
221language and on other aspects of the GNU linker.
0285c67d
NC
222@end ifset
223
252b5132 224@ifclear SingleFormat
ff5dcc92
SC
225This version of @command{ld} uses the general purpose BFD libraries
226to operate on object files. This allows @command{ld} to read, combine, and
252b5132
RH
227write object files in many different formats---for example, COFF or
228@code{a.out}. Different formats may be linked together to produce any
229available kind of object file. @xref{BFD}, for more information.
230@end ifclear
231
232Aside from its flexibility, the @sc{gnu} linker is more helpful than other
233linkers in providing diagnostic information. Many linkers abandon
234execution immediately upon encountering an error; whenever possible,
ff5dcc92 235@command{ld} continues executing, allowing you to identify other errors
252b5132
RH
236(or, in some cases, to get an output file in spite of the error).
237
0285c67d
NC
238@c man end
239
252b5132
RH
240@node Invocation
241@chapter Invocation
242
0285c67d
NC
243@c man begin DESCRIPTION
244
ff5dcc92 245The @sc{gnu} linker @command{ld} is meant to cover a broad range of situations,
252b5132
RH
246and to be as compatible as possible with other linkers. As a result,
247you have many choices to control its behavior.
248
0285c67d
NC
249@c man end
250
252b5132
RH
251@ifset UsesEnvVars
252@menu
a05a5b64 253* Options:: Command-line Options
252b5132
RH
254* Environment:: Environment Variables
255@end menu
256
257@node Options
a05a5b64 258@section Command-line Options
252b5132
RH
259@end ifset
260
261@cindex command line
262@cindex options
0285c67d
NC
263
264@c man begin OPTIONS
265
252b5132
RH
266The linker supports a plethora of command-line options, but in actual
267practice few of them are used in any particular context.
268@cindex standard Unix system
ff5dcc92 269For instance, a frequent use of @command{ld} is to link standard Unix
252b5132
RH
270object files on a standard, supported Unix system. On such a system, to
271link a file @code{hello.o}:
272
273@smallexample
274ld -o @var{output} /lib/crt0.o hello.o -lc
275@end smallexample
276
ff5dcc92 277This tells @command{ld} to produce a file called @var{output} as the
252b5132
RH
278result of linking the file @code{/lib/crt0.o} with @code{hello.o} and
279the library @code{libc.a}, which will come from the standard search
280directories. (See the discussion of the @samp{-l} option below.)
281
ff5dcc92 282Some of the command-line options to @command{ld} may be specified at any
511ab9e9
ILT
283point in the command line. However, options which refer to files, such
284as @samp{-l} or @samp{-T}, cause the file to be read at the point at
285which the option appears in the command line, relative to the object
286files and other file options. Repeating non-file options with a
287different argument will either have no further effect, or override prior
252b5132
RH
288occurrences (those further to the left on the command line) of that
289option. Options which may be meaningfully specified more than once are
290noted in the descriptions below.
291
292@cindex object files
511ab9e9
ILT
293Non-option arguments are object files or archives which are to be linked
294together. They may follow, precede, or be mixed in with command-line
295options, except that an object file argument may not be placed between
296an option and its argument.
252b5132
RH
297
298Usually the linker is invoked with at least one object file, but you can
299specify other forms of binary input files using @samp{-l}, @samp{-R},
300and the script command language. If @emph{no} binary input files at all
301are specified, the linker does not produce any output, and issues the
302message @samp{No input files}.
303
36f63dca 304If the linker cannot recognize the format of an object file, it will
252b5132
RH
305assume that it is a linker script. A script specified in this way
306augments the main linker script used for the link (either the default
307linker script or the one specified by using @samp{-T}). This feature
308permits the linker to link against a file which appears to be an object
309or an archive, but actually merely defines some symbol values, or uses
53d25da6
AM
310@code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP} to load other objects. Specifying a
311script in this way merely augments the main linker script, with the
312extra commands placed after the main script; use the @samp{-T} option
313to replace the default linker script entirely, but note the effect of
314the @code{INSERT} command. @xref{Scripts}.
252b5132
RH
315
316For options whose names are a single letter,
317option arguments must either follow the option letter without intervening
318whitespace, or be given as separate arguments immediately following the
319option that requires them.
320
321For options whose names are multiple letters, either one dash or two can
e4897a32 322precede the option name; for example, @samp{-trace-symbol} and
36f63dca 323@samp{--trace-symbol} are equivalent. Note---there is one exception to
e4897a32 324this rule. Multiple letter options that start with a lower case 'o' can
ba1be17e 325only be preceded by two dashes. This is to reduce confusion with the
e4897a32
NC
326@samp{-o} option. So for example @samp{-omagic} sets the output file
327name to @samp{magic} whereas @samp{--omagic} sets the NMAGIC flag on the
328output.
329
330Arguments to multiple-letter options must either be separated from the
331option name by an equals sign, or be given as separate arguments
332immediately following the option that requires them. For example,
333@samp{--trace-symbol foo} and @samp{--trace-symbol=foo} are equivalent.
334Unique abbreviations of the names of multiple-letter options are
335accepted.
252b5132 336
36f63dca 337Note---if the linker is being invoked indirectly, via a compiler driver
a05a5b64 338(e.g. @samp{gcc}) then all the linker command-line options should be
fa19fce0
NC
339prefixed by @samp{-Wl,} (or whatever is appropriate for the particular
340compiler driver) like this:
4e53152f
NC
341
342@smallexample
2509a395 343 gcc -Wl,--start-group foo.o bar.o -Wl,--end-group
4e53152f
NC
344@end smallexample
345
346This is important, because otherwise the compiler driver program may
2509a395
SL
347silently drop the linker options, resulting in a bad link. Confusion
348may also arise when passing options that require values through a
349driver, as the use of a space between option and argument acts as
350a separator, and causes the driver to pass only the option to the linker
351and the argument to the compiler. In this case, it is simplest to use
352the joined forms of both single- and multiple-letter options, such as:
353
354@smallexample
355 gcc foo.o bar.o -Wl,-eENTRY -Wl,-Map=a.map
356@end smallexample
4e53152f 357
a05a5b64 358Here is a table of the generic command-line switches accepted by the GNU
4e53152f
NC
359linker:
360
ff5dcc92 361@table @gcctabopt
38fc1cb1 362@include at-file.texi
dff70155 363
2509a395
SL
364@kindex -a @var{keyword}
365@item -a @var{keyword}
252b5132
RH
366This option is supported for HP/UX compatibility. The @var{keyword}
367argument must be one of the strings @samp{archive}, @samp{shared}, or
368@samp{default}. @samp{-aarchive} is functionally equivalent to
369@samp{-Bstatic}, and the other two keywords are functionally equivalent
370to @samp{-Bdynamic}. This option may be used any number of times.
371
7ee314fa
AM
372@kindex --audit @var{AUDITLIB}
373@item --audit @var{AUDITLIB}
374Adds @var{AUDITLIB} to the @code{DT_AUDIT} entry of the dynamic section.
375@var{AUDITLIB} is not checked for existence, nor will it use the DT_SONAME
376specified in the library. If specified multiple times @code{DT_AUDIT}
377will contain a colon separated list of audit interfaces to use. If the linker
378finds an object with an audit entry while searching for shared libraries,
9d5777a3 379it will add a corresponding @code{DT_DEPAUDIT} entry in the output file.
7ee314fa 380This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms supporting the rtld-audit
9d5777a3 381interface.
7ee314fa 382
252b5132
RH
383@ifclear SingleFormat
384@cindex binary input format
385@kindex -b @var{format}
386@kindex --format=@var{format}
387@cindex input format
388@cindex input format
389@item -b @var{input-format}
390@itemx --format=@var{input-format}
ff5dcc92
SC
391@command{ld} may be configured to support more than one kind of object
392file. If your @command{ld} is configured this way, you can use the
252b5132 393@samp{-b} option to specify the binary format for input object files
ff5dcc92 394that follow this option on the command line. Even when @command{ld} is
252b5132 395configured to support alternative object formats, you don't usually need
ff5dcc92 396to specify this, as @command{ld} should be configured to expect as a
252b5132
RH
397default input format the most usual format on each machine.
398@var{input-format} is a text string, the name of a particular format
399supported by the BFD libraries. (You can list the available binary
400formats with @samp{objdump -i}.)
401@xref{BFD}.
402
403You may want to use this option if you are linking files with an unusual
404binary format. You can also use @samp{-b} to switch formats explicitly (when
405linking object files of different formats), by including
406@samp{-b @var{input-format}} before each group of object files in a
a1ab1d2a 407particular format.
252b5132
RH
408
409The default format is taken from the environment variable
410@code{GNUTARGET}.
411@ifset UsesEnvVars
412@xref{Environment}.
413@end ifset
414You can also define the input format from a script, using the command
0285c67d
NC
415@code{TARGET};
416@ifclear man
417see @ref{Format Commands}.
418@end ifclear
252b5132
RH
419@end ifclear
420
421@kindex -c @var{MRI-cmdfile}
422@kindex --mri-script=@var{MRI-cmdfile}
423@cindex compatibility, MRI
424@item -c @var{MRI-commandfile}
425@itemx --mri-script=@var{MRI-commandfile}
ff5dcc92 426For compatibility with linkers produced by MRI, @command{ld} accepts script
252b5132 427files written in an alternate, restricted command language, described in
0285c67d
NC
428@ifclear man
429@ref{MRI,,MRI Compatible Script Files}.
430@end ifclear
431@ifset man
432the MRI Compatible Script Files section of GNU ld documentation.
433@end ifset
434Introduce MRI script files with
252b5132 435the option @samp{-c}; use the @samp{-T} option to run linker
ff5dcc92
SC
436scripts written in the general-purpose @command{ld} scripting language.
437If @var{MRI-cmdfile} does not exist, @command{ld} looks for it in the directories
252b5132
RH
438specified by any @samp{-L} options.
439
440@cindex common allocation
441@kindex -d
442@kindex -dc
443@kindex -dp
a1ab1d2a 444@item -d
252b5132
RH
445@itemx -dc
446@itemx -dp
447These three options are equivalent; multiple forms are supported for
448compatibility with other linkers. They assign space to common symbols
449even if a relocatable output file is specified (with @samp{-r}). The
450script command @code{FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION} has the same effect.
451@xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
452
7ee314fa
AM
453@kindex --depaudit @var{AUDITLIB}
454@kindex -P @var{AUDITLIB}
455@item --depaudit @var{AUDITLIB}
456@itemx -P @var{AUDITLIB}
457Adds @var{AUDITLIB} to the @code{DT_DEPAUDIT} entry of the dynamic section.
458@var{AUDITLIB} is not checked for existence, nor will it use the DT_SONAME
459specified in the library. If specified multiple times @code{DT_DEPAUDIT}
460will contain a colon separated list of audit interfaces to use. This
461option is only meaningful on ELF platforms supporting the rtld-audit interface.
9d5777a3 462The -P option is provided for Solaris compatibility.
7ee314fa 463
2d5783fa
NC
464@kindex --enable-linker-version
465@item --enable-linker-version
466Enables the @code{LINKER_VERSION} linker script directive, described
467in @ref{Output Section Data}. If this directive is used in a linker
468script and this option has been enabled then a string containing the
469linker version will be inserted at the current point.
470
471Note - this location of this option on the linker command line is
472significant. It will only affect linker scripts that come after it on
473the command line, or which are built into the linker.
474
475@kindex --disable-linker-version
476@item --disable-linker-version
477Disables the @code{LINKER_VERSION} linker script directive, so that it
478does not insert a version string. This is the default.
479
abf874aa
CL
480@kindex --enable-non-contiguous-regions
481@item --enable-non-contiguous-regions
482This option avoids generating an error if an input section does not
483fit a matching output section. The linker tries to allocate the input
484section to subseque nt matching output sections, and generates an
485error only if no output section is large enough. This is useful when
486several non-contiguous memory regions are available and the input
487section does not require a particular one. The order in which input
488sections are evaluated does not change, for instance:
489
490@smallexample
491 MEMORY @{
93cda40b
NC
492 MEM1 (rwx) : ORIGIN = 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x14
493 MEM2 (rwx) : ORIGIN = 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x40
494 MEM3 (rwx) : ORIGIN = 0x2000, LENGTH = 0x40
abf874aa
CL
495 @}
496 SECTIONS @{
497 mem1 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM1
498 mem2 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM2
94ffdb59 499 mem3 : @{ *(.data.*); @} > MEM3
abf874aa
CL
500 @}
501
502 with input sections:
503 .data.1: size 8
504 .data.2: size 0x10
505 .data.3: size 4
506
507 results in .data.1 affected to mem1, and .data.2 and .data.3
508 affected to mem2, even though .data.3 would fit in mem3.
509@end smallexample
510
511This option is incompatible with INSERT statements because it changes
512the way input sections are mapped to output sections.
513
514@kindex --enable-non-contiguous-regions-warnings
515@item --enable-non-contiguous-regions-warnings
516This option enables warnings when
517@code{--enable-non-contiguous-regions} allows possibly unexpected
518matches in sections mapping, potentially leading to silently
519discarding a section instead of failing because it does not fit any
520output region.
521
252b5132
RH
522@cindex entry point, from command line
523@kindex -e @var{entry}
524@kindex --entry=@var{entry}
a1ab1d2a 525@item -e @var{entry}
252b5132
RH
526@itemx --entry=@var{entry}
527Use @var{entry} as the explicit symbol for beginning execution of your
528program, rather than the default entry point. If there is no symbol
529named @var{entry}, the linker will try to parse @var{entry} as a number,
530and use that as the entry address (the number will be interpreted in
531base 10; you may use a leading @samp{0x} for base 16, or a leading
532@samp{0} for base 8). @xref{Entry Point}, for a discussion of defaults
533and other ways of specifying the entry point.
534
b58f81ae
DJ
535@kindex --exclude-libs
536@item --exclude-libs @var{lib},@var{lib},...
537Specifies a list of archive libraries from which symbols should not be automatically
e1c37eb5 538exported. The library names may be delimited by commas or colons. Specifying
b58f81ae
DJ
539@code{--exclude-libs ALL} excludes symbols in all archive libraries from
540automatic export. This option is available only for the i386 PE targeted
541port of the linker and for ELF targeted ports. For i386 PE, symbols
542explicitly listed in a .def file are still exported, regardless of this
543option. For ELF targeted ports, symbols affected by this option will
544be treated as hidden.
545
e1c37eb5
DK
546@kindex --exclude-modules-for-implib
547@item --exclude-modules-for-implib @var{module},@var{module},...
548Specifies a list of object files or archive members, from which symbols
549should not be automatically exported, but which should be copied wholesale
550into the import library being generated during the link. The module names
551may be delimited by commas or colons, and must match exactly the filenames
552used by @command{ld} to open the files; for archive members, this is simply
553the member name, but for object files the name listed must include and
554match precisely any path used to specify the input file on the linker's
555command-line. This option is available only for the i386 PE targeted port
556of the linker. Symbols explicitly listed in a .def file are still exported,
557regardless of this option.
558
252b5132
RH
559@cindex dynamic symbol table
560@kindex -E
561@kindex --export-dynamic
267e2722 562@kindex --no-export-dynamic
252b5132
RH
563@item -E
564@itemx --export-dynamic
267e2722
CD
565@itemx --no-export-dynamic
566When creating a dynamically linked executable, using the @option{-E}
567option or the @option{--export-dynamic} option causes the linker to add
568all symbols to the dynamic symbol table. The dynamic symbol table is the
569set of symbols which are visible from dynamic objects at run time.
570
571If you do not use either of these options (or use the
572@option{--no-export-dynamic} option to restore the default behavior), the
573dynamic symbol table will normally contain only those symbols which are
574referenced by some dynamic object mentioned in the link.
252b5132
RH
575
576If you use @code{dlopen} to load a dynamic object which needs to refer
577back to the symbols defined by the program, rather than some other
578dynamic object, then you will probably need to use this option when
579linking the program itself.
580
55255dae 581You can also use the dynamic list to control what symbols should
cb840a31 582be added to the dynamic symbol table if the output format supports it.
55255dae 583See the description of @samp{--dynamic-list}.
cb840a31 584
8b747e1a
DK
585Note that this option is specific to ELF targeted ports. PE targets
586support a similar function to export all symbols from a DLL or EXE; see
587the description of @samp{--export-all-symbols} below.
588
37a141bf
FS
589@kindex --export-dynamic-symbol=@var{glob}
590@cindex export dynamic symbol
591@item --export-dynamic-symbol=@var{glob}
592When creating a dynamically linked executable, symbols matching
593@var{glob} will be added to the dynamic symbol table. When creating a
594shared library, references to symbols matching @var{glob} will not be
595bound to the definitions within the shared library. This option is a
596no-op when creating a shared library and @samp{-Bsymbolic} or
597@samp{--dynamic-list} are not specified. This option is only meaningful
598on ELF platforms which support shared libraries.
599
600@kindex --export-dynamic-symbol-list=@var{file}
601@cindex export dynamic symbol list
602@item --export-dynamic-symbol-list=@var{file}
603Specify a @samp{--export-dynamic-symbol} for each pattern in the file.
604The format of the file is the same as the version node without
605scope and node name. See @ref{VERSION} for more information.
606
36f63dca 607@ifclear SingleFormat
252b5132
RH
608@cindex big-endian objects
609@cindex endianness
610@kindex -EB
611@item -EB
612Link big-endian objects. This affects the default output format.
613
614@cindex little-endian objects
615@kindex -EL
616@item -EL
617Link little-endian objects. This affects the default output format.
36f63dca 618@end ifclear
252b5132 619
2509a395
SL
620@kindex -f @var{name}
621@kindex --auxiliary=@var{name}
622@item -f @var{name}
623@itemx --auxiliary=@var{name}
252b5132
RH
624When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_AUXILIARY field
625to the specified name. This tells the dynamic linker that the symbol
626table of the shared object should be used as an auxiliary filter on the
627symbol table of the shared object @var{name}.
628
629If you later link a program against this filter object, then, when you
630run the program, the dynamic linker will see the DT_AUXILIARY field. If
631the dynamic linker resolves any symbols from the filter object, it will
632first check whether there is a definition in the shared object
633@var{name}. If there is one, it will be used instead of the definition
634in the filter object. The shared object @var{name} need not exist.
635Thus the shared object @var{name} may be used to provide an alternative
636implementation of certain functions, perhaps for debugging or for
a094d01f 637machine-specific performance.
252b5132
RH
638
639This option may be specified more than once. The DT_AUXILIARY entries
640will be created in the order in which they appear on the command line.
641
2509a395
SL
642@kindex -F @var{name}
643@kindex --filter=@var{name}
252b5132 644@item -F @var{name}
2509a395 645@itemx --filter=@var{name}
252b5132
RH
646When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_FILTER field to
647the specified name. This tells the dynamic linker that the symbol table
648of the shared object which is being created should be used as a filter
649on the symbol table of the shared object @var{name}.
650
651If you later link a program against this filter object, then, when you
652run the program, the dynamic linker will see the DT_FILTER field. The
653dynamic linker will resolve symbols according to the symbol table of the
654filter object as usual, but it will actually link to the definitions
655found in the shared object @var{name}. Thus the filter object can be
656used to select a subset of the symbols provided by the object
657@var{name}.
658
ff5dcc92 659Some older linkers used the @option{-F} option throughout a compilation
252b5132 660toolchain for specifying object-file format for both input and output
36f63dca
NC
661object files.
662@ifclear SingleFormat
663The @sc{gnu} linker uses other mechanisms for this purpose: the
ece2d90e 664@option{-b}, @option{--format}, @option{--oformat} options, the
252b5132 665@code{TARGET} command in linker scripts, and the @code{GNUTARGET}
36f63dca
NC
666environment variable.
667@end ifclear
668The @sc{gnu} linker will ignore the @option{-F} option when not
669creating an ELF shared object.
252b5132 670
3dbf70a2 671@cindex finalization function
2509a395
SL
672@kindex -fini=@var{name}
673@item -fini=@var{name}
3dbf70a2
MM
674When creating an ELF executable or shared object, call NAME when the
675executable or shared object is unloaded, by setting DT_FINI to the
676address of the function. By default, the linker uses @code{_fini} as
677the function to call.
678
252b5132
RH
679@kindex -g
680@item -g
681Ignored. Provided for compatibility with other tools.
682
2509a395
SL
683@kindex -G @var{value}
684@kindex --gpsize=@var{value}
252b5132 685@cindex object size
2509a395 686@item -G @var{value}
252b5132
RH
687@itemx --gpsize=@var{value}
688Set the maximum size of objects to be optimized using the GP register to
689@var{size}. This is only meaningful for object file formats such as
e8044f35 690MIPS ELF that support putting large and small objects into different
252b5132
RH
691sections. This is ignored for other object file formats.
692
693@cindex runtime library name
2509a395 694@kindex -h @var{name}
252b5132 695@kindex -soname=@var{name}
2509a395 696@item -h @var{name}
252b5132
RH
697@itemx -soname=@var{name}
698When creating an ELF shared object, set the internal DT_SONAME field to
699the specified name. When an executable is linked with a shared object
700which has a DT_SONAME field, then when the executable is run the dynamic
701linker will attempt to load the shared object specified by the DT_SONAME
010e444b 702field rather than using the file name given to the linker.
252b5132
RH
703
704@kindex -i
705@cindex incremental link
706@item -i
707Perform an incremental link (same as option @samp{-r}).
708
3dbf70a2 709@cindex initialization function
2509a395
SL
710@kindex -init=@var{name}
711@item -init=@var{name}
3dbf70a2
MM
712When creating an ELF executable or shared object, call NAME when the
713executable or shared object is loaded, by setting DT_INIT to the address
714of the function. By default, the linker uses @code{_init} as the
715function to call.
716
252b5132 717@cindex archive files, from cmd line
2509a395 718@kindex -l @var{namespec}
bcb674cf 719@kindex --library=@var{namespec}
2509a395 720@item -l @var{namespec}
bcb674cf
RS
721@itemx --library=@var{namespec}
722Add the archive or object file specified by @var{namespec} to the
723list of files to link. This option may be used any number of times.
724If @var{namespec} is of the form @file{:@var{filename}}, @command{ld}
07d8eb55 725will search the library path for a file called @var{filename}, otherwise it
bcb674cf 726will search the library path for a file called @file{lib@var{namespec}.a}.
252b5132 727
ff5dcc92 728On systems which support shared libraries, @command{ld} may also search for
bcb674cf
RS
729files other than @file{lib@var{namespec}.a}. Specifically, on ELF
730and SunOS systems, @command{ld} will search a directory for a library
731called @file{lib@var{namespec}.so} before searching for one called
732@file{lib@var{namespec}.a}. (By convention, a @code{.so} extension
733indicates a shared library.) Note that this behavior does not apply
734to @file{:@var{filename}}, which always specifies a file called
735@var{filename}.
252b5132
RH
736
737The linker will search an archive only once, at the location where it is
738specified on the command line. If the archive defines a symbol which
739was undefined in some object which appeared before the archive on the
740command line, the linker will include the appropriate file(s) from the
741archive. However, an undefined symbol in an object appearing later on
742the command line will not cause the linker to search the archive again.
743
ff5dcc92 744See the @option{-(} option for a way to force the linker to search
252b5132
RH
745archives multiple times.
746
747You may list the same archive multiple times on the command line.
748
749@ifset GENERIC
750This type of archive searching is standard for Unix linkers. However,
ff5dcc92 751if you are using @command{ld} on AIX, note that it is different from the
252b5132
RH
752behaviour of the AIX linker.
753@end ifset
754
755@cindex search directory, from cmd line
2509a395 756@kindex -L @var{dir}
252b5132 757@kindex --library-path=@var{dir}
2509a395 758@item -L @var{searchdir}
252b5132 759@itemx --library-path=@var{searchdir}
ff5dcc92
SC
760Add path @var{searchdir} to the list of paths that @command{ld} will search
761for archive libraries and @command{ld} control scripts. You may use this
252b5132
RH
762option any number of times. The directories are searched in the order
763in which they are specified on the command line. Directories specified
764on the command line are searched before the default directories. All
ff5dcc92 765@option{-L} options apply to all @option{-l} options, regardless of the
7d24f02c
KH
766order in which the options appear. @option{-L} options do not affect
767how @command{ld} searches for a linker script unless @option{-T}
768option is specified.
252b5132 769
3aa2d05a
NC
770If @var{searchdir} begins with @code{=} or @code{$SYSROOT}, then this
771prefix will be replaced by the @dfn{sysroot prefix}, controlled by the
772@samp{--sysroot} option, or specified when the linker is configured.
9c8ebd6a 773
252b5132
RH
774@ifset UsesEnvVars
775The default set of paths searched (without being specified with
ff5dcc92 776@samp{-L}) depends on which emulation mode @command{ld} is using, and in
252b5132
RH
777some cases also on how it was configured. @xref{Environment}.
778@end ifset
779
780The paths can also be specified in a link script with the
781@code{SEARCH_DIR} command. Directories specified this way are searched
782at the point in which the linker script appears in the command line.
783
784@cindex emulation
785@kindex -m @var{emulation}
2509a395 786@item -m @var{emulation}
252b5132
RH
787Emulate the @var{emulation} linker. You can list the available
788emulations with the @samp{--verbose} or @samp{-V} options.
789
790If the @samp{-m} option is not used, the emulation is taken from the
791@code{LDEMULATION} environment variable, if that is defined.
792
793Otherwise, the default emulation depends upon how the linker was
794configured.
795
fb221fba
NC
796@cindex remapping inputs
797@kindex --remap-inputs=@file{pattern}=@file{filename}
798@kindex --remap-inputs-file=@file{file}
799@item --remap-inputs=@file{pattern}=@file{filename}
800@itemx --remap-inputs-file=@file{file}
801These options allow the names of input files to be changed before the
802linker attempts to open them. The option
803@option{--remap-inputs=foo.o=bar.o} will cause any attempt to load a
804file called @file{foo.o} to instead try to load a file called
805@file{bar.o}. Wildcard patterns are permitted in the first filename,
806so @option{--remap-inputs=foo*.o=bar.o} will rename any input file that
807matches @file{foo*.o} to @file{bar.o}.
808
809An alternative form of the option
810@option{--remap-inputs-file=filename} allows the remappings to be read
811from a file. Each line in the file can contain a single remapping.
812Blank lines are ignored. Anything from a hash character (@samp{#}) to
813the end of a line is considered to be a comment and is also ignored.
814The mapping pattern can be separated from the filename by whitespace
815or an equals (@samp{=}) character.
816
817The options can be specified multiple times. Their contents
818accumulate. The remappings will be processed in the order in which
819they occur on the command line, and if they come from a file, in the
820order in which they occur in the file. If a match is made, no further
821checking for that filename will be performed.
822
823If the replacement filename is @file{/dev/null} or just @file{NUL}
824then the remapping will actually cause the input file to be ignored.
825This can be a convenient way to experiment with removing input files
826from a complicated build environment.
827
828Note that this option is position dependent and only affects filenames
829that come after it on the command line. Thus:
830
831@smallexample
832 ld foo.o --remap-inputs=foo.o=bar.o
833@end smallexample
834
835Will have no effect, whereas:
836
837@smallexample
838 ld --remap-inputs=foo.o=bar.o foo.o
839@end smallexample
840
841Will rename the input file @file{foo.o} to @file{bar.o}.
842
843Note - these options also affect files referenced by @emph{INPUT}
844statements in linker scripts. But since linker scripts are processed
845after the entire command line is read, the position of the remap
846options on the command line is not significant.
847
848If the @option{verbose} option is enabled then any mappings that match
849will be reported, although again the @option{verbose} option needs to
850be enabled on the command line @emph{before} the remaped filenames
851appear.
852
853If the @option{-Map} or @option{--print-map} options are enabled then
854the remapping list will be included in the map output.
855
252b5132
RH
856@cindex link map
857@kindex -M
858@kindex --print-map
859@item -M
860@itemx --print-map
861Print a link map to the standard output. A link map provides
862information about the link, including the following:
863
864@itemize @bullet
865@item
3b83e13a 866Where object files are mapped into memory.
252b5132
RH
867@item
868How common symbols are allocated.
869@item
870All archive members included in the link, with a mention of the symbol
871which caused the archive member to be brought in.
3b83e13a
NC
872@item
873The values assigned to symbols.
874
875Note - symbols whose values are computed by an expression which
876involves a reference to a previous value of the same symbol may not
877have correct result displayed in the link map. This is because the
878linker discards intermediate results and only retains the final value
879of an expression. Under such circumstances the linker will display
880the final value enclosed by square brackets. Thus for example a
881linker script containing:
882
883@smallexample
884 foo = 1
885 foo = foo * 4
886 foo = foo + 8
887@end smallexample
888
889will produce the following output in the link map if the @option{-M}
890option is used:
891
892@smallexample
893 0x00000001 foo = 0x1
894 [0x0000000c] foo = (foo * 0x4)
895 [0x0000000c] foo = (foo + 0x8)
896@end smallexample
897
898See @ref{Expressions} for more information about expressions in linker
899scripts.
d2ef37eb 900
06ddcada
AM
901@item
902How GNU properties are merged.
d2ef37eb 903
06ddcada
AM
904When the linker merges input .note.gnu.property sections into one output
905.note.gnu.property section, some properties are removed or updated.
906These actions are reported in the link map. For example:
d2ef37eb
L
907
908@smallexample
909Removed property 0xc0000002 to merge foo.o (0x1) and bar.o (not found)
910@end smallexample
911
06ddcada 912This indicates that property 0xc0000002 is removed from output when
d2ef37eb
L
913merging properties in @file{foo.o}, whose property 0xc0000002 value
914is 0x1, and @file{bar.o}, which doesn't have property 0xc0000002.
915
916@smallexample
06ddcada 917Updated property 0xc0010001 (0x1) to merge foo.o (0x1) and bar.o (0x1)
d2ef37eb
L
918@end smallexample
919
06ddcada 920This indicates that property 0xc0010001 value is updated to 0x1 in output
d2ef37eb
L
921when merging properties in @file{foo.o}, whose 0xc0010001 property value
922is 0x1, and @file{bar.o}, whose 0xc0010001 property value is 0x1.
252b5132
RH
923@end itemize
924
035801ce
FS
925@cindex link map discarded
926@kindex --print-map-discarded
927@kindex --no-print-map-discarded
928@item --print-map-discarded
929@itemx --no-print-map-discarded
930Print (or do not print) the list of discarded and garbage collected sections
931in the link map. Enabled by default.
932
496917ce
NC
933@kindex --print-map-locals
934@kindex --no-print-map-locals
935@item --print-map-locals
936@itemx --no-print-map-locals
937Print (or do not print) local symbols in the link map. Local symbols
938will have the text @samp{(local)} printed before their name, and will
939be listed after all of the global symbols in a given section.
940Temporary local symbols (typically those that start with @samp{.L})
941will not be included in the output. Disabled by default.
942
252b5132
RH
943@kindex -n
944@cindex read-only text
945@cindex NMAGIC
946@kindex --nmagic
947@item -n
948@itemx --nmagic
90f5d9d9
JZ
949Turn off page alignment of sections, and disable linking against shared
950libraries. If the output format supports Unix style magic numbers,
951mark the output as @code{NMAGIC}.
252b5132
RH
952
953@kindex -N
954@kindex --omagic
955@cindex read/write from cmd line
956@cindex OMAGIC
a1ab1d2a 957@item -N
252b5132
RH
958@itemx --omagic
959Set the text and data sections to be readable and writable. Also, do
63fd3b82
NC
960not page-align the data segment, and disable linking against shared
961libraries. If the output format supports Unix style magic numbers,
4d8907ac
DS
962mark the output as @code{OMAGIC}. Note: Although a writable text section
963is allowed for PE-COFF targets, it does not conform to the format
964specification published by Microsoft.
63fd3b82
NC
965
966@kindex --no-omagic
967@cindex OMAGIC
968@item --no-omagic
969This option negates most of the effects of the @option{-N} option. It
970sets the text section to be read-only, and forces the data segment to
971be page-aligned. Note - this option does not enable linking against
972shared libraries. Use @option{-Bdynamic} for this.
252b5132
RH
973
974@kindex -o @var{output}
975@kindex --output=@var{output}
976@cindex naming the output file
977@item -o @var{output}
978@itemx --output=@var{output}
ff5dcc92 979Use @var{output} as the name for the program produced by @command{ld}; if this
252b5132
RH
980option is not specified, the name @file{a.out} is used by default. The
981script command @code{OUTPUT} can also specify the output file name.
982
f37b21b4
RM
983@kindex --dependency-file=@var{depfile}
984@cindex dependency file
985@item --dependency-file=@var{depfile}
986Write a @dfn{dependency file} to @var{depfile}. This file contains a rule
987suitable for @code{make} describing the output file and all the input files
988that were read to produce it. The output is similar to the compiler's
989output with @samp{-M -MP} (@pxref{Preprocessor Options,, Options
990Controlling the Preprocessor, gcc.info, Using the GNU Compiler
991Collection}). Note that there is no option like the compiler's @samp{-MM},
992to exclude ``system files'' (which is not a well-specified concept in the
993linker, unlike ``system headers'' in the compiler). So the output from
994@samp{--dependency-file} is always specific to the exact state of the
995installation where it was produced, and should not be copied into
996distributed makefiles without careful editing.
997
252b5132
RH
998@kindex -O @var{level}
999@cindex generating optimized output
1000@item -O @var{level}
ff5dcc92 1001If @var{level} is a numeric values greater than zero @command{ld} optimizes
252b5132 1002the output. This might take significantly longer and therefore probably
98c503ac
NC
1003should only be enabled for the final binary. At the moment this
1004option only affects ELF shared library generation. Future releases of
1005the linker may make more use of this option. Also currently there is
1006no difference in the linker's behaviour for different non-zero values
1007of this option. Again this may change with future releases.
252b5132 1008
387dd777
DP
1009@kindex -plugin @var{name}
1010@item -plugin @var{name}
1011Involve a plugin in the linking process. The @var{name} parameter is
1012the absolute filename of the plugin. Usually this parameter is
1013automatically added by the complier, when using link time
1014optimization, but users can also add their own plugins if they so
1015wish.
1016
1017Note that the location of the compiler originated plugins is different
1018from the place where the @command{ar}, @command{nm} and
1019@command{ranlib} programs search for their plugins. In order for
1020those commands to make use of a compiler based plugin it must first be
41f37a6f 1021copied into the @file{$@{libdir@}/bfd-plugins} directory. All gcc
387dd777 1022based linker plugins are backward compatible, so it is sufficient to
6c19b93b 1023just copy in the newest one.
387dd777 1024
26278bb8
UD
1025@kindex --push-state
1026@cindex push state governing input file handling
1027@item --push-state
f9a6a8f0 1028The @option{--push-state} allows one to preserve the current state of the
26278bb8
UD
1029flags which govern the input file handling so that they can all be
1030restored with one corresponding @option{--pop-state} option.
1031
1032The option which are covered are: @option{-Bdynamic}, @option{-Bstatic},
1033@option{-dn}, @option{-dy}, @option{-call_shared}, @option{-non_shared},
1034@option{-static}, @option{-N}, @option{-n}, @option{--whole-archive},
1035@option{--no-whole-archive}, @option{-r}, @option{-Ur},
1036@option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}, @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries},
1037@option{--as-needed}, @option{--no-as-needed}, and @option{-a}.
1038
1039One target for this option are specifications for @file{pkg-config}. When
1040used with the @option{--libs} option all possibly needed libraries are
1041listed and then possibly linked with all the time. It is better to return
1042something as follows:
1043
1044@smallexample
1045-Wl,--push-state,--as-needed -libone -libtwo -Wl,--pop-state
1046@end smallexample
1047
1048@kindex --pop-state
1049@cindex pop state governing input file handling
67cecaba 1050@item --pop-state
26278bb8
UD
1051Undoes the effect of --push-state, restores the previous values of the
1052flags governing input file handling.
1053
a712da20
NC
1054@kindex -q
1055@kindex --emit-relocs
1056@cindex retain relocations in final executable
1057@item -q
1058@itemx --emit-relocs
ba1be17e 1059Leave relocation sections and contents in fully linked executables.
a712da20
NC
1060Post link analysis and optimization tools may need this information in
1061order to perform correct modifications of executables. This results
1062in larger executables.
1063
dbab7a7b
NC
1064This option is currently only supported on ELF platforms.
1065
4f471f39
RS
1066@kindex --force-dynamic
1067@cindex forcing the creation of dynamic sections
1068@item --force-dynamic
1069Force the output file to have dynamic sections. This option is specific
1070to VxWorks targets.
1071
252b5132
RH
1072@cindex partial link
1073@cindex relocatable output
1074@kindex -r
1049f94e 1075@kindex --relocatable
252b5132 1076@item -r
1049f94e 1077@itemx --relocatable
252b5132 1078Generate relocatable output---i.e., generate an output file that can in
ff5dcc92 1079turn serve as input to @command{ld}. This is often called @dfn{partial
252b5132
RH
1080linking}. As a side effect, in environments that support standard Unix
1081magic numbers, this option also sets the output file's magic number to
1082@code{OMAGIC}.
ff5dcc92 1083@c ; see @option{-N}.
252b5132
RH
1084If this option is not specified, an absolute file is produced. When
1085linking C++ programs, this option @emph{will not} resolve references to
1086constructors; to do that, use @samp{-Ur}.
1087
62bf86b4
HPN
1088When an input file does not have the same format as the output file,
1089partial linking is only supported if that input file does not contain any
1090relocations. Different output formats can have further restrictions; for
1091example some @code{a.out}-based formats do not support partial linking
1092with input files in other formats at all.
1093
252b5132
RH
1094This option does the same thing as @samp{-i}.
1095
1096@kindex -R @var{file}
1097@kindex --just-symbols=@var{file}
1098@cindex symbol-only input
1099@item -R @var{filename}
1100@itemx --just-symbols=@var{filename}
1101Read symbol names and their addresses from @var{filename}, but do not
1102relocate it or include it in the output. This allows your output file
1103to refer symbolically to absolute locations of memory defined in other
1104programs. You may use this option more than once.
1105
ff5dcc92 1106For compatibility with other ELF linkers, if the @option{-R} option is
252b5132 1107followed by a directory name, rather than a file name, it is treated as
ff5dcc92 1108the @option{-rpath} option.
252b5132
RH
1109
1110@kindex -s
1111@kindex --strip-all
1112@cindex strip all symbols
a1ab1d2a 1113@item -s
252b5132
RH
1114@itemx --strip-all
1115Omit all symbol information from the output file.
1116
1117@kindex -S
1118@kindex --strip-debug
1119@cindex strip debugger symbols
a1ab1d2a 1120@item -S
252b5132
RH
1121@itemx --strip-debug
1122Omit debugger symbol information (but not all symbols) from the output file.
1123
a70f34c0
NC
1124@kindex --strip-discarded
1125@kindex --no-strip-discarded
1126@item --strip-discarded
1127@itemx --no-strip-discarded
1128Omit (or do not omit) global symbols defined in discarded sections.
1129Enabled by default.
1130
252b5132
RH
1131@kindex -t
1132@kindex --trace
1133@cindex input files, displaying
a1ab1d2a 1134@item -t
252b5132 1135@itemx --trace
4f4690cd
AM
1136Print the names of the input files as @command{ld} processes them. If
1137@samp{-t} is given twice then members within archives are also printed.
1138@samp{-t} output is useful to generate a list of all the object files
1139and scripts involved in linking, for example, when packaging files for
1140a linker bug report.
252b5132
RH
1141
1142@kindex -T @var{script}
1143@kindex --script=@var{script}
1144@cindex script files
1145@item -T @var{scriptfile}
1146@itemx --script=@var{scriptfile}
1147Use @var{scriptfile} as the linker script. This script replaces
31f14901
AM
1148@command{ld}'s default linker script (rather than adding to it),
1149unless the script contains @code{INSERT}, so
252b5132 1150@var{commandfile} must specify everything necessary to describe the
114283d8
NC
1151output file. @xref{Scripts}. If @var{scriptfile} does not exist in
1152the current directory, @code{ld} looks for it in the directories
1153specified by any preceding @samp{-L} options. Multiple @samp{-T}
1154options accumulate.
252b5132 1155
14be8564
L
1156@kindex -dT @var{script}
1157@kindex --default-script=@var{script}
1158@cindex script files
1159@item -dT @var{scriptfile}
1160@itemx --default-script=@var{scriptfile}
1161Use @var{scriptfile} as the default linker script. @xref{Scripts}.
1162
1163This option is similar to the @option{--script} option except that
1164processing of the script is delayed until after the rest of the
1165command line has been processed. This allows options placed after the
1166@option{--default-script} option on the command line to affect the
1167behaviour of the linker script, which can be important when the linker
1168command line cannot be directly controlled by the user. (eg because
1169the command line is being constructed by another tool, such as
1170@samp{gcc}).
1171
252b5132
RH
1172@kindex -u @var{symbol}
1173@kindex --undefined=@var{symbol}
1174@cindex undefined symbol
1175@item -u @var{symbol}
1176@itemx --undefined=@var{symbol}
1177Force @var{symbol} to be entered in the output file as an undefined
1178symbol. Doing this may, for example, trigger linking of additional
1179modules from standard libraries. @samp{-u} may be repeated with
1180different option arguments to enter additional undefined symbols. This
1181option is equivalent to the @code{EXTERN} linker script command.
1182
0a618243
AB
1183If this option is being used to force additional modules to be pulled
1184into the link, and if it is an error for the symbol to remain
1185undefined, then the option @option{--require-defined} should be used
1186instead.
1187
1188@kindex --require-defined=@var{symbol}
1189@cindex symbols, require defined
1190@cindex defined symbol
1191@item --require-defined=@var{symbol}
1192Require that @var{symbol} is defined in the output file. This option
1193is the same as option @option{--undefined} except that if @var{symbol}
1194is not defined in the output file then the linker will issue an error
1195and exit. The same effect can be achieved in a linker script by using
1196@code{EXTERN}, @code{ASSERT} and @code{DEFINED} together. This option
1197can be used multiple times to require additional symbols.
1198
252b5132
RH
1199@kindex -Ur
1200@cindex constructors
a1ab1d2a 1201@item -Ur
0a7dda4f
NC
1202
1203For programs that do not use constructors or destructors, or for ELF
1204based systems this option is equivalent to @option{-r}: it generates
1205relocatable output---i.e., an output file that can in turn serve as
1206input to @command{ld}. For other binaries however the @option{-Ur}
1207option is similar to @option{-r} but it also resolves references to
1208constructors and destructors.
1209
35f8b059
NC
1210For those systems where @option{-r} and @option{-Ur} behave
1211differently, it does not work to use @option{-Ur} on files that were
1212themselves linked with @option{-Ur}; once the constructor table has
1213been built, it cannot be added to. Use @option{-Ur} only for the last
1214partial link, and @option{-r} for the others.
252b5132 1215
c005eb9e
AB
1216@kindex --orphan-handling=@var{MODE}
1217@cindex orphan sections
1218@cindex sections, orphan
1219@item --orphan-handling=@var{MODE}
1220Control how orphan sections are handled. An orphan section is one not
1221specifically mentioned in a linker script. @xref{Orphan Sections}.
1222
1223@var{MODE} can have any of the following values:
1224
1225@table @code
1226@item place
1227Orphan sections are placed into a suitable output section following
1228the strategy described in @ref{Orphan Sections}. The option
d2732b69 1229@samp{--unique} also affects how sections are placed.
c005eb9e
AB
1230
1231@item discard
1232All orphan sections are discarded, by placing them in the
1233@samp{/DISCARD/} section (@pxref{Output Section Discarding}).
1234
1235@item warn
1236The linker will place the orphan section as for @code{place} and also
1237issue a warning.
1238
1239@item error
1240The linker will exit with an error if any orphan section is found.
1241@end table
1242
1243The default if @samp{--orphan-handling} is not given is @code{place}.
1244
577a0623
AM
1245@kindex --unique[=@var{SECTION}]
1246@item --unique[=@var{SECTION}]
1247Creates a separate output section for every input section matching
1248@var{SECTION}, or if the optional wildcard @var{SECTION} argument is
1249missing, for every orphan input section. An orphan section is one not
1250specifically mentioned in a linker script. You may use this option
1251multiple times on the command line; It prevents the normal merging of
1252input sections with the same name, overriding output section assignments
1253in a linker script.
a854a4a7 1254
252b5132
RH
1255@kindex -v
1256@kindex -V
1257@kindex --version
1258@cindex version
1259@item -v
1260@itemx --version
1261@itemx -V
ff5dcc92 1262Display the version number for @command{ld}. The @option{-V} option also
2d5783fa
NC
1263lists the supported emulations. See also the description of the
1264@option{--enable-linker-version} in @ref{Options,,Command-line Options}
1265which can be used to insert the linker version string into a binary.
252b5132
RH
1266
1267@kindex -x
1268@kindex --discard-all
1269@cindex deleting local symbols
1270@item -x
1271@itemx --discard-all
1272Delete all local symbols.
1273
1274@kindex -X
1275@kindex --discard-locals
1276@cindex local symbols, deleting
a1ab1d2a 1277@item -X
252b5132 1278@itemx --discard-locals
3c68c38f
BW
1279Delete all temporary local symbols. (These symbols start with
1280system-specific local label prefixes, typically @samp{.L} for ELF systems
1281or @samp{L} for traditional a.out systems.)
252b5132
RH
1282
1283@kindex -y @var{symbol}
1284@kindex --trace-symbol=@var{symbol}
1285@cindex symbol tracing
1286@item -y @var{symbol}
1287@itemx --trace-symbol=@var{symbol}
1288Print the name of each linked file in which @var{symbol} appears. This
1289option may be given any number of times. On many systems it is necessary
1290to prepend an underscore.
1291
1292This option is useful when you have an undefined symbol in your link but
1293don't know where the reference is coming from.
1294
1295@kindex -Y @var{path}
1296@item -Y @var{path}
1297Add @var{path} to the default library search path. This option exists
1298for Solaris compatibility.
1299
1300@kindex -z @var{keyword}
1301@item -z @var{keyword}
cd6d6c15
NC
1302The recognized keywords are:
1303@table @samp
1304
e6e2dfbd
AM
1305@item call-nop=prefix-addr
1306@itemx call-nop=suffix-nop
1307@itemx call-nop=prefix-@var{byte}
1308@itemx call-nop=suffix-@var{byte}
1309Specify the 1-byte @code{NOP} padding when transforming indirect call
1310to a locally defined function, foo, via its GOT slot.
1311@option{call-nop=prefix-addr} generates @code{0x67 call foo}.
1312@option{call-nop=suffix-nop} generates @code{call foo 0x90}.
1313@option{call-nop=prefix-@var{byte}} generates @code{@var{byte} call foo}.
1314@option{call-nop=suffix-@var{byte}} generates @code{call foo @var{byte}}.
1315Supported for i386 and x86_64.
1316
233a0083
L
1317@item cet-report=none
1318@itemx cet-report=warning
1319@itemx cet-report=error
1320Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT and
1321GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK properties in input .note.gnu.property
1322section. @option{cet-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1323linker not report missing properties in input files.
1324@option{cet-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1325missing properties in input files. @option{cet-report=error} will make
1326the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1327Note that @option{ibt} will turn off the missing
1328GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT property report and @option{shstk} will
1329turn off the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK property report.
1330Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1331
cd6d6c15 1332@item combreloc
e6e2dfbd
AM
1333@itemx nocombreloc
1334Combine multiple dynamic relocation sections and sort to improve
1335dynamic symbol lookup caching. Do not do this if @samp{nocombreloc}.
cd6d6c15 1336
b8871f35 1337@item common
e6e2dfbd
AM
1338@itemx nocommon
1339Generate common symbols with STT_COMMON type during a relocatable
1340link. Use STT_OBJECT type if @samp{nocommon}.
1341
1342@item common-page-size=@var{value}
1343Set the page size most commonly used to @var{value}. Memory image
1344layout will be optimized to minimize memory pages if the system is
1345using pages of this size.
b8871f35 1346
cd6d6c15 1347@item defs
97a232d7
NC
1348Report unresolved symbol references from regular object files. This
1349is done even if the linker is creating a non-symbolic shared library.
1350This option is the inverse of @samp{-z undefs}.
cd6d6c15 1351
e6e2dfbd
AM
1352@item dynamic-undefined-weak
1353@itemx nodynamic-undefined-weak
1354Make undefined weak symbols dynamic when building a dynamic object,
1355if they are referenced from a regular object file and not forced local
1356by symbol visibility or versioning. Do not make them dynamic if
1357@samp{nodynamic-undefined-weak}. If neither option is given, a target
1358may default to either option being in force, or make some other
1359selection of undefined weak symbols dynamic. Not all targets support
1360these options.
1361
6aa29e7b
JJ
1362@item execstack
1363Marks the object as requiring executable stack.
1364
b039ef04
L
1365@item global
1366This option is only meaningful when building a shared object. It makes
1367the symbols defined by this shared object available for symbol resolution
1368of subsequently loaded libraries.
1369
93ab9c0d
NC
1370@item globalaudit
1371This option is only meaningful when building a dynamic executable.
1372This option marks the executable as requiring global auditing by
1373setting the @code{DF_1_GLOBAUDIT} bit in the @code{DT_FLAGS_1} dynamic
1374tag. Global auditing requires that any auditing library defined via
a05a5b64 1375the @option{--depaudit} or @option{-P} command-line options be run for
6c19b93b 1376all dynamic objects loaded by the application.
93ab9c0d 1377
e6e2dfbd
AM
1378@item ibtplt
1379Generate Intel Indirect Branch Tracking (IBT) enabled PLT entries.
1380Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1381
8df93cb5 1382@item ibt
e6e2dfbd
AM
1383Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_IBT in .note.gnu.property section
1384to indicate compatibility with IBT. This also implies @option{ibtplt}.
1385Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1386
6f365fda
L
1387@item indirect-extern-access
1388@itemx noindirect-extern-access
1389Generate GNU_PROPERTY_1_NEEDED_INDIRECT_EXTERN_ACCESS in
1390.note.gnu.property section to indicate that object file requires
1391canonical function pointers and cannot be used with copy relocation.
1392This option also implies @option{noextern-protected-data} and
1393@option{nocopyreloc}. Supported for i386 and x86-64.
1394
1395@option{noindirect-extern-access} removes
1396GNU_PROPERTY_1_NEEDED_INDIRECT_EXTERN_ACCESS from .note.gnu.property
1397section.
1398
cd6d6c15
NC
1399@item initfirst
1400This option is only meaningful when building a shared object.
1401It marks the object so that its runtime initialization will occur
1402before the runtime initialization of any other objects brought into
1403the process at the same time. Similarly the runtime finalization of
1404the object will occur after the runtime finalization of any other
1405objects.
1406
1407@item interpose
e6e2dfbd
AM
1408Specify that the dynamic loader should modify its symbol search order
1409so that symbols in this shared library interpose all other shared
1410libraries not so marked.
cd6d6c15 1411
c3805e4c
VDM
1412@item unique
1413@itemx nounique
1414When generating a shared library or other dynamically loadable ELF
1415object mark it as one that should (by default) only ever be loaded once,
1416and only in the main namespace (when using @code{dlmopen}). This is
1417primarily used to mark fundamental libraries such as libc, libpthread et
1418al which do not usually function correctly unless they are the sole instances
1419of themselves. This behaviour can be overridden by the @code{dlmopen} caller
1420and does not apply to certain loading mechanisms (such as audit libraries).
1421
279d901e
L
1422@item lam-u48
1423Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U48 in .note.gnu.property section
1424to indicate compatibility with Intel LAM_U48. Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1425
1426@item lam-u57
1427Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U57 in .note.gnu.property section
1428to indicate compatibility with Intel LAM_U57. Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1429
1430@item lam-u48-report=none
1431@itemx lam-u48-report=warning
1432@itemx lam-u48-report=error
1433Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U48
1434property in input .note.gnu.property section.
1435@option{lam-u48-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1436linker not report missing properties in input files.
1437@option{lam-u48-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1438missing properties in input files. @option{lam-u48-report=error} will
1439make the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1440Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1441
1442@item lam-u57-report=none
1443@itemx lam-u57-report=warning
1444@itemx lam-u57-report=error
1445Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U57
1446property in input .note.gnu.property section.
1447@option{lam-u57-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1448linker not report missing properties in input files.
1449@option{lam-u57-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1450missing properties in input files. @option{lam-u57-report=error} will
1451make the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1452Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1453
1454@item lam-report=none
1455@itemx lam-report=warning
1456@itemx lam-report=error
1457Specify how to report the missing GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U48 and
1458GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_LAM_U57 properties in input .note.gnu.property
1459section. @option{lam-report=none}, which is the default, will make the
1460linker not report missing properties in input files.
1461@option{lam-report=warning} will make the linker issue a warning for
1462missing properties in input files. @option{lam-report=error} will make
1463the linker issue an error for missing properties in input files.
1464Supported for Linux/x86_64.
1465
5fa222e4
AM
1466@item lazy
1467When generating an executable or shared library, mark it to tell the
1468dynamic linker to defer function call resolution to the point when
1469the function is called (lazy binding), rather than at load time.
1470Lazy binding is the default.
1471
cd6d6c15 1472@item loadfltr
e6e2dfbd 1473Specify that the object's filters be processed immediately at runtime.
cd6d6c15 1474
e6e2dfbd
AM
1475@item max-page-size=@var{value}
1476Set the maximum memory page size supported to @var{value}.
cd6d6c15 1477
e6e2dfbd
AM
1478@item muldefs
1479Allow multiple definitions.
b8871f35 1480
cd6d6c15 1481@item nocopyreloc
daf220f0
AM
1482Disable linker generated .dynbss variables used in place of variables
1483defined in shared libraries. May result in dynamic text relocations.
cd6d6c15
NC
1484
1485@item nodefaultlib
e6e2dfbd
AM
1486Specify that the dynamic loader search for dependencies of this object
1487should ignore any default library search paths.
cd6d6c15
NC
1488
1489@item nodelete
e6e2dfbd 1490Specify that the object shouldn't be unloaded at runtime.
cd6d6c15
NC
1491
1492@item nodlopen
e6e2dfbd 1493Specify that the object is not available to @code{dlopen}.
cd6d6c15
NC
1494
1495@item nodump
e6e2dfbd 1496Specify that the object can not be dumped by @code{dldump}.
cd6d6c15 1497
6aa29e7b
JJ
1498@item noexecstack
1499Marks the object as not requiring executable stack.
1500
e6e2dfbd
AM
1501@item noextern-protected-data
1502Don't treat protected data symbols as external when building a shared
1503library. This option overrides the linker backend default. It can be
1504used to work around incorrect relocations against protected data symbols
1505generated by compiler. Updates on protected data symbols by another
1506module aren't visible to the resulting shared library. Supported for
1507i386 and x86-64.
8dfef1bd 1508
e6e2dfbd
AM
1509@item noreloc-overflow
1510Disable relocation overflow check. This can be used to disable
1511relocation overflow check if there will be no dynamic relocation
1512overflow at run-time. Supported for x86_64.
6aa29e7b 1513
cd6d6c15
NC
1514@item now
1515When generating an executable or shared library, mark it to tell the
1516dynamic linker to resolve all symbols when the program is started, or
e6e2dfbd
AM
1517when the shared library is loaded by dlopen, instead of deferring
1518function call resolution to the point when the function is first
1519called.
cd6d6c15
NC
1520
1521@item origin
e6e2dfbd 1522Specify that the object requires @samp{$ORIGIN} handling in paths.
cd6d6c15 1523
6a91be86
L
1524@item pack-relative-relocs
1525@itemx nopack-relative-relocs
1526Generate compact relative relocation in position-independent executable
1527and shared library. It adds @code{DT_RELR}, @code{DT_RELRSZ} and
1528@code{DT_RELRENT} entries to the dynamic section. It is ignored when
1529building position-dependent executable and relocatable output.
1530@option{nopack-relative-relocs} is the default, which disables compact
72aa8173
L
1531relative relocation. When linked against the GNU C Library, a
1532GLIBC_ABI_DT_RELR symbol version dependency on the shared C Library is
1533added to the output. Supported for i386 and x86-64.
6a91be86 1534
6aa29e7b 1535@item relro
e6e2dfbd 1536@itemx norelro
def5c83c
AM
1537Create an ELF @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment header in the object. This
1538specifies a memory segment that should be made read-only after
1539relocation, if supported. Specifying @samp{common-page-size} smaller
1540than the system page size will render this protection ineffective.
e6e2dfbd 1541Don't create an ELF @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment if @samp{norelro}.
6aa29e7b 1542
68b00778
L
1543@item report-relative-reloc
1544Report dynamic relative relocations generated by linker. Supported for
1545Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1546
96cc7918
KB
1547@item sectionheader
1548@itemx nosectionheader
1549Generate section header. Don't generate section header if
1550@samp{nosectionheader} is used. @option{sectionheader} is the default.
1551
47acac12
L
1552@item separate-code
1553@itemx noseparate-code
1554Create separate code @code{PT_LOAD} segment header in the object. This
1555specifies a memory segment that should contain only instructions and must
1556be in wholly disjoint pages from any other data. Don't create separate
1557code @code{PT_LOAD} segment if @samp{noseparate-code} is used.
1558
e6e2dfbd
AM
1559@item shstk
1560Generate GNU_PROPERTY_X86_FEATURE_1_SHSTK in .note.gnu.property section
1561to indicate compatibility with Intel Shadow Stack. Supported for
1562Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
24718e3b 1563
04c3a755 1564@item stack-size=@var{value}
e6e2dfbd 1565Specify a stack size for an ELF @code{PT_GNU_STACK} segment.
04c3a755
NS
1566Specifying zero will override any default non-zero sized
1567@code{PT_GNU_STACK} segment creation.
1568
8ee10e86
AM
1569@item start-stop-gc
1570@itemx nostart-stop-gc
1571@cindex start-stop-gc
1572When @samp{--gc-sections} is in effect, a reference from a retained
1573section to @code{__start_SECNAME} or @code{__stop_SECNAME} causes all
1574input sections named @code{SECNAME} to also be retained, if
1575@code{SECNAME} is representable as a C identifier and either
1576@code{__start_SECNAME} or @code{__stop_SECNAME} is synthesized by the
1577linker. @samp{-z start-stop-gc} disables this effect, allowing
1578sections to be garbage collected as if the special synthesized symbols
1579were not defined. @samp{-z start-stop-gc} has no effect on a
1580definition of @code{__start_SECNAME} or @code{__stop_SECNAME} in an
1581object file or linker script. Such a definition will prevent the
1582linker providing a synthesized @code{__start_SECNAME} or
1583@code{__stop_SECNAME} respectively, and therefore the special
1584treatment by garbage collection for those references.
1585
cae64165
RM
1586@item start-stop-visibility=@var{value}
1587@cindex visibility
1588@cindex ELF symbol visibility
1589Specify the ELF symbol visibility for synthesized
1590@code{__start_SECNAME} and @code{__stop_SECNAME} symbols (@pxref{Input
1591Section Example}). @var{value} must be exactly @samp{default},
1592@samp{internal}, @samp{hidden}, or @samp{protected}. If no @samp{-z
1593start-stop-visibility} option is given, @samp{protected} is used for
1594compatibility with historical practice. However, it's highly
1595recommended to use @samp{-z start-stop-visibility=hidden} in new
1596programs and shared libraries so that these symbols are not exported
1597between shared objects, which is not usually what's intended.
1598
e6e2dfbd
AM
1599@item text
1600@itemx notext
1601@itemx textoff
a6dbf402
L
1602Report an error if DT_TEXTREL is set, i.e., if the position-independent
1603or shared object has dynamic relocations in read-only sections. Don't
1604report an error if @samp{notext} or @samp{textoff}.
48580982 1605
97a232d7
NC
1606@item undefs
1607Do not report unresolved symbol references from regular object files,
1608either when creating an executable, or when creating a shared library.
1609This option is the inverse of @samp{-z defs}.
1610
2d95647b
L
1611@item unique-symbol
1612@itemx nounique-symbol
1613Avoid duplicated local symbol names in the symbol string table. Append
1614".@code{number}" to duplicated local symbol names if @samp{unique-symbol}
1615is used. @option{nounique-symbol} is the default.
1616
b0ab0693 1617@item x86-64-baseline
32930e4e
L
1618@item x86-64-v2
1619@item x86-64-v3
1620@itemx x86-64-v4
1621Specify the x86-64 ISA level needed in .note.gnu.property section.
b0ab0693 1622@option{x86-64-baseline} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_BASELINE}.
32930e4e
L
1623@option{x86-64-v2} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V2}.
1624@option{x86-64-v3} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V3}.
1625@option{x86-64-v4} generates @code{GNU_PROPERTY_X86_ISA_1_V4}.
1626Supported for Linux/i386 and Linux/x86_64.
1627
cd6d6c15
NC
1628@end table
1629
ece2d90e 1630Other keywords are ignored for Solaris compatibility.
252b5132
RH
1631
1632@kindex -(
1633@cindex groups of archives
1634@item -( @var{archives} -)
1635@itemx --start-group @var{archives} --end-group
1636The @var{archives} should be a list of archive files. They may be
1637either explicit file names, or @samp{-l} options.
1638
1639The specified archives are searched repeatedly until no new undefined
1640references are created. Normally, an archive is searched only once in
1641the order that it is specified on the command line. If a symbol in that
1642archive is needed to resolve an undefined symbol referred to by an
1643object in an archive that appears later on the command line, the linker
1644would not be able to resolve that reference. By grouping the archives,
5d3db3e2 1645they will all be searched repeatedly until all possible references are
252b5132
RH
1646resolved.
1647
1648Using this option has a significant performance cost. It is best to use
1649it only when there are unavoidable circular references between two or
1650more archives.
1651
69da35b5
NC
1652@kindex --accept-unknown-input-arch
1653@kindex --no-accept-unknown-input-arch
1654@item --accept-unknown-input-arch
1655@itemx --no-accept-unknown-input-arch
1656Tells the linker to accept input files whose architecture cannot be
2ca22b03 1657recognised. The assumption is that the user knows what they are doing
69da35b5
NC
1658and deliberately wants to link in these unknown input files. This was
1659the default behaviour of the linker, before release 2.14. The default
1660behaviour from release 2.14 onwards is to reject such input files, and
1661so the @samp{--accept-unknown-input-arch} option has been added to
1662restore the old behaviour.
2ca22b03 1663
4a43e768
AM
1664@kindex --as-needed
1665@kindex --no-as-needed
1666@item --as-needed
1667@itemx --no-as-needed
1668This option affects ELF DT_NEEDED tags for dynamic libraries mentioned
ddbb8a31 1669on the command line after the @option{--as-needed} option. Normally
4a43e768
AM
1670the linker will add a DT_NEEDED tag for each dynamic library mentioned
1671on the command line, regardless of whether the library is actually
ddbb8a31 1672needed or not. @option{--as-needed} causes a DT_NEEDED tag to only be
ffa9430d
AM
1673emitted for a library that @emph{at that point in the link} satisfies a
1674non-weak undefined symbol reference from a regular object file or, if
1240be6b
AM
1675the library is not found in the DT_NEEDED lists of other needed libraries, a
1676non-weak undefined symbol reference from another needed dynamic library.
ffa9430d
AM
1677Object files or libraries appearing on the command line @emph{after}
1678the library in question do not affect whether the library is seen as
1679needed. This is similar to the rules for extraction of object files
1680from archives. @option{--no-as-needed} restores the default behaviour.
4a43e768 1681
6418520e
NC
1682Note: On Linux based systems the @option{--as-needed} option also has
1683an affect on the behaviour of the @option{--rpath} and
1684@option{--rpath-link} options. See the description of
1685@option{--rpath-link} for more details.
1686
e56f61be
L
1687@kindex --add-needed
1688@kindex --no-add-needed
1689@item --add-needed
1690@itemx --no-add-needed
ddbb8a31
NC
1691These two options have been deprecated because of the similarity of
1692their names to the @option{--as-needed} and @option{--no-as-needed}
1693options. They have been replaced by @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}
1694and @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries}.
e56f61be 1695
252b5132
RH
1696@kindex -assert @var{keyword}
1697@item -assert @var{keyword}
1698This option is ignored for SunOS compatibility.
1699
1700@kindex -Bdynamic
1701@kindex -dy
1702@kindex -call_shared
1703@item -Bdynamic
1704@itemx -dy
1705@itemx -call_shared
1706Link against dynamic libraries. This is only meaningful on platforms
1707for which shared libraries are supported. This option is normally the
1708default on such platforms. The different variants of this option are
1709for compatibility with various systems. You may use this option
1710multiple times on the command line: it affects library searching for
da8bce14 1711@option{-l} options which follow it.
252b5132 1712
a1ab1d2a
UD
1713@kindex -Bgroup
1714@item -Bgroup
1715Set the @code{DF_1_GROUP} flag in the @code{DT_FLAGS_1} entry in the dynamic
1716section. This causes the runtime linker to handle lookups in this
1717object and its dependencies to be performed only inside the group.
560e09e9
NC
1718@option{--unresolved-symbols=report-all} is implied. This option is
1719only meaningful on ELF platforms which support shared libraries.
a1ab1d2a 1720
252b5132
RH
1721@kindex -Bstatic
1722@kindex -dn
1723@kindex -non_shared
1724@kindex -static
a1ab1d2a 1725@item -Bstatic
252b5132
RH
1726@itemx -dn
1727@itemx -non_shared
1728@itemx -static
1729Do not link against shared libraries. This is only meaningful on
1730platforms for which shared libraries are supported. The different
1731variants of this option are for compatibility with various systems. You
1732may use this option multiple times on the command line: it affects
560e09e9 1733library searching for @option{-l} options which follow it. This
e9156f74
NC
1734option also implies @option{--unresolved-symbols=report-all}. This
1735option can be used with @option{-shared}. Doing so means that a
1736shared library is being created but that all of the library's external
1737references must be resolved by pulling in entries from static
ece2d90e 1738libraries.
252b5132
RH
1739
1740@kindex -Bsymbolic
1741@item -Bsymbolic
1742When creating a shared library, bind references to global symbols to the
1743definition within the shared library, if any. Normally, it is possible
1744for a program linked against a shared library to override the definition
1914e264
AM
1745within the shared library. This option is only meaningful on ELF
1746platforms which support shared libraries.
252b5132 1747
40b36307
L
1748@kindex -Bsymbolic-functions
1749@item -Bsymbolic-functions
1750When creating a shared library, bind references to global function
c0065db7 1751symbols to the definition within the shared library, if any.
40b36307 1752This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms which support shared
1914e264 1753libraries.
40b36307 1754
cf893b0e
FS
1755@kindex -Bno-symbolic
1756@item -Bno-symbolic
1757This option can cancel previously specified @samp{-Bsymbolic} and
1758@samp{-Bsymbolic-functions}.
1759
55255dae
L
1760@kindex --dynamic-list=@var{dynamic-list-file}
1761@item --dynamic-list=@var{dynamic-list-file}
1762Specify the name of a dynamic list file to the linker. This is
1763typically used when creating shared libraries to specify a list of
1764global symbols whose references shouldn't be bound to the definition
1765within the shared library, or creating dynamically linked executables
1766to specify a list of symbols which should be added to the symbol table
1767in the executable. This option is only meaningful on ELF platforms
1768which support shared libraries.
1769
1770The format of the dynamic list is the same as the version node without
1771scope and node name. See @ref{VERSION} for more information.
1772
40b36307
L
1773@kindex --dynamic-list-data
1774@item --dynamic-list-data
1775Include all global data symbols to the dynamic list.
1776
1777@kindex --dynamic-list-cpp-new
1778@item --dynamic-list-cpp-new
1779Provide the builtin dynamic list for C++ operator new and delete. It
1780is mainly useful for building shared libstdc++.
1781
0b8a70d9
L
1782@kindex --dynamic-list-cpp-typeinfo
1783@item --dynamic-list-cpp-typeinfo
1784Provide the builtin dynamic list for C++ runtime type identification.
1785
252b5132
RH
1786@kindex --check-sections
1787@kindex --no-check-sections
1788@item --check-sections
308b1ffd 1789@itemx --no-check-sections
252b5132 1790Asks the linker @emph{not} to check section addresses after they have
7d816a17 1791been assigned to see if there are any overlaps. Normally the linker will
252b5132
RH
1792perform this check, and if it finds any overlaps it will produce
1793suitable error messages. The linker does know about, and does make
1794allowances for sections in overlays. The default behaviour can be
a05a5b64 1795restored by using the command-line switch @option{--check-sections}.
02b0b1aa
NS
1796Section overlap is not usually checked for relocatable links. You can
1797force checking in that case by using the @option{--check-sections}
1798option.
252b5132 1799
ddbb8a31
NC
1800@kindex --copy-dt-needed-entries
1801@kindex --no-copy-dt-needed-entries
1802@item --copy-dt-needed-entries
1803@itemx --no-copy-dt-needed-entries
9d5777a3 1804This option affects the treatment of dynamic libraries referred to
ddbb8a31 1805by DT_NEEDED tags @emph{inside} ELF dynamic libraries mentioned on the
08efffb8 1806command line. Normally the linker won't add a DT_NEEDED tag to the
ddbb8a31 1807output binary for each library mentioned in a DT_NEEDED tag in an
08efffb8 1808input dynamic library. With @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries}
ddbb8a31 1809specified on the command line however any dynamic libraries that
08efffb8
MM
1810follow it will have their DT_NEEDED entries added. The default
1811behaviour can be restored with @option{--no-copy-dt-needed-entries}.
ddbb8a31
NC
1812
1813This option also has an effect on the resolution of symbols in dynamic
08efffb8
MM
1814libraries. With @option{--copy-dt-needed-entries} dynamic libraries
1815mentioned on the command line will be recursively searched, following
1816their DT_NEEDED tags to other libraries, in order to resolve symbols
1817required by the output binary. With the default setting however
1818the searching of dynamic libraries that follow it will stop with the
1819dynamic library itself. No DT_NEEDED links will be traversed to resolve
ddbb8a31
NC
1820symbols.
1821
252b5132
RH
1822@cindex cross reference table
1823@kindex --cref
1824@item --cref
1825Output a cross reference table. If a linker map file is being
1826generated, the cross reference table is printed to the map file.
1827Otherwise, it is printed on the standard output.
1828
1829The format of the table is intentionally simple, so that it may be
1830easily processed by a script if necessary. The symbols are printed out,
1831sorted by name. For each symbol, a list of file names is given. If the
1832symbol is defined, the first file listed is the location of the
049c1c8e
NC
1833definition. If the symbol is defined as a common value then any files
1834where this happens appear next. Finally any files that reference the
1835symbol are listed.
252b5132 1836
5dba6f05
NA
1837@cindex ctf variables
1838@kindex --ctf-variables
1839@kindex --no-ctf-variables
1840@item --ctf-variables
1841@item --no-ctf-variables
1842The CTF debuginfo format supports a section which encodes the names and
1843types of variables found in the program which do not appear in any symbol
1844table. These variables clearly cannot be looked up by address by
1845conventional debuggers, so the space used for their types and names is
1846usually wasted: the types are usually small but the names are often not.
1847@option{--ctf-variables} causes the generation of such a section.
1848The default behaviour can be restored with @option{--no-ctf-variables}.
1849
1850@cindex ctf type sharing
1851@kindex --ctf-share-types
1852@item --ctf-share-types=@var{method}
1853Adjust the method used to share types between translation units in CTF.
1854
1855@table @samp
1856@item share-unconflicted
1857Put all types that do not have ambiguous definitions into the shared dictionary,
1858where debuggers can easily access them, even if they only occur in one
1859translation unit. This is the default.
1860
1861@item share-duplicated
1862Put only types that occur in multiple translation units into the shared
1863dictionary: types with only one definition go into per-translation-unit
1864dictionaries. Types with ambiguous definitions in multiple translation units
1865always go into per-translation-unit dictionaries. This tends to make the CTF
1866larger, but may reduce the amount of CTF in the shared dictionary. For very
1867large projects this may speed up opening the CTF and save memory in the CTF
1868consumer at runtime.
1869@end table
1870
4818e05f
AM
1871@cindex common allocation
1872@kindex --no-define-common
1873@item --no-define-common
1874This option inhibits the assignment of addresses to common symbols.
1875The script command @code{INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION} has the same effect.
1876@xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
1877
1878The @samp{--no-define-common} option allows decoupling
1879the decision to assign addresses to Common symbols from the choice
1880of the output file type; otherwise a non-Relocatable output type
1881forces assigning addresses to Common symbols.
1882Using @samp{--no-define-common} allows Common symbols that are referenced
1883from a shared library to be assigned addresses only in the main program.
1884This eliminates the unused duplicate space in the shared library,
1885and also prevents any possible confusion over resolving to the wrong
1886duplicate when there are many dynamic modules with specialized search
1887paths for runtime symbol resolution.
1888
7bdf4127
AB
1889@cindex group allocation in linker script
1890@cindex section groups
1891@cindex COMDAT
1892@kindex --force-group-allocation
1893@item --force-group-allocation
1894This option causes the linker to place section group members like
1895normal input sections, and to delete the section groups. This is the
1896default behaviour for a final link but this option can be used to
1897change the behaviour of a relocatable link (@samp{-r}). The script
1898command @code{FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION} has the same
1899effect. @xref{Miscellaneous Commands}.
1900
252b5132 1901@cindex symbols, from command line
2509a395
SL
1902@kindex --defsym=@var{symbol}=@var{exp}
1903@item --defsym=@var{symbol}=@var{expression}
252b5132
RH
1904Create a global symbol in the output file, containing the absolute
1905address given by @var{expression}. You may use this option as many
1906times as necessary to define multiple symbols in the command line. A
1907limited form of arithmetic is supported for the @var{expression} in this
1908context: you may give a hexadecimal constant or the name of an existing
1909symbol, or use @code{+} and @code{-} to add or subtract hexadecimal
1910constants or symbols. If you need more elaborate expressions, consider
66bc8739
AM
1911using the linker command language from a script (@pxref{Assignments}).
1912@emph{Note:} there should be no white space between @var{symbol}, the
1913equals sign (``@key{=}''), and @var{expression}.
252b5132 1914
54874444
AB
1915The linker processes @samp{--defsym} arguments and @samp{-T} arguments
1916in order, placing @samp{--defsym} before @samp{-T} will define the
1917symbol before the linker script from @samp{-T} is processed, while
1918placing @samp{--defsym} after @samp{-T} will define the symbol after
1919the linker script has been processed. This difference has
1920consequences for expressions within the linker script that use the
1921@samp{--defsym} symbols, which order is correct will depend on what
1922you are trying to achieve.
1923
252b5132 1924@cindex demangling, from command line
28c309a2 1925@kindex --demangle[=@var{style}]
252b5132 1926@kindex --no-demangle
28c309a2 1927@item --demangle[=@var{style}]
252b5132
RH
1928@itemx --no-demangle
1929These options control whether to demangle symbol names in error messages
1930and other output. When the linker is told to demangle, it tries to
1931present symbol names in a readable fashion: it strips leading
1932underscores if they are used by the object file format, and converts C++
a1ab1d2a
UD
1933mangled symbol names into user readable names. Different compilers have
1934different mangling styles. The optional demangling style argument can be used
1935to choose an appropriate demangling style for your compiler. The linker will
28c309a2
NC
1936demangle by default unless the environment variable @samp{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE}
1937is set. These options may be used to override the default.
252b5132
RH
1938
1939@cindex dynamic linker, from command line
506eee22 1940@kindex -I@var{file}
2509a395
SL
1941@kindex --dynamic-linker=@var{file}
1942@item -I@var{file}
1943@itemx --dynamic-linker=@var{file}
252b5132
RH
1944Set the name of the dynamic linker. This is only meaningful when
1945generating dynamically linked ELF executables. The default dynamic
1946linker is normally correct; don't use this unless you know what you are
1947doing.
1948
9b8b325a
RF
1949@kindex --no-dynamic-linker
1950@item --no-dynamic-linker
1951When producing an executable file, omit the request for a dynamic
1952linker to be used at load-time. This is only meaningful for ELF
1953executables that contain dynamic relocations, and usually requires
1954entry point code that is capable of processing these relocations.
1955
a70f34c0
NC
1956@kindex --embedded-relocs
1957@item --embedded-relocs
1958This option is similar to the @option{--emit-relocs} option except
a094d01f 1959that the relocs are stored in a target-specific section. This option
a70f34c0
NC
1960is only supported by the @samp{BFIN}, @samp{CR16} and @emph{M68K}
1961targets.
1962
3f0a5f17
ME
1963@kindex --disable-multiple-abs-defs
1964@item --disable-multiple-abs-defs
1965Do not allow multiple definitions with symbols included
1966in filename invoked by -R or --just-symbols
1967
7ce691ae 1968@kindex --fatal-warnings
0fe58ccd 1969@kindex --no-fatal-warnings
7ce691ae 1970@item --fatal-warnings
0fe58ccd
NC
1971@itemx --no-fatal-warnings
1972Treat all warnings as errors. The default behaviour can be restored
1973with the option @option{--no-fatal-warnings}.
7ce691ae 1974
4b2e7a57
NC
1975@kindex -w
1976@kindex --no-warnings
1977@item -w
1978@itemx --no-warnings
1979Do not display any warning or error messages. This overrides
1980@option{--fatal-warnings} if it has been enabled. This option can be
1981used when it is known that the output binary will not work, but there
1982is still a need to create it.
1983
252b5132
RH
1984@kindex --force-exe-suffix
1985@item --force-exe-suffix
1986Make sure that an output file has a .exe suffix.
1987
1988If a successfully built fully linked output file does not have a
1989@code{.exe} or @code{.dll} suffix, this option forces the linker to copy
1990the output file to one of the same name with a @code{.exe} suffix. This
1991option is useful when using unmodified Unix makefiles on a Microsoft
1992Windows host, since some versions of Windows won't run an image unless
1993it ends in a @code{.exe} suffix.
1994
1995@kindex --gc-sections
1996@kindex --no-gc-sections
1997@cindex garbage collection
c17d87de
NC
1998@item --gc-sections
1999@itemx --no-gc-sections
252b5132 2000Enable garbage collection of unused input sections. It is ignored on
ac69cbc6 2001targets that do not support this option. The default behaviour (of not
b3549761 2002performing this garbage collection) can be restored by specifying
0f088b2a
KT
2003@samp{--no-gc-sections} on the command line. Note that garbage
2004collection for COFF and PE format targets is supported, but the
2005implementation is currently considered to be experimental.
252b5132 2006
d5465ba2
AM
2007@samp{--gc-sections} decides which input sections are used by
2008examining symbols and relocations. The section containing the entry
2009symbol and all sections containing symbols undefined on the
2010command-line will be kept, as will sections containing symbols
2011referenced by dynamic objects. Note that when building shared
2012libraries, the linker must assume that any visible symbol is
2013referenced. Once this initial set of sections has been determined,
2014the linker recursively marks as used any section referenced by their
b69e1ff3
CC
2015relocations. See @samp{--entry}, @samp{--undefined}, and
2016@samp{--gc-keep-exported}.
d5465ba2 2017
ac69cbc6 2018This option can be set when doing a partial link (enabled with option
9d5777a3 2019@samp{-r}). In this case the root of symbols kept must be explicitly
b69e1ff3
CC
2020specified either by one of the options @samp{--entry},
2021@samp{--undefined}, or @samp{--gc-keep-exported} or by a @code{ENTRY}
2022command in the linker script.
ac69cbc6 2023
99fabbc9
JL
2024As a GNU extension, ELF input sections marked with the
2025@code{SHF_GNU_RETAIN} flag will not be garbage collected.
2026
c17d87de
NC
2027@kindex --print-gc-sections
2028@kindex --no-print-gc-sections
2029@cindex garbage collection
2030@item --print-gc-sections
2031@itemx --no-print-gc-sections
2032List all sections removed by garbage collection. The listing is
2033printed on stderr. This option is only effective if garbage
2034collection has been enabled via the @samp{--gc-sections}) option. The
2035default behaviour (of not listing the sections that are removed) can
2036be restored by specifying @samp{--no-print-gc-sections} on the command
2037line.
2038
22185505 2039@kindex --gc-keep-exported
2040@cindex garbage collection
2041@item --gc-keep-exported
2042When @samp{--gc-sections} is enabled, this option prevents garbage
2043collection of unused input sections that contain global symbols having
2044default or protected visibility. This option is intended to be used for
2045executables where unreferenced sections would otherwise be garbage
2046collected regardless of the external visibility of contained symbols.
2047Note that this option has no effect when linking shared objects since
2048it is already the default behaviour. This option is only supported for
2049ELF format targets.
2050
30824704
RM
2051@kindex --print-output-format
2052@cindex output format
2053@item --print-output-format
2054Print the name of the default output format (perhaps influenced by
2055other command-line options). This is the string that would appear
2056in an @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} linker script command (@pxref{File Commands}).
2057
3604cb1f
TG
2058@kindex --print-memory-usage
2059@cindex memory usage
2060@item --print-memory-usage
2061Print used size, total size and used size of memory regions created with
2062the @ref{MEMORY} command. This is useful on embedded targets to have a
2063quick view of amount of free memory. The format of the output has one
2064headline and one line per region. It is both human readable and easily
2065parsable by tools. Here is an example of an output:
2066
2067@smallexample
2068Memory region Used Size Region Size %age Used
2069 ROM: 256 KB 1 MB 25.00%
2070 RAM: 32 B 2 GB 0.00%
2071@end smallexample
2072
252b5132
RH
2073@cindex help
2074@cindex usage
2075@kindex --help
2076@item --help
2077Print a summary of the command-line options on the standard output and exit.
2078
ea20a7da
CC
2079@kindex --target-help
2080@item --target-help
a094d01f 2081Print a summary of all target-specific options on the standard output and exit.
ea20a7da 2082
2509a395
SL
2083@kindex -Map=@var{mapfile}
2084@item -Map=@var{mapfile}
252b5132 2085Print a link map to the file @var{mapfile}. See the description of the
2c72361c
NC
2086@option{-M} option, above. If @var{mapfile} is just the character
2087@code{-} then the map will be written to stdout.
2088
2089Specifying a directory as @var{mapfile} causes the linker map to be
2090written as a file inside the directory. Normally name of the file
2091inside the directory is computed as the basename of the @var{output}
2092file with @code{.map} appended. If however the special character
2093@code{%} is used then this will be replaced by the full path of the
2094output file. Additionally if there are any characters after the
2095@var{%} symbol then @code{.map} will no longer be appended.
2096
2097@smallexample
2098 -o foo.exe -Map=bar [Creates ./bar]
2099 -o ../dir/foo.exe -Map=bar [Creates ./bar]
2100 -o foo.exe -Map=../dir [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.map]
2101 -o ../dir2/foo.exe -Map=../dir [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.map]
2102 -o foo.exe -Map=% [Creates ./foo.exe.map]
2103 -o ../dir/foo.exe -Map=% [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.map]
2104 -o foo.exe -Map=%.bar [Creates ./foo.exe.bar]
2105 -o ../dir/foo.exe -Map=%.bar [Creates ../dir/foo.exe.bar]
2106 -o ../dir2/foo.exe -Map=../dir/% [Creates ../dir/../dir2/foo.exe.map]
2107 -o ../dir2/foo.exe -Map=../dir/%.bar [Creates ../dir/../dir2/foo.exe.bar]
2108@end smallexample
2109
2110It is an error to specify more than one @code{%} character.
2111
2112If the map file already exists then it will be overwritten by this
2113operation.
252b5132
RH
2114
2115@cindex memory usage
2116@kindex --no-keep-memory
2117@item --no-keep-memory
ff5dcc92
SC
2118@command{ld} normally optimizes for speed over memory usage by caching the
2119symbol tables of input files in memory. This option tells @command{ld} to
252b5132 2120instead optimize for memory usage, by rereading the symbol tables as
ff5dcc92 2121necessary. This may be required if @command{ld} runs out of memory space
252b5132
RH
2122while linking a large executable.
2123
2124@kindex --no-undefined
a1ab1d2a 2125@kindex -z defs
97a232d7 2126@kindex -z undefs
252b5132 2127@item --no-undefined
a1ab1d2a 2128@itemx -z defs
560e09e9
NC
2129Report unresolved symbol references from regular object files. This
2130is done even if the linker is creating a non-symbolic shared library.
2131The switch @option{--[no-]allow-shlib-undefined} controls the
2132behaviour for reporting unresolved references found in shared
ece2d90e 2133libraries being linked in.
252b5132 2134
97a232d7
NC
2135The effects of this option can be reverted by using @code{-z undefs}.
2136
aa713662
L
2137@kindex --allow-multiple-definition
2138@kindex -z muldefs
2139@item --allow-multiple-definition
2140@itemx -z muldefs
2141Normally when a symbol is defined multiple times, the linker will
2142report a fatal error. These options allow multiple definitions and the
2143first definition will be used.
2144
b79e8c78 2145@kindex --allow-shlib-undefined
ae9a127f 2146@kindex --no-allow-shlib-undefined
b79e8c78 2147@item --allow-shlib-undefined
ae9a127f 2148@itemx --no-allow-shlib-undefined
903249d7 2149Allows or disallows undefined symbols in shared libraries.
560e09e9
NC
2150This switch is similar to @option{--no-undefined} except that it
2151determines the behaviour when the undefined symbols are in a
2152shared library rather than a regular object file. It does not affect
2153how undefined symbols in regular object files are handled.
2154
903249d7
NC
2155The default behaviour is to report errors for any undefined symbols
2156referenced in shared libraries if the linker is being used to create
2157an executable, but to allow them if the linker is being used to create
2158a shared library.
2159
2160The reasons for allowing undefined symbol references in shared
2161libraries specified at link time are that:
2162
2163@itemize @bullet
2164@item
2165A shared library specified at link time may not be the same as the one
2166that is available at load time, so the symbol might actually be
2167resolvable at load time.
2168@item
2169There are some operating systems, eg BeOS and HPPA, where undefined
2170symbols in shared libraries are normal.
2171
2172The BeOS kernel for example patches shared libraries at load time to
2173select whichever function is most appropriate for the current
2174architecture. This is used, for example, to dynamically select an
2175appropriate memset function.
2176@end itemize
b79e8c78 2177
23ae20f5
NC
2178@kindex --error-handling-script=@var{scriptname}
2179@item --error-handling-script=@var{scriptname}
2180If this option is provided then the linker will invoke
2181@var{scriptname} whenever an error is encountered. Currently however
2182only two kinds of error are supported: missing symbols and missing
2183libraries. Two arguments will be passed to script: the keyword
5c14cc55 2184``undefined-symbol'' or `missing-lib'' and the @var{name} of the
93cf38c0
NC
2185undefined symbol or missing library. The intention is that the script
2186will provide suggestions to the user as to where the symbol or library
23ae20f5
NC
2187might be found. After the script has finished then the normal linker
2188error message will be displayed.
2189
2190The availability of this option is controlled by a configure time
2191switch, so it may not be present in specific implementations.
2192
31941635
L
2193@kindex --no-undefined-version
2194@item --no-undefined-version
2195Normally when a symbol has an undefined version, the linker will ignore
2196it. This option disallows symbols with undefined version and a fatal error
2197will be issued instead.
2198
3e3b46e5
PB
2199@kindex --default-symver
2200@item --default-symver
2201Create and use a default symbol version (the soname) for unversioned
fc0e6df6
PB
2202exported symbols.
2203
2204@kindex --default-imported-symver
2205@item --default-imported-symver
2206Create and use a default symbol version (the soname) for unversioned
2207imported symbols.
3e3b46e5 2208
252b5132
RH
2209@kindex --no-warn-mismatch
2210@item --no-warn-mismatch
ff5dcc92 2211Normally @command{ld} will give an error if you try to link together input
252b5132
RH
2212files that are mismatched for some reason, perhaps because they have
2213been compiled for different processors or for different endiannesses.
ff5dcc92 2214This option tells @command{ld} that it should silently permit such possible
252b5132
RH
2215errors. This option should only be used with care, in cases when you
2216have taken some special action that ensures that the linker errors are
2217inappropriate.
2218
fe7929ce
AM
2219@kindex --no-warn-search-mismatch
2220@item --no-warn-search-mismatch
2221Normally @command{ld} will give a warning if it finds an incompatible
2222library during a library search. This option silences the warning.
2223
252b5132
RH
2224@kindex --no-whole-archive
2225@item --no-whole-archive
ff5dcc92 2226Turn off the effect of the @option{--whole-archive} option for subsequent
252b5132
RH
2227archive files.
2228
2229@cindex output file after errors
2230@kindex --noinhibit-exec
2231@item --noinhibit-exec
2232Retain the executable output file whenever it is still usable.
2233Normally, the linker will not produce an output file if it encounters
2234errors during the link process; it exits without writing an output file
2235when it issues any error whatsoever.
2236
0a9c1c8e
CD
2237@kindex -nostdlib
2238@item -nostdlib
2239Only search library directories explicitly specified on the
2240command line. Library directories specified in linker scripts
2241(including linker scripts specified on the command line) are ignored.
2242
252b5132 2243@ifclear SingleFormat
2509a395
SL
2244@kindex --oformat=@var{output-format}
2245@item --oformat=@var{output-format}
ff5dcc92
SC
2246@command{ld} may be configured to support more than one kind of object
2247file. If your @command{ld} is configured this way, you can use the
252b5132 2248@samp{--oformat} option to specify the binary format for the output
ff5dcc92
SC
2249object file. Even when @command{ld} is configured to support alternative
2250object formats, you don't usually need to specify this, as @command{ld}
252b5132
RH
2251should be configured to produce as a default output format the most
2252usual format on each machine. @var{output-format} is a text string, the
2253name of a particular format supported by the BFD libraries. (You can
2254list the available binary formats with @samp{objdump -i}.) The script
2255command @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} can also specify the output format, but
2256this option overrides it. @xref{BFD}.
2257@end ifclear
2258
76359541
TP
2259@kindex --out-implib
2260@item --out-implib @var{file}
2261Create an import library in @var{file} corresponding to the executable
2262the linker is generating (eg. a DLL or ELF program). This import
2263library (which should be called @code{*.dll.a} or @code{*.a} for DLLs)
2264may be used to link clients against the generated executable; this
2265behaviour makes it possible to skip a separate import library creation
2266step (eg. @code{dlltool} for DLLs). This option is only available for
2267the i386 PE and ELF targetted ports of the linker.
2268
36af4a4e
JJ
2269@kindex -pie
2270@kindex --pic-executable
2271@item -pie
2272@itemx --pic-executable
2273@cindex position independent executables
2274Create a position independent executable. This is currently only supported on
2275ELF platforms. Position independent executables are similar to shared
2276libraries in that they are relocated by the dynamic linker to the virtual
7e7d5768 2277address the OS chooses for them (which can vary between invocations). Like
36af4a4e
JJ
2278normal dynamically linked executables they can be executed and symbols
2279defined in the executable cannot be overridden by shared libraries.
2280
e8f6c2a5
FS
2281@kindex -no-pie
2282@item -no-pie
2283@cindex position dependent executables
2284Create a position dependent executable. This is the default.
2285
252b5132
RH
2286@kindex -qmagic
2287@item -qmagic
2288This option is ignored for Linux compatibility.
2289
2290@kindex -Qy
2291@item -Qy
2292This option is ignored for SVR4 compatibility.
2293
2294@kindex --relax
2295@cindex synthesizing linker
2296@cindex relaxing addressing modes
28d5f677 2297@cindex --no-relax
252b5132 2298@item --relax
28d5f677 2299@itemx --no-relax
a1ab1d2a 2300An option with machine dependent effects.
252b5132
RH
2301@ifset GENERIC
2302This option is only supported on a few targets.
2303@end ifset
2304@ifset H8300
ff5dcc92 2305@xref{H8/300,,@command{ld} and the H8/300}.
252b5132 2306@end ifset
e0001a05
NC
2307@ifset XTENSA
2308@xref{Xtensa,, @command{ld} and Xtensa Processors}.
2309@end ifset
93fd0973
SC
2310@ifset M68HC11
2311@xref{M68HC11/68HC12,,@command{ld} and the 68HC11 and 68HC12}.
2312@end ifset
78058a5e
SL
2313@ifset NIOSII
2314@xref{Nios II,,@command{ld} and the Altera Nios II}.
2315@end ifset
2a60a7a8
AM
2316@ifset POWERPC
2317@xref{PowerPC ELF32,,@command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support}.
2318@end ifset
252b5132 2319
ccd9fae5 2320On some platforms the @option{--relax} option performs target specific,
28d5f677
NC
2321global optimizations that become possible when the linker resolves
2322addressing in the program, such as relaxing address modes,
2323synthesizing new instructions, selecting shorter version of current
11e7fd74 2324instructions, and combining constant values.
252b5132
RH
2325
2326On some platforms these link time global optimizations may make symbolic
2327debugging of the resulting executable impossible.
2328@ifset GENERIC
28d5f677
NC
2329This is known to be the case for the Matsushita MN10200 and MN10300
2330family of processors.
252b5132
RH
2331@end ifset
2332
ccd9fae5
NC
2333On platforms where the feature is supported, the option
2334@option{--no-relax} will disable it.
28d5f677 2335
ccd9fae5
NC
2336On platforms where the feature is not supported, both @option{--relax}
2337and @option{--no-relax} are accepted, but ignored.
5c14cc55 2338
252b5132
RH
2339@cindex retaining specified symbols
2340@cindex stripping all but some symbols
2341@cindex symbols, retaining selectively
2509a395
SL
2342@kindex --retain-symbols-file=@var{filename}
2343@item --retain-symbols-file=@var{filename}
252b5132
RH
2344Retain @emph{only} the symbols listed in the file @var{filename},
2345discarding all others. @var{filename} is simply a flat file, with one
2346symbol name per line. This option is especially useful in environments
2347@ifset GENERIC
2348(such as VxWorks)
2349@end ifset
2350where a large global symbol table is accumulated gradually, to conserve
2351run-time memory.
2352
2353@samp{--retain-symbols-file} does @emph{not} discard undefined symbols,
2354or symbols needed for relocations.
2355
2356You may only specify @samp{--retain-symbols-file} once in the command
2357line. It overrides @samp{-s} and @samp{-S}.
2358
2359@ifset GENERIC
2509a395 2360@item -rpath=@var{dir}
252b5132 2361@cindex runtime library search path
2509a395 2362@kindex -rpath=@var{dir}
252b5132 2363Add a directory to the runtime library search path. This is used when
ff5dcc92 2364linking an ELF executable with shared objects. All @option{-rpath}
252b5132 2365arguments are concatenated and passed to the runtime linker, which uses
c1b00498
MR
2366them to locate shared objects at runtime.
2367
2368The @option{-rpath} option is also used when locating shared objects which
2369are needed by shared objects explicitly included in the link; see the
2370description of the @option{-rpath-link} option. Searching @option{-rpath}
2371in this way is only supported by native linkers and cross linkers which
2372have been configured with the @option{--with-sysroot} option.
2373
2374If @option{-rpath} is not used when linking an ELF executable, the
2375contents of the environment variable @code{LD_RUN_PATH} will be used if it
2376is defined.
252b5132 2377
ff5dcc92 2378The @option{-rpath} option may also be used on SunOS. By default, on
d8506323 2379SunOS, the linker will form a runtime search path out of all the
ff5dcc92
SC
2380@option{-L} options it is given. If a @option{-rpath} option is used, the
2381runtime search path will be formed exclusively using the @option{-rpath}
2382options, ignoring the @option{-L} options. This can be useful when using
2383gcc, which adds many @option{-L} options which may be on NFS mounted
b45619c0 2384file systems.
252b5132 2385
ff5dcc92 2386For compatibility with other ELF linkers, if the @option{-R} option is
252b5132 2387followed by a directory name, rather than a file name, it is treated as
ff5dcc92 2388the @option{-rpath} option.
252b5132
RH
2389@end ifset
2390
2391@ifset GENERIC
2392@cindex link-time runtime library search path
2509a395
SL
2393@kindex -rpath-link=@var{dir}
2394@item -rpath-link=@var{dir}
252b5132
RH
2395When using ELF or SunOS, one shared library may require another. This
2396happens when an @code{ld -shared} link includes a shared library as one
2397of the input files.
2398
2399When the linker encounters such a dependency when doing a non-shared,
2400non-relocatable link, it will automatically try to locate the required
2401shared library and include it in the link, if it is not included
ff5dcc92 2402explicitly. In such a case, the @option{-rpath-link} option
252b5132 2403specifies the first set of directories to search. The
ff5dcc92 2404@option{-rpath-link} option may specify a sequence of directory names
252b5132
RH
2405either by specifying a list of names separated by colons, or by
2406appearing multiple times.
2407
e680a6b6
NC
2408The tokens @var{$ORIGIN} and @var{$LIB} can appear in these search
2409directories. They will be replaced by the full path to the directory
2410containing the program or shared object in the case of @var{$ORIGIN}
2411and either @samp{lib} - for 32-bit binaries - or @samp{lib64} - for
241264-bit binaries - in the case of @var{$LIB}.
2413
2414The alternative form of these tokens - @var{$@{ORIGIN@}} and
2415@var{$@{LIB@}} can also be used. The token @var{$PLATFORM} is not
2416supported.
2417
28c309a2
NC
2418This option should be used with caution as it overrides the search path
2419that may have been hard compiled into a shared library. In such a case it
2420is possible to use unintentionally a different search path than the
2421runtime linker would do.
2422
252b5132 2423The linker uses the following search paths to locate required shared
ece2d90e 2424libraries:
d8e4137b 2425
252b5132
RH
2426@enumerate
2427@item
ff5dcc92 2428Any directories specified by @option{-rpath-link} options.
252b5132 2429@item
ff5dcc92
SC
2430Any directories specified by @option{-rpath} options. The difference
2431between @option{-rpath} and @option{-rpath-link} is that directories
2432specified by @option{-rpath} options are included in the executable and
2433used at runtime, whereas the @option{-rpath-link} option is only effective
ece2d90e
NC
2434at link time. Searching @option{-rpath} in this way is only supported
2435by native linkers and cross linkers which have been configured with
2436the @option{--with-sysroot} option.
252b5132 2437@item
e2a83dd0
NC
2438On an ELF system, for native linkers, if the @option{-rpath} and
2439@option{-rpath-link} options were not used, search the contents of the
2440environment variable @code{LD_RUN_PATH}.
252b5132 2441@item
ff5dcc92
SC
2442On SunOS, if the @option{-rpath} option was not used, search any
2443directories specified using @option{-L} options.
252b5132 2444@item
a1b8d843 2445For a native linker, search the contents of the environment
e2a83dd0 2446variable @code{LD_LIBRARY_PATH}.
252b5132 2447@item
ec4eb78a
L
2448For a native ELF linker, the directories in @code{DT_RUNPATH} or
2449@code{DT_RPATH} of a shared library are searched for shared
2450libraries needed by it. The @code{DT_RPATH} entries are ignored if
2451@code{DT_RUNPATH} entries exist.
2452@item
d8e4137b
NC
2453For a linker for a Linux system, if the file @file{/etc/ld.so.conf}
2454exists, the list of directories found in that file. Note: the path
2455to this file is prefixed with the @code{sysroot} value, if that is
2456defined, and then any @code{prefix} string if the linker was
2457configured with the @command{--prefix=<path>} option.
2458@item
2459For a native linker on a FreeBSD system, any directories specified by
2460the @code{_PATH_ELF_HINTS} macro defined in the @file{elf-hints.h}
2461header file.
2462@item
364d7729
AM
2463Any directories specified by a @code{SEARCH_DIR} command in a
2464linker script given on the command line, including scripts specified
2465by @option{-T} (but not @option{-dT}).
2466@item
2467The default directories, normally @file{/lib} and @file{/usr/lib}.
2468@item
2469Any directories specified by a plugin LDPT_SET_EXTRA_LIBRARY_PATH.
2470@item
2471Any directories specified by a @code{SEARCH_DIR} command in a default
2472linker script.
252b5132
RH
2473@end enumerate
2474
6418520e
NC
2475Note however on Linux based systems there is an additional caveat: If
2476the @option{--as-needed} option is active @emph{and} a shared library
2477is located which would normally satisfy the search @emph{and} this
2478library does not have DT_NEEDED tag for @file{libc.so}
2479@emph{and} there is a shared library later on in the set of search
2480directories which also satisfies the search @emph{and}
2481this second shared library does have a DT_NEEDED tag for
2482@file{libc.so} @emph{then} the second library will be selected instead
2483of the first.
2484
252b5132
RH
2485If the required shared library is not found, the linker will issue a
2486warning and continue with the link.
6418520e 2487
252b5132
RH
2488@end ifset
2489
2490@kindex -shared
2491@kindex -Bshareable
2492@item -shared
2493@itemx -Bshareable
2494@cindex shared libraries
2495Create a shared library. This is currently only supported on ELF, XCOFF
2496and SunOS platforms. On SunOS, the linker will automatically create a
ff5dcc92 2497shared library if the @option{-e} option is not used and there are
252b5132
RH
2498undefined symbols in the link.
2499
252b5132 2500@kindex --sort-common
2509a395
SL
2501@item --sort-common
2502@itemx --sort-common=ascending
2503@itemx --sort-common=descending
de7dd2bd
NC
2504This option tells @command{ld} to sort the common symbols by alignment in
2505ascending or descending order when it places them in the appropriate output
2506sections. The symbol alignments considered are sixteen-byte or larger,
2507eight-byte, four-byte, two-byte, and one-byte. This is to prevent gaps
2508between symbols due to alignment constraints. If no sorting order is
2509specified, then descending order is assumed.
252b5132 2510
2509a395
SL
2511@kindex --sort-section=name
2512@item --sort-section=name
bcaa7b3e
L
2513This option will apply @code{SORT_BY_NAME} to all wildcard section
2514patterns in the linker script.
2515
2509a395
SL
2516@kindex --sort-section=alignment
2517@item --sort-section=alignment
bcaa7b3e
L
2518This option will apply @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} to all wildcard section
2519patterns in the linker script.
2520
a70f34c0
NC
2521@kindex --spare-dynamic-tags
2522@item --spare-dynamic-tags=@var{count}
2523This option specifies the number of empty slots to leave in the
2524.dynamic section of ELF shared objects. Empty slots may be needed by
2525post processing tools, such as the prelinker. The default is 5.
2526
252b5132 2527@kindex --split-by-file
2509a395 2528@item --split-by-file[=@var{size}]
ff5dcc92 2529Similar to @option{--split-by-reloc} but creates a new output section for
a854a4a7
AM
2530each input file when @var{size} is reached. @var{size} defaults to a
2531size of 1 if not given.
252b5132
RH
2532
2533@kindex --split-by-reloc
2509a395 2534@item --split-by-reloc[=@var{count}]
a854a4a7 2535Tries to creates extra sections in the output file so that no single
252b5132 2536output section in the file contains more than @var{count} relocations.
a854a4a7 2537This is useful when generating huge relocatable files for downloading into
252b5132
RH
2538certain real time kernels with the COFF object file format; since COFF
2539cannot represent more than 65535 relocations in a single section. Note
2540that this will fail to work with object file formats which do not
2541support arbitrary sections. The linker will not split up individual
2542input sections for redistribution, so if a single input section contains
2543more than @var{count} relocations one output section will contain that
a854a4a7 2544many relocations. @var{count} defaults to a value of 32768.
252b5132
RH
2545
2546@kindex --stats
2547@item --stats
2548Compute and display statistics about the operation of the linker, such
2549as execution time and memory usage.
2550
2509a395 2551@kindex --sysroot=@var{directory}
e2243057
RS
2552@item --sysroot=@var{directory}
2553Use @var{directory} as the location of the sysroot, overriding the
2554configure-time default. This option is only supported by linkers
2555that were configured using @option{--with-sysroot}.
2556
a70f34c0
NC
2557@kindex --task-link
2558@item --task-link
2559This is used by COFF/PE based targets to create a task-linked object
2560file where all of the global symbols have been converted to statics.
2561
252b5132
RH
2562@kindex --traditional-format
2563@cindex traditional format
2564@item --traditional-format
ff5dcc92
SC
2565For some targets, the output of @command{ld} is different in some ways from
2566the output of some existing linker. This switch requests @command{ld} to
252b5132
RH
2567use the traditional format instead.
2568
2569@cindex dbx
ff5dcc92 2570For example, on SunOS, @command{ld} combines duplicate entries in the
252b5132
RH
2571symbol string table. This can reduce the size of an output file with
2572full debugging information by over 30 percent. Unfortunately, the SunOS
2573@code{dbx} program can not read the resulting program (@code{gdb} has no
ff5dcc92 2574trouble). The @samp{--traditional-format} switch tells @command{ld} to not
252b5132
RH
2575combine duplicate entries.
2576
2509a395
SL
2577@kindex --section-start=@var{sectionname}=@var{org}
2578@item --section-start=@var{sectionname}=@var{org}
176355da
NC
2579Locate a section in the output file at the absolute
2580address given by @var{org}. You may use this option as many
2581times as necessary to locate multiple sections in the command
2582line.
2583@var{org} must be a single hexadecimal integer;
2584for compatibility with other linkers, you may omit the leading
2585@samp{0x} usually associated with hexadecimal values. @emph{Note:} there
2586should be no white space between @var{sectionname}, the equals
2587sign (``@key{=}''), and @var{org}.
2588
2509a395
SL
2589@kindex -Tbss=@var{org}
2590@kindex -Tdata=@var{org}
2591@kindex -Ttext=@var{org}
252b5132 2592@cindex segment origins, cmd line
2509a395
SL
2593@item -Tbss=@var{org}
2594@itemx -Tdata=@var{org}
2595@itemx -Ttext=@var{org}
2596Same as @option{--section-start}, with @code{.bss}, @code{.data} or
a6e02871 2597@code{.text} as the @var{sectionname}.
252b5132 2598
2509a395
SL
2599@kindex -Ttext-segment=@var{org}
2600@item -Ttext-segment=@var{org}
258795f5 2601@cindex text segment origin, cmd line
2b8c06a3
L
2602When creating an ELF executable, it will set the address of the first
2603byte of the text segment.
258795f5 2604
9d5777a3
RM
2605@kindex -Trodata-segment=@var{org}
2606@item -Trodata-segment=@var{org}
2607@cindex rodata segment origin, cmd line
2608When creating an ELF executable or shared object for a target where
2609the read-only data is in its own segment separate from the executable
2610text, it will set the address of the first byte of the read-only data segment.
2611
0d705e9f
AM
2612@kindex -Tldata-segment=@var{org}
2613@item -Tldata-segment=@var{org}
2614@cindex ldata segment origin, cmd line
2615When creating an ELF executable or shared object for x86-64 medium memory
2616model, it will set the address of the first byte of the ldata segment.
2617
560e09e9
NC
2618@kindex --unresolved-symbols
2619@item --unresolved-symbols=@var{method}
2620Determine how to handle unresolved symbols. There are four possible
2621values for @samp{method}:
2622
2623@table @samp
2624@item ignore-all
da8bce14 2625Do not report any unresolved symbols.
560e09e9
NC
2626
2627@item report-all
da8bce14 2628Report all unresolved symbols. This is the default.
560e09e9
NC
2629
2630@item ignore-in-object-files
2631Report unresolved symbols that are contained in shared libraries, but
2632ignore them if they come from regular object files.
2633
2634@item ignore-in-shared-libs
2635Report unresolved symbols that come from regular object files, but
2636ignore them if they come from shared libraries. This can be useful
2637when creating a dynamic binary and it is known that all the shared
2638libraries that it should be referencing are included on the linker's
2639command line.
2640@end table
2641
2642The behaviour for shared libraries on their own can also be controlled
2643by the @option{--[no-]allow-shlib-undefined} option.
2644
2645Normally the linker will generate an error message for each reported
2646unresolved symbol but the option @option{--warn-unresolved-symbols}
2647can change this to a warning.
2648
1715a13c
L
2649@kindex --verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
2650@cindex verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
252b5132 2651@item --dll-verbose
1715a13c 2652@itemx --verbose[=@var{NUMBER}]
ff5dcc92 2653Display the version number for @command{ld} and list the linker emulations
252b5132 2654supported. Display which input files can and cannot be opened. Display
1715a13c
L
2655the linker script being used by the linker. If the optional @var{NUMBER}
2656argument > 1, plugin symbol status will also be displayed.
252b5132
RH
2657
2658@kindex --version-script=@var{version-scriptfile}
2659@cindex version script, symbol versions
2509a395 2660@item --version-script=@var{version-scriptfile}
252b5132
RH
2661Specify the name of a version script to the linker. This is typically
2662used when creating shared libraries to specify additional information
36f63dca 2663about the version hierarchy for the library being created. This option
09e2aba4
DK
2664is only fully supported on ELF platforms which support shared libraries;
2665see @ref{VERSION}. It is partially supported on PE platforms, which can
2666use version scripts to filter symbol visibility in auto-export mode: any
2667symbols marked @samp{local} in the version script will not be exported.
2668@xref{WIN32}.
252b5132 2669
7ce691ae 2670@kindex --warn-common
252b5132
RH
2671@cindex warnings, on combining symbols
2672@cindex combining symbols, warnings on
2673@item --warn-common
2674Warn when a common symbol is combined with another common symbol or with
11e7fd74 2675a symbol definition. Unix linkers allow this somewhat sloppy practice,
252b5132
RH
2676but linkers on some other operating systems do not. This option allows
2677you to find potential problems from combining global symbols.
11e7fd74 2678Unfortunately, some C libraries use this practice, so you may get some
252b5132
RH
2679warnings about symbols in the libraries as well as in your programs.
2680
2681There are three kinds of global symbols, illustrated here by C examples:
2682
2683@table @samp
2684@item int i = 1;
2685A definition, which goes in the initialized data section of the output
2686file.
2687
2688@item extern int i;
2689An undefined reference, which does not allocate space.
2690There must be either a definition or a common symbol for the
2691variable somewhere.
2692
2693@item int i;
2694A common symbol. If there are only (one or more) common symbols for a
2695variable, it goes in the uninitialized data area of the output file.
2696The linker merges multiple common symbols for the same variable into a
2697single symbol. If they are of different sizes, it picks the largest
2698size. The linker turns a common symbol into a declaration, if there is
2699a definition of the same variable.
2700@end table
2701
2702The @samp{--warn-common} option can produce five kinds of warnings.
2703Each warning consists of a pair of lines: the first describes the symbol
2704just encountered, and the second describes the previous symbol
2705encountered with the same name. One or both of the two symbols will be
2706a common symbol.
2707
2708@enumerate
2709@item
2710Turning a common symbol into a reference, because there is already a
2711definition for the symbol.
2712@smallexample
2713@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2714 overridden by definition
2715@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: defined here
2716@end smallexample
2717
2718@item
2719Turning a common symbol into a reference, because a later definition for
2720the symbol is encountered. This is the same as the previous case,
2721except that the symbols are encountered in a different order.
2722@smallexample
2723@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: definition of `@var{symbol}'
2724 overriding common
2725@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common is here
2726@end smallexample
2727
2728@item
2729Merging a common symbol with a previous same-sized common symbol.
2730@smallexample
2731@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: multiple common
2732 of `@var{symbol}'
2733@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: previous common is here
2734@end smallexample
2735
2736@item
2737Merging a common symbol with a previous larger common symbol.
2738@smallexample
2739@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2740 overridden by larger common
2741@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: larger common is here
2742@end smallexample
2743
2744@item
2745Merging a common symbol with a previous smaller common symbol. This is
2746the same as the previous case, except that the symbols are
2747encountered in a different order.
2748@smallexample
2749@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: common of `@var{symbol}'
2750 overriding smaller common
2751@var{file}(@var{section}): warning: smaller common is here
2752@end smallexample
2753@end enumerate
2754
2755@kindex --warn-constructors
2756@item --warn-constructors
2757Warn if any global constructors are used. This is only useful for a few
2758object file formats. For formats like COFF or ELF, the linker can not
2759detect the use of global constructors.
2760
65daf5be 2761@kindex --warn-execstack
bd7d326d 2762@cindex warnings, on executable stack
65daf5be
NC
2763@cindex executable stack, warnings on
2764@item --warn-execstack
2765@itemx --no-warn-execstack
2766On ELF platforms this option controls how the linker generates warning
2767messages when it creates an output file with an executable stack. By
2768default the linker will not warn if the @command{-z execstack} command
2769line option has been used, but this behaviour can be overridden by the
2770@option{--warn-execstack} option.
2771
2772On the other hand the linker will normally warn if the stack is made
2773executable because one or more of the input files need an execuable
2774stack and neither of the @command{-z execstack} or @command{-z
bd7d326d 2775noexecstack} command line options have been specified. This warning
65daf5be
NC
2776can be disabled via the @command{--no-warn-execstack} option.
2777
2778Note: ELF format input files specify that they need an executable
2779stack by having a @var{.note.GNU-stack} section with the executable
2780bit set in its section flags. They can specify that they do not need
2781an executable stack by having that section, but without the executable
2782flag bit set. If an input file does not have a @var{.note.GNU-stack}
2783section present then the default behaviour is target specific. For
2784some targets, then absence of such a section implies that an
2785executable stack @emph{is} required. This is often a problem for hand
2786crafted assembler files.
2787
252b5132
RH
2788@kindex --warn-multiple-gp
2789@item --warn-multiple-gp
2790Warn if multiple global pointer values are required in the output file.
2791This is only meaningful for certain processors, such as the Alpha.
2792Specifically, some processors put large-valued constants in a special
2793section. A special register (the global pointer) points into the middle
2794of this section, so that constants can be loaded efficiently via a
2795base-register relative addressing mode. Since the offset in
2796base-register relative mode is fixed and relatively small (e.g., 16
2797bits), this limits the maximum size of the constant pool. Thus, in
2798large programs, it is often necessary to use multiple global pointer
2799values in order to be able to address all possible constants. This
2800option causes a warning to be issued whenever this case occurs.
2801
2802@kindex --warn-once
2803@cindex warnings, on undefined symbols
2804@cindex undefined symbols, warnings on
2805@item --warn-once
2806Only warn once for each undefined symbol, rather than once per module
2807which refers to it.
2808
ba951afb
NC
2809@kindex --warn-rwx-segments
2810@cindex warnings, on writeable and exectuable segments
2811@cindex executable segments, warnings on
2812@item --warn-rwx-segments
2813@itemx --no-warn-rwx-segments
2814Warn if the linker creates a loadable, non-zero sized segment that has
2815all three of the read, write and execute permission flags set. Such a
2816segment represents a potential security vulnerability. In addition
2817warnings will be generated if a thread local storage segment is
2818created with the execute permission flag set, regardless of whether or
2819not it has the read and/or write flags set.
2820
2821These warnings are enabled by default. They can be disabled via the
2822@option{--no-warn-rwx-segments} option and re-enabled via the
2823@option{--warn-rwx-segments} option.
2824
252b5132
RH
2825@kindex --warn-section-align
2826@cindex warnings, on section alignment
2827@cindex section alignment, warnings on
2828@item --warn-section-align
2829Warn if the address of an output section is changed because of
2830alignment. Typically, the alignment will be set by an input section.
2831The address will only be changed if it not explicitly specified; that
2832is, if the @code{SECTIONS} command does not specify a start address for
2833the section (@pxref{SECTIONS}).
2834
a6dbf402
L
2835@kindex --warn-textrel
2836@item --warn-textrel
2837Warn if the linker adds DT_TEXTREL to a position-independent executable
2838or shared object.
8fdd7217 2839
a0c402a5
L
2840@kindex --warn-alternate-em
2841@item --warn-alternate-em
2842Warn if an object has alternate ELF machine code.
2843
560e09e9
NC
2844@kindex --warn-unresolved-symbols
2845@item --warn-unresolved-symbols
2846If the linker is going to report an unresolved symbol (see the option
2847@option{--unresolved-symbols}) it will normally generate an error.
2848This option makes it generate a warning instead.
2849
2850@kindex --error-unresolved-symbols
2851@item --error-unresolved-symbols
2852This restores the linker's default behaviour of generating errors when
2853it is reporting unresolved symbols.
2854
252b5132
RH
2855@kindex --whole-archive
2856@cindex including an entire archive
2857@item --whole-archive
2858For each archive mentioned on the command line after the
ff5dcc92 2859@option{--whole-archive} option, include every object file in the archive
252b5132
RH
2860in the link, rather than searching the archive for the required object
2861files. This is normally used to turn an archive file into a shared
2862library, forcing every object to be included in the resulting shared
2863library. This option may be used more than once.
2864
7ec229ce 2865Two notes when using this option from gcc: First, gcc doesn't know
ff5dcc92
SC
2866about this option, so you have to use @option{-Wl,-whole-archive}.
2867Second, don't forget to use @option{-Wl,-no-whole-archive} after your
7ec229ce
DD
2868list of archives, because gcc will add its own list of archives to
2869your link and you may not want this flag to affect those as well.
2870
2509a395
SL
2871@kindex --wrap=@var{symbol}
2872@item --wrap=@var{symbol}
252b5132
RH
2873Use a wrapper function for @var{symbol}. Any undefined reference to
2874@var{symbol} will be resolved to @code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. Any
2875undefined reference to @code{__real_@var{symbol}} will be resolved to
2876@var{symbol}.
2877
2878This can be used to provide a wrapper for a system function. The
2879wrapper function should be called @code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. If it
2880wishes to call the system function, it should call
2881@code{__real_@var{symbol}}.
2882
2883Here is a trivial example:
2884
2885@smallexample
2886void *
cc2f008e 2887__wrap_malloc (size_t c)
252b5132 2888@{
cc2f008e 2889 printf ("malloc called with %zu\n", c);
252b5132
RH
2890 return __real_malloc (c);
2891@}
2892@end smallexample
2893
ff5dcc92 2894If you link other code with this file using @option{--wrap malloc}, then
252b5132
RH
2895all calls to @code{malloc} will call the function @code{__wrap_malloc}
2896instead. The call to @code{__real_malloc} in @code{__wrap_malloc} will
2897call the real @code{malloc} function.
2898
2899You may wish to provide a @code{__real_malloc} function as well, so that
ff5dcc92 2900links without the @option{--wrap} option will succeed. If you do this,
252b5132
RH
2901you should not put the definition of @code{__real_malloc} in the same
2902file as @code{__wrap_malloc}; if you do, the assembler may resolve the
2903call before the linker has a chance to wrap it to @code{malloc}.
2904
4ea904ed
SH
2905Only undefined references are replaced by the linker. So, translation unit
2906internal references to @var{symbol} are not resolved to
2907@code{__wrap_@var{symbol}}. In the next example, the call to @code{f} in
2908@code{g} is not resolved to @code{__wrap_f}.
2909
2910@smallexample
2911int
2912f (void)
2913@{
2914 return 123;
2915@}
2916
2917int
2918g (void)
2919@{
2920 return f();
2921@}
2922@end smallexample
2923
6aa29e7b 2924@kindex --eh-frame-hdr
29063f8b 2925@kindex --no-eh-frame-hdr
6aa29e7b 2926@item --eh-frame-hdr
29063f8b
NC
2927@itemx --no-eh-frame-hdr
2928Request (@option{--eh-frame-hdr}) or suppress
2929(@option{--no-eh-frame-hdr}) the creation of @code{.eh_frame_hdr}
2930section and ELF @code{PT_GNU_EH_FRAME} segment header.
6aa29e7b 2931
e41b3a13
JJ
2932@kindex --ld-generated-unwind-info
2933@item --no-ld-generated-unwind-info
2934Request creation of @code{.eh_frame} unwind info for linker
2935generated code sections like PLT. This option is on by default
cf0e0a0b 2936if linker generated unwind info is supported. This option also
1bd123bd 2937controls the generation of @code{.sframe} stack trace info for linker
cf0e0a0b 2938generated code sections like PLT.
e41b3a13 2939
6c1439be
L
2940@kindex --enable-new-dtags
2941@kindex --disable-new-dtags
2942@item --enable-new-dtags
2943@itemx --disable-new-dtags
2944This linker can create the new dynamic tags in ELF. But the older ELF
2945systems may not understand them. If you specify
b1b00fcc
MF
2946@option{--enable-new-dtags}, the new dynamic tags will be created as needed
2947and older dynamic tags will be omitted.
ff5dcc92 2948If you specify @option{--disable-new-dtags}, no new dynamic tags will be
6c1439be
L
2949created. By default, the new dynamic tags are not created. Note that
2950those options are only available for ELF systems.
2951
2d643429 2952@kindex --hash-size=@var{number}
e185dd51 2953@item --hash-size=@var{number}
2d643429
NC
2954Set the default size of the linker's hash tables to a prime number
2955close to @var{number}. Increasing this value can reduce the length of
2956time it takes the linker to perform its tasks, at the expense of
2957increasing the linker's memory requirements. Similarly reducing this
2958value can reduce the memory requirements at the expense of speed.
2959
fdc90cb4
JJ
2960@kindex --hash-style=@var{style}
2961@item --hash-style=@var{style}
2962Set the type of linker's hash table(s). @var{style} can be either
2963@code{sysv} for classic ELF @code{.hash} section, @code{gnu} for
2964new style GNU @code{.gnu.hash} section or @code{both} for both
2965the classic ELF @code{.hash} and new style GNU @code{.gnu.hash}
c8455dc9
NC
2966hash tables. The default depends upon how the linker was configured,
2967but for most Linux based systems it will be @code{both}.
fdc90cb4 2968
0ce398f1
L
2969@kindex --compress-debug-sections=none
2970@kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib
2971@kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu
2972@kindex --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi
2cac01e3 2973@kindex --compress-debug-sections=zstd
0ce398f1
L
2974@item --compress-debug-sections=none
2975@itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib
2976@itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu
2977@itemx --compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi
2cac01e3 2978@itemx --compress-debug-sections=zstd
9af89fba
NC
2979On ELF platforms, these options control how DWARF debug sections are
2980compressed using zlib.
2981
2982@option{--compress-debug-sections=none} doesn't compress DWARF debug
2983sections. @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gnu} compresses
2984DWARF debug sections and renames them to begin with @samp{.zdebug}
2985instead of @samp{.debug}. @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi}
2986also compresses DWARF debug sections, but rather than renaming them it
2987sets the SHF_COMPRESSED flag in the sections' headers.
2988
2989The @option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib} option is an alias for
2990@option{--compress-debug-sections=zlib-gabi}.
2991
2cac01e3
FS
2992@option{--compress-debug-sections=zstd} compresses DWARF debug sections using
2993zstd.
2994
9af89fba
NC
2995Note that this option overrides any compression in input debug
2996sections, so if a binary is linked with @option{--compress-debug-sections=none}
2997for example, then any compressed debug sections in input files will be
2998uncompressed before they are copied into the output binary.
2999
3000The default compression behaviour varies depending upon the target
3001involved and the configure options used to build the toolchain. The
3002default can be determined by examining the output from the linker's
3003@option{--help} option.
0ce398f1 3004
35835446
JR
3005@kindex --reduce-memory-overheads
3006@item --reduce-memory-overheads
3007This option reduces memory requirements at ld runtime, at the expense of
f2a8f148 3008linking speed. This was introduced to select the old O(n^2) algorithm
35835446 3009for link map file generation, rather than the new O(n) algorithm which uses
2d643429
NC
3010about 40% more memory for symbol storage.
3011
4f9c04f7 3012Another effect of the switch is to set the default hash table size to
2d643429 30131021, which again saves memory at the cost of lengthening the linker's
a85785bc 3014run time. This is not done however if the @option{--hash-size} switch
2d643429
NC
3015has been used.
3016
3017The @option{--reduce-memory-overheads} switch may be also be used to
3018enable other tradeoffs in future versions of the linker.
35835446 3019
a8dde0a2
L
3020@kindex --max-cache-size=@var{size}
3021@item --max-cache-size=@var{size}
3022@command{ld} normally caches the relocation information and symbol tables
3023of input files in memory with the unlimited size. This option sets the
3024maximum cache size to @var{size}.
3025
c0065db7
RM
3026@kindex --build-id
3027@kindex --build-id=@var{style}
3028@item --build-id
3029@itemx --build-id=@var{style}
61e2488c 3030Request the creation of a @code{.note.gnu.build-id} ELF note section
6033bf41 3031or a @code{.buildid} COFF section. The contents of the note are
61e2488c
JT
3032unique bits identifying this linked file. @var{style} can be
3033@code{uuid} to use 128 random bits, @code{sha1} to use a 160-bit
3034@sc{SHA1} hash on the normative parts of the output contents,
3035@code{md5} to use a 128-bit @sc{MD5} hash on the normative parts of
3036the output contents, or @code{0x@var{hexstring}} to use a chosen bit
3037string specified as an even number of hexadecimal digits (@code{-} and
3038@code{:} characters between digit pairs are ignored). If @var{style}
3039is omitted, @code{sha1} is used.
24382dca
RM
3040
3041The @code{md5} and @code{sha1} styles produces an identifier
3042that is always the same in an identical output file, but will be
3043unique among all nonidentical output files. It is not intended
3044to be compared as a checksum for the file's contents. A linked
3045file may be changed later by other tools, but the build ID bit
3046string identifying the original linked file does not change.
c0065db7
RM
3047
3048Passing @code{none} for @var{style} disables the setting from any
3049@code{--build-id} options earlier on the command line.
9e2bb0cb
LB
3050
3051@kindex --package-metadata=@var{JSON}
3052@item --package-metadata=@var{JSON}
3053Request the creation of a @code{.note.package} ELF note section. The
3054contents of the note are in JSON format, as per the package metadata
3055specification. For more information see:
3056https://systemd.io/ELF_PACKAGE_METADATA/
3057If the JSON argument is missing/empty then this will disable the
3058creation of the metadata note, if one had been enabled by an earlier
3059occurrence of the --package-metdata option.
3060If the linker has been built with libjansson, then the JSON string
3061will be validated.
252b5132
RH
3062@end table
3063
0285c67d
NC
3064@c man end
3065
36f63dca 3066@subsection Options Specific to i386 PE Targets
252b5132 3067
0285c67d
NC
3068@c man begin OPTIONS
3069
ff5dcc92 3070The i386 PE linker supports the @option{-shared} option, which causes
252b5132
RH
3071the output to be a dynamically linked library (DLL) instead of a
3072normal executable. You should name the output @code{*.dll} when you
3073use this option. In addition, the linker fully supports the standard
3074@code{*.def} files, which may be specified on the linker command line
3075like an object file (in fact, it should precede archives it exports
3076symbols from, to ensure that they get linked in, just like a normal
3077object file).
3078
3079In addition to the options common to all targets, the i386 PE linker
a05a5b64 3080support additional command-line options that are specific to the i386
252b5132
RH
3081PE target. Options that take values may be separated from their
3082values by either a space or an equals sign.
3083
ff5dcc92 3084@table @gcctabopt
252b5132
RH
3085
3086@kindex --add-stdcall-alias
3087@item --add-stdcall-alias
3088If given, symbols with a stdcall suffix (@@@var{nn}) will be exported
3089as-is and also with the suffix stripped.
bb10df36 3090[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3091
3092@kindex --base-file
3093@item --base-file @var{file}
3094Use @var{file} as the name of a file in which to save the base
3095addresses of all the relocations needed for generating DLLs with
3096@file{dlltool}.
bb10df36 3097[This is an i386 PE specific option]
252b5132
RH
3098
3099@kindex --dll
3100@item --dll
3101Create a DLL instead of a regular executable. You may also use
ff5dcc92 3102@option{-shared} or specify a @code{LIBRARY} in a given @code{.def}
252b5132 3103file.
bb10df36 3104[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 3105
88183869
DK
3106@kindex --enable-long-section-names
3107@kindex --disable-long-section-names
3108@item --enable-long-section-names
3109@itemx --disable-long-section-names
56e6cf80 3110The PE variants of the COFF object format add an extension that permits
88183869 3111the use of section names longer than eight characters, the normal limit
56e6cf80
NC
3112for COFF. By default, these names are only allowed in object files, as
3113fully-linked executable images do not carry the COFF string table required
88183869
DK
3114to support the longer names. As a GNU extension, it is possible to
3115allow their use in executable images as well, or to (probably pointlessly!)
3116disallow it in object files, by using these two options. Executable images
3117generated with these long section names are slightly non-standard, carrying
3118as they do a string table, and may generate confusing output when examined
9d5777a3
RM
3119with non-GNU PE-aware tools, such as file viewers and dumpers. However,
3120GDB relies on the use of PE long section names to find Dwarf-2 debug
3efd345c
DK
3121information sections in an executable image at runtime, and so if neither
3122option is specified on the command-line, @command{ld} will enable long
3123section names, overriding the default and technically correct behaviour,
3124when it finds the presence of debug information while linking an executable
3125image and not stripping symbols.
88183869
DK
3126[This option is valid for all PE targeted ports of the linker]
3127
252b5132
RH
3128@kindex --enable-stdcall-fixup
3129@kindex --disable-stdcall-fixup
3130@item --enable-stdcall-fixup
3131@itemx --disable-stdcall-fixup
3132If the link finds a symbol that it cannot resolve, it will attempt to
36f63dca 3133do ``fuzzy linking'' by looking for another defined symbol that differs
252b5132
RH
3134only in the format of the symbol name (cdecl vs stdcall) and will
3135resolve that symbol by linking to the match. For example, the
3136undefined symbol @code{_foo} might be linked to the function
3137@code{_foo@@12}, or the undefined symbol @code{_bar@@16} might be linked
3138to the function @code{_bar}. When the linker does this, it prints a
3139warning, since it normally should have failed to link, but sometimes
3140import libraries generated from third-party dlls may need this feature
ff5dcc92 3141to be usable. If you specify @option{--enable-stdcall-fixup}, this
252b5132 3142feature is fully enabled and warnings are not printed. If you specify
ff5dcc92 3143@option{--disable-stdcall-fixup}, this feature is disabled and such
252b5132 3144mismatches are considered to be errors.
bb10df36 3145[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 3146
522f09cd
KT
3147@kindex --leading-underscore
3148@kindex --no-leading-underscore
3149@item --leading-underscore
3150@itemx --no-leading-underscore
3151For most targets default symbol-prefix is an underscore and is defined
3152in target's description. By this option it is possible to
3153disable/enable the default underscore symbol-prefix.
3154
252b5132
RH
3155@cindex DLLs, creating
3156@kindex --export-all-symbols
3157@item --export-all-symbols
3158If given, all global symbols in the objects used to build a DLL will
3159be exported by the DLL. Note that this is the default if there
3160otherwise wouldn't be any exported symbols. When symbols are
3161explicitly exported via DEF files or implicitly exported via function
3162attributes, the default is to not export anything else unless this
3163option is given. Note that the symbols @code{DllMain@@12},
ece2d90e 3164@code{DllEntryPoint@@0}, @code{DllMainCRTStartup@@12}, and
b044cda1 3165@code{impure_ptr} will not be automatically
ece2d90e
NC
3166exported. Also, symbols imported from other DLLs will not be
3167re-exported, nor will symbols specifying the DLL's internal layout
3168such as those beginning with @code{_head_} or ending with
3169@code{_iname}. In addition, no symbols from @code{libgcc},
b044cda1
CW
3170@code{libstd++}, @code{libmingw32}, or @code{crtX.o} will be exported.
3171Symbols whose names begin with @code{__rtti_} or @code{__builtin_} will
3172not be exported, to help with C++ DLLs. Finally, there is an
ece2d90e 3173extensive list of cygwin-private symbols that are not exported
b044cda1 3174(obviously, this applies on when building DLLs for cygwin targets).
ece2d90e 3175These cygwin-excludes are: @code{_cygwin_dll_entry@@12},
b044cda1 3176@code{_cygwin_crt0_common@@8}, @code{_cygwin_noncygwin_dll_entry@@12},
ece2d90e 3177@code{_fmode}, @code{_impure_ptr}, @code{cygwin_attach_dll},
b044cda1 3178@code{cygwin_premain0}, @code{cygwin_premain1}, @code{cygwin_premain2},
ece2d90e 3179@code{cygwin_premain3}, and @code{environ}.
bb10df36 3180[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3181
3182@kindex --exclude-symbols
1d0a3c9c 3183@item --exclude-symbols @var{symbol},@var{symbol},...
252b5132
RH
3184Specifies a list of symbols which should not be automatically
3185exported. The symbol names may be delimited by commas or colons.
bb10df36 3186[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 3187
2927aaca
NC
3188@kindex --exclude-all-symbols
3189@item --exclude-all-symbols
3190Specifies no symbols should be automatically exported.
3191[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3192
252b5132
RH
3193@kindex --file-alignment
3194@item --file-alignment
3195Specify the file alignment. Sections in the file will always begin at
3196file offsets which are multiples of this number. This defaults to
3197512.
bb10df36 3198[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3199
3200@cindex heap size
3201@kindex --heap
3202@item --heap @var{reserve}
3203@itemx --heap @var{reserve},@var{commit}
a00b50c5 3204Specify the number of bytes of memory to reserve (and optionally commit)
fe6d7d6a 3205to be used as heap for this program. The default is 1MB reserved, 4K
252b5132 3206committed.
bb10df36 3207[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3208
3209@cindex image base
3210@kindex --image-base
3211@item --image-base @var{value}
3212Use @var{value} as the base address of your program or dll. This is
3213the lowest memory location that will be used when your program or dll
3214is loaded. To reduce the need to relocate and improve performance of
3215your dlls, each should have a unique base address and not overlap any
3216other dlls. The default is 0x400000 for executables, and 0x10000000
3217for dlls.
bb10df36 3218[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3219
3220@kindex --kill-at
3221@item --kill-at
3222If given, the stdcall suffixes (@@@var{nn}) will be stripped from
3223symbols before they are exported.
bb10df36 3224[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 3225
26d2d8a2
BF
3226@kindex --large-address-aware
3227@item --large-address-aware
b45619c0 3228If given, the appropriate bit in the ``Characteristics'' field of the COFF
26d2d8a2 3229header is set to indicate that this executable supports virtual addresses
b45619c0 3230greater than 2 gigabytes. This should be used in conjunction with the /3GB
26d2d8a2
BF
3231or /USERVA=@var{value} megabytes switch in the ``[operating systems]''
3232section of the BOOT.INI. Otherwise, this bit has no effect.
3233[This option is specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
3234
f69a2f97
NC
3235@kindex --disable-large-address-aware
3236@item --disable-large-address-aware
3237Reverts the effect of a previous @samp{--large-address-aware} option.
3238This is useful if @samp{--large-address-aware} is always set by the compiler
3239driver (e.g. Cygwin gcc) and the executable does not support virtual
3240addresses greater than 2 gigabytes.
3241[This option is specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
3242
252b5132
RH
3243@kindex --major-image-version
3244@item --major-image-version @var{value}
36f63dca 3245Sets the major number of the ``image version''. Defaults to 1.
bb10df36 3246[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3247
3248@kindex --major-os-version
3249@item --major-os-version @var{value}
36f63dca 3250Sets the major number of the ``os version''. Defaults to 4.
bb10df36 3251[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3252
3253@kindex --major-subsystem-version
3254@item --major-subsystem-version @var{value}
36f63dca 3255Sets the major number of the ``subsystem version''. Defaults to 4.
bb10df36 3256[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3257
3258@kindex --minor-image-version
3259@item --minor-image-version @var{value}
36f63dca 3260Sets the minor number of the ``image version''. Defaults to 0.
bb10df36 3261[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3262
3263@kindex --minor-os-version
3264@item --minor-os-version @var{value}
36f63dca 3265Sets the minor number of the ``os version''. Defaults to 0.
bb10df36 3266[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3267
3268@kindex --minor-subsystem-version
3269@item --minor-subsystem-version @var{value}
36f63dca 3270Sets the minor number of the ``subsystem version''. Defaults to 0.
bb10df36 3271[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3272
3273@cindex DEF files, creating
3274@cindex DLLs, creating
3275@kindex --output-def
3276@item --output-def @var{file}
3277The linker will create the file @var{file} which will contain a DEF
3278file corresponding to the DLL the linker is generating. This DEF file
3279(which should be called @code{*.def}) may be used to create an import
3280library with @code{dlltool} or may be used as a reference to
3281automatically or implicitly exported symbols.
bb10df36 3282[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 3283
b044cda1 3284@cindex DLLs, creating
b044cda1
CW
3285@kindex --enable-auto-image-base
3286@item --enable-auto-image-base
d0e6d77b
CF
3287@itemx --enable-auto-image-base=@var{value}
3288Automatically choose the image base for DLLs, optionally starting with base
3289@var{value}, unless one is specified using the @code{--image-base} argument.
3290By using a hash generated from the dllname to create unique image bases
3291for each DLL, in-memory collisions and relocations which can delay program
3292execution are avoided.
bb10df36 3293[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1
CW
3294
3295@kindex --disable-auto-image-base
3296@item --disable-auto-image-base
3297Do not automatically generate a unique image base. If there is no
3298user-specified image base (@code{--image-base}) then use the platform
3299default.
bb10df36 3300[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1
CW
3301
3302@cindex DLLs, linking to
3303@kindex --dll-search-prefix
3304@item --dll-search-prefix @var{string}
489d0400 3305When linking dynamically to a dll without an import library,
ece2d90e 3306search for @code{<string><basename>.dll} in preference to
560e09e9 3307@code{lib<basename>.dll}. This behaviour allows easy distinction
b044cda1
CW
3308between DLLs built for the various "subplatforms": native, cygwin,
3309uwin, pw, etc. For instance, cygwin DLLs typically use
ece2d90e 3310@code{--dll-search-prefix=cyg}.
bb10df36 3311[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1
CW
3312
3313@kindex --enable-auto-import
3314@item --enable-auto-import
ece2d90e 3315Do sophisticated linking of @code{_symbol} to @code{__imp__symbol} for
317ff008
EB
3316DATA imports from DLLs, thus making it possible to bypass the dllimport
3317mechanism on the user side and to reference unmangled symbol names.
3318[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
3319
3320The following remarks pertain to the original implementation of the
3321feature and are obsolete nowadays for Cygwin and MinGW targets.
3322
3323Note: Use of the 'auto-import' extension will cause the text section
3324of the image file to be made writable. This does not conform to the
3325PE-COFF format specification published by Microsoft.
4d8907ac 3326
e2a83dd0
NC
3327Note - use of the 'auto-import' extension will also cause read only
3328data which would normally be placed into the .rdata section to be
3329placed into the .data section instead. This is in order to work
3330around a problem with consts that is described here:
3331http://www.cygwin.com/ml/cygwin/2004-09/msg01101.html
3332
4d8907ac
DS
3333Using 'auto-import' generally will 'just work' -- but sometimes you may
3334see this message:
0d888aac 3335
ece2d90e 3336"variable '<var>' can't be auto-imported. Please read the
0d888aac
CW
3337documentation for ld's @code{--enable-auto-import} for details."
3338
ece2d90e
NC
3339This message occurs when some (sub)expression accesses an address
3340ultimately given by the sum of two constants (Win32 import tables only
c0065db7
RM
3341allow one). Instances where this may occur include accesses to member
3342fields of struct variables imported from a DLL, as well as using a
3343constant index into an array variable imported from a DLL. Any
2f8d8971
NC
3344multiword variable (arrays, structs, long long, etc) may trigger
3345this error condition. However, regardless of the exact data type
3346of the offending exported variable, ld will always detect it, issue
3347the warning, and exit.
3348
3349There are several ways to address this difficulty, regardless of the
3350data type of the exported variable:
0d888aac 3351
2fa9fc65
NC
3352One way is to use --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc switch. This leaves the task
3353of adjusting references in your client code for runtime environment, so
560e09e9 3354this method works only when runtime environment supports this feature.
2fa9fc65 3355
c0065db7
RM
3356A second solution is to force one of the 'constants' to be a variable --
3357that is, unknown and un-optimizable at compile time. For arrays,
3358there are two possibilities: a) make the indexee (the array's address)
0d888aac
CW
3359a variable, or b) make the 'constant' index a variable. Thus:
3360
3361@example
3362extern type extern_array[];
c0065db7 3363extern_array[1] -->
0d888aac
CW
3364 @{ volatile type *t=extern_array; t[1] @}
3365@end example
3366
3367or
3368
3369@example
3370extern type extern_array[];
c0065db7 3371extern_array[1] -->
0d888aac
CW
3372 @{ volatile int t=1; extern_array[t] @}
3373@end example
3374
c0065db7 3375For structs (and most other multiword data types) the only option
2f8d8971 3376is to make the struct itself (or the long long, or the ...) variable:
0d888aac
CW
3377
3378@example
3379extern struct s extern_struct;
c0065db7 3380extern_struct.field -->
0d888aac
CW
3381 @{ volatile struct s *t=&extern_struct; t->field @}
3382@end example
3383
c406afaf
NC
3384or
3385
3386@example
3387extern long long extern_ll;
3388extern_ll -->
3389 @{ volatile long long * local_ll=&extern_ll; *local_ll @}
3390@end example
3391
2fa9fc65 3392A third method of dealing with this difficulty is to abandon
c0065db7 3393'auto-import' for the offending symbol and mark it with
11e7fd74 3394@code{__declspec(dllimport)}. However, in practice that
0d888aac 3395requires using compile-time #defines to indicate whether you are
c0065db7
RM
3396building a DLL, building client code that will link to the DLL, or
3397merely building/linking to a static library. In making the choice
3398between the various methods of resolving the 'direct address with
0d888aac
CW
3399constant offset' problem, you should consider typical real-world usage:
3400
3401Original:
3402@example
3403--foo.h
3404extern int arr[];
3405--foo.c
3406#include "foo.h"
3407void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3408 printf("%d\n",arr[1]);
3409@}
3410@end example
3411
3412Solution 1:
3413@example
3414--foo.h
3415extern int arr[];
3416--foo.c
3417#include "foo.h"
3418void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3419 /* This workaround is for win32 and cygwin; do not "optimize" */
3420 volatile int *parr = arr;
3421 printf("%d\n",parr[1]);
3422@}
3423@end example
3424
3425Solution 2:
3426@example
3427--foo.h
3428/* Note: auto-export is assumed (no __declspec(dllexport)) */
3429#if (defined(_WIN32) || defined(__CYGWIN__)) && \
3430 !(defined(FOO_BUILD_DLL) || defined(FOO_STATIC))
3431#define FOO_IMPORT __declspec(dllimport)
3432#else
3433#define FOO_IMPORT
3434#endif
3435extern FOO_IMPORT int arr[];
3436--foo.c
3437#include "foo.h"
3438void main(int argc, char **argv)@{
3439 printf("%d\n",arr[1]);
3440@}
3441@end example
3442
c0065db7 3443A fourth way to avoid this problem is to re-code your
0d888aac
CW
3444library to use a functional interface rather than a data interface
3445for the offending variables (e.g. set_foo() and get_foo() accessor
3446functions).
b044cda1
CW
3447
3448@kindex --disable-auto-import
3449@item --disable-auto-import
c0065db7 3450Do not attempt to do sophisticated linking of @code{_symbol} to
b044cda1 3451@code{__imp__symbol} for DATA imports from DLLs.
bb10df36 3452[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1 3453
2fa9fc65
NC
3454@kindex --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3455@item --enable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3456If your code contains expressions described in --enable-auto-import section,
3457that is, DATA imports from DLL with non-zero offset, this switch will create
3458a vector of 'runtime pseudo relocations' which can be used by runtime
c0065db7 3459environment to adjust references to such data in your client code.
bb10df36 3460[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2fa9fc65
NC
3461
3462@kindex --disable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
3463@item --disable-runtime-pseudo-reloc
317ff008 3464Do not create pseudo relocations for non-zero offset DATA imports from DLLs.
bb10df36 3465[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
2fa9fc65 3466
b044cda1
CW
3467@kindex --enable-extra-pe-debug
3468@item --enable-extra-pe-debug
3469Show additional debug info related to auto-import symbol thunking.
bb10df36 3470[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
b044cda1 3471
252b5132
RH
3472@kindex --section-alignment
3473@item --section-alignment
3474Sets the section alignment. Sections in memory will always begin at
3475addresses which are a multiple of this number. Defaults to 0x1000.
bb10df36 3476[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3477
3478@cindex stack size
3479@kindex --stack
3480@item --stack @var{reserve}
3481@itemx --stack @var{reserve},@var{commit}
a00b50c5 3482Specify the number of bytes of memory to reserve (and optionally commit)
fe6d7d6a 3483to be used as stack for this program. The default is 2MB reserved, 4K
252b5132 3484committed.
bb10df36 3485[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132
RH
3486
3487@kindex --subsystem
3488@item --subsystem @var{which}
3489@itemx --subsystem @var{which}:@var{major}
3490@itemx --subsystem @var{which}:@var{major}.@var{minor}
3491Specifies the subsystem under which your program will execute. The
3492legal values for @var{which} are @code{native}, @code{windows},
33f362e1
NC
3493@code{console}, @code{posix}, and @code{xbox}. You may optionally set
3494the subsystem version also. Numeric values are also accepted for
3495@var{which}.
bb10df36 3496[This option is specific to the i386 PE targeted port of the linker]
252b5132 3497
2f563b51
DK
3498The following options set flags in the @code{DllCharacteristics} field
3499of the PE file header:
3500[These options are specific to PE targeted ports of the linker]
3501
2d5c3743
NC
3502@kindex --high-entropy-va
3503@item --high-entropy-va
514b4e19 3504@itemx --disable-high-entropy-va
2d5c3743 3505Image is compatible with 64-bit address space layout randomization
514b4e19
JD
3506(ASLR). This option is enabled by default for 64-bit PE images.
3507
dc9bd8c9
HD
3508This option also implies @option{--dynamicbase} and
3509@option{--enable-reloc-section}.
2d5c3743 3510
2f563b51
DK
3511@kindex --dynamicbase
3512@item --dynamicbase
514b4e19 3513@itemx --disable-dynamicbase
2f563b51
DK
3514The image base address may be relocated using address space layout
3515randomization (ASLR). This feature was introduced with MS Windows
514b4e19
JD
3516Vista for i386 PE targets. This option is enabled by default but
3517can be disabled via the @option{--disable-dynamicbase} option.
dc9bd8c9 3518This option also implies @option{--enable-reloc-section}.
2f563b51
DK
3519
3520@kindex --forceinteg
3521@item --forceinteg
514b4e19
JD
3522@itemx --disable-forceinteg
3523Code integrity checks are enforced. This option is disabled by
3524default.
2f563b51
DK
3525
3526@kindex --nxcompat
3527@item --nxcompat
514b4e19 3528@item --disable-nxcompat
2f563b51 3529The image is compatible with the Data Execution Prevention.
514b4e19
JD
3530This feature was introduced with MS Windows XP SP2 for i386 PE
3531targets. The option is enabled by default.
2f563b51
DK
3532
3533@kindex --no-isolation
3534@item --no-isolation
514b4e19 3535@itemx --disable-no-isolation
2f563b51 3536Although the image understands isolation, do not isolate the image.
514b4e19 3537This option is disabled by default.
2f563b51
DK
3538
3539@kindex --no-seh
3540@item --no-seh
514b4e19 3541@itemx --disable-no-seh
2f563b51 3542The image does not use SEH. No SE handler may be called from
514b4e19 3543this image. This option is disabled by default.
2f563b51
DK
3544
3545@kindex --no-bind
3546@item --no-bind
514b4e19
JD
3547@itemx --disable-no-bind
3548Do not bind this image. This option is disabled by default.
2f563b51
DK
3549
3550@kindex --wdmdriver
3551@item --wdmdriver
514b4e19
JD
3552@itemx --disable-wdmdriver
3553The driver uses the MS Windows Driver Model. This option is disabled
3554by default.
9d5777a3 3555
2f563b51
DK
3556@kindex --tsaware
3557@item --tsaware
514b4e19
JD
3558@itemx --disable-tsaware
3559The image is Terminal Server aware. This option is disabled by
3560default.
2f563b51 3561
0cb112f7
CF
3562@kindex --insert-timestamp
3563@item --insert-timestamp
eeb14e5a
LZ
3564@itemx --no-insert-timestamp
3565Insert a real timestamp into the image. This is the default behaviour
3566as it matches legacy code and it means that the image will work with
3567other, proprietary tools. The problem with this default is that it
56e6cf80 3568will result in slightly different images being produced each time the
eeb14e5a
LZ
3569same sources are linked. The option @option{--no-insert-timestamp}
3570can be used to insert a zero value for the timestamp, this ensuring
56e6cf80 3571that binaries produced from identical sources will compare
eeb14e5a 3572identically.
dc9bd8c9
HD
3573
3574@kindex --enable-reloc-section
3575@item --enable-reloc-section
514b4e19 3576@itemx --disable-reloc-section
dc9bd8c9
HD
3577Create the base relocation table, which is necessary if the image
3578is loaded at a different image base than specified in the PE header.
514b4e19 3579This option is enabled by default.
252b5132
RH
3580@end table
3581
0285c67d
NC
3582@c man end
3583
ac145307
BS
3584@ifset C6X
3585@subsection Options specific to C6X uClinux targets
3586
3587@c man begin OPTIONS
3588
3589The C6X uClinux target uses a binary format called DSBT to support shared
3590libraries. Each shared library in the system needs to have a unique index;
3591all executables use an index of 0.
3592
3593@table @gcctabopt
3594
3595@kindex --dsbt-size
3596@item --dsbt-size @var{size}
56e6cf80 3597This option sets the number of entries in the DSBT of the current executable
ac145307
BS
3598or shared library to @var{size}. The default is to create a table with 64
3599entries.
3600
3601@kindex --dsbt-index
3602@item --dsbt-index @var{index}
3603This option sets the DSBT index of the current executable or shared library
3604to @var{index}. The default is 0, which is appropriate for generating
3605executables. If a shared library is generated with a DSBT index of 0, the
3606@code{R_C6000_DSBT_INDEX} relocs are copied into the output file.
3607
fbd9ad90
PB
3608@kindex --no-merge-exidx-entries
3609The @samp{--no-merge-exidx-entries} switch disables the merging of adjacent
3610exidx entries in frame unwind info.
3611
ac145307
BS
3612@end table
3613
3614@c man end
3615@end ifset
3616
b8891f8d
AJ
3617@ifset CSKY
3618@subsection Options specific to C-SKY targets
3619
3620@c man begin OPTIONS
3621
3622@table @gcctabopt
3623
3624@kindex --branch-stub on C-SKY
3625@item --branch-stub
3626This option enables linker branch relaxation by inserting branch stub
3627sections when needed to extend the range of branches. This option is
3628usually not required since C-SKY supports branch and call instructions that
3629can access the full memory range and branch relaxation is normally handled by
3630the compiler or assembler.
3631
3632@kindex --stub-group-size on C-SKY
3633@item --stub-group-size=@var{N}
3634This option allows finer control of linker branch stub creation.
3635It sets the maximum size of a group of input sections that can
3636be handled by one stub section. A negative value of @var{N} locates
3637stub sections after their branches, while a positive value allows stub
3638sections to appear either before or after the branches. Values of
3639@samp{1} or @samp{-1} indicate that the
3640linker should choose suitable defaults.
3641
3642@end table
3643
3644@c man end
3645@end ifset
3646
93fd0973
SC
3647@ifset M68HC11
3648@subsection Options specific to Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 targets
3649
3650@c man begin OPTIONS
3651
3652The 68HC11 and 68HC12 linkers support specific options to control the
3653memory bank switching mapping and trampoline code generation.
3654
3655@table @gcctabopt
3656
3657@kindex --no-trampoline
3658@item --no-trampoline
3659This option disables the generation of trampoline. By default a trampoline
3660is generated for each far function which is called using a @code{jsr}
3661instruction (this happens when a pointer to a far function is taken).
3662
3663@kindex --bank-window
3664@item --bank-window @var{name}
3665This option indicates to the linker the name of the memory region in
3666the @samp{MEMORY} specification that describes the memory bank window.
3667The definition of such region is then used by the linker to compute
3668paging and addresses within the memory window.
3669
3670@end table
3671
3672@c man end
3673@end ifset
3674
7fb9f789
NC
3675@ifset M68K
3676@subsection Options specific to Motorola 68K target
3677
3678@c man begin OPTIONS
3679
3680The following options are supported to control handling of GOT generation
3681when linking for 68K targets.
3682
3683@table @gcctabopt
3684
3685@kindex --got
3686@item --got=@var{type}
3687This option tells the linker which GOT generation scheme to use.
3688@var{type} should be one of @samp{single}, @samp{negative},
3689@samp{multigot} or @samp{target}. For more information refer to the
3690Info entry for @file{ld}.
3691
3692@end table
3693
3694@c man end
3695@end ifset
3696
833794fc
MR
3697@ifset MIPS
3698@subsection Options specific to MIPS targets
3699
3700@c man begin OPTIONS
3701
3702The following options are supported to control microMIPS instruction
8b10b0b3
MR
3703generation and branch relocation checks for ISA mode transitions when
3704linking for MIPS targets.
833794fc
MR
3705
3706@table @gcctabopt
3707
3708@kindex --insn32
3709@item --insn32
3710@kindex --no-insn32
3711@itemx --no-insn32
3712These options control the choice of microMIPS instructions used in code
3713generated by the linker, such as that in the PLT or lazy binding stubs,
3714or in relaxation. If @samp{--insn32} is used, then the linker only uses
371532-bit instruction encodings. By default or if @samp{--no-insn32} is
3716used, all instruction encodings are used, including 16-bit ones where
3717possible.
3718
8b10b0b3
MR
3719@kindex --ignore-branch-isa
3720@item --ignore-branch-isa
3721@kindex --no-ignore-branch-isa
3722@itemx --no-ignore-branch-isa
3723These options control branch relocation checks for invalid ISA mode
3724transitions. If @samp{--ignore-branch-isa} is used, then the linker
3725accepts any branch relocations and any ISA mode transition required
3726is lost in relocation calculation, except for some cases of @code{BAL}
3727instructions which meet relaxation conditions and are converted to
3728equivalent @code{JALX} instructions as the associated relocation is
3729calculated. By default or if @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} is used
3730a check is made causing the loss of an ISA mode transition to produce
3731an error.
3732
3734320d
MF
3733@kindex --compact-branches
3734@item --compact-branches
3735@kindex --no-compact-branches
fa1477dc 3736@itemx --no-compact-branches
3734320d
MF
3737These options control the generation of compact instructions by the linker
3738in the PLT entries for MIPS R6.
3739
833794fc
MR
3740@end table
3741
3742@c man end
3743@end ifset
3744
fa1477dc
SC
3745
3746@ifset PDP11
3747@subsection Options specific to PDP11 targets
3748
3749@c man begin OPTIONS
3750
3751For the pdp11-aout target, three variants of the output format can be
3752produced as selected by the following options. The default variant
3753for pdp11-aout is the @samp{--omagic} option, whereas for other
3754targets @samp{--nmagic} is the default. The @samp{--imagic} option is
3755defined only for the pdp11-aout target, while the others are described
3756here as they apply to the pdp11-aout target.
3757
3758@table @gcctabopt
3759
3760@kindex -N
3761@item -N
3762@kindex --omagic
3763@itemx --omagic
3764
3765Mark the output as @code{OMAGIC} (0407) in the @file{a.out} header to
3766indicate that the text segment is not to be write-protected and
3767shared. Since the text and data sections are both readable and
3768writable, the data section is allocated immediately contiguous after
3769the text segment. This is the oldest format for PDP11 executable
3770programs and is the default for @command{ld} on PDP11 Unix systems
3771from the beginning through 2.11BSD.
3772
3773@kindex -n
3774@item -n
3775@kindex --nmagic
3776@itemx --nmagic
3777
3778Mark the output as @code{NMAGIC} (0410) in the @file{a.out} header to
3779indicate that when the output file is executed, the text portion will
3780be read-only and shareable among all processes executing the same
3781file. This involves moving the data areas up to the first possible 8K
3782byte page boundary following the end of the text. This option creates
3783a @emph{pure executable} format.
3784
3785@kindex -z
3786@item -z
3787@kindex --imagic
3788@itemx --imagic
3789
3790Mark the output as @code{IMAGIC} (0411) in the @file{a.out} header to
3791indicate that when the output file is executed, the program text and
3792data areas will be loaded into separate address spaces using the split
3793instruction and data space feature of the memory management unit in
3794larger models of the PDP11. This doubles the address space available
3795to the program. The text segment is again pure, write-protected, and
3796shareable. The only difference in the output format between this
3797option and the others, besides the magic number, is that both the text
3798and data sections start at location 0. The @samp{-z} option selected
3799this format in 2.11BSD. This option creates a @emph{separate
3800executable} format.
3801
3802@kindex --no-omagic
3803@item --no-omagic
3804
3805Equivalent to @samp{--nmagic} for pdp11-aout.
3806
3807@end table
3808
3809@c man end
3810@end ifset
3811
252b5132
RH
3812@ifset UsesEnvVars
3813@node Environment
3814@section Environment Variables
3815
0285c67d
NC
3816@c man begin ENVIRONMENT
3817
560e09e9 3818You can change the behaviour of @command{ld} with the environment variables
36f63dca
NC
3819@ifclear SingleFormat
3820@code{GNUTARGET},
3821@end ifclear
3822@code{LDEMULATION} and @code{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE}.
252b5132 3823
36f63dca 3824@ifclear SingleFormat
252b5132
RH
3825@kindex GNUTARGET
3826@cindex default input format
3827@code{GNUTARGET} determines the input-file object format if you don't
3828use @samp{-b} (or its synonym @samp{--format}). Its value should be one
3829of the BFD names for an input format (@pxref{BFD}). If there is no
ff5dcc92 3830@code{GNUTARGET} in the environment, @command{ld} uses the natural format
252b5132
RH
3831of the target. If @code{GNUTARGET} is set to @code{default} then BFD
3832attempts to discover the input format by examining binary input files;
3833this method often succeeds, but there are potential ambiguities, since
3834there is no method of ensuring that the magic number used to specify
3835object-file formats is unique. However, the configuration procedure for
3836BFD on each system places the conventional format for that system first
3837in the search-list, so ambiguities are resolved in favor of convention.
36f63dca 3838@end ifclear
252b5132
RH
3839
3840@kindex LDEMULATION
3841@cindex default emulation
3842@cindex emulation, default
3843@code{LDEMULATION} determines the default emulation if you don't use the
3844@samp{-m} option. The emulation can affect various aspects of linker
3845behaviour, particularly the default linker script. You can list the
3846available emulations with the @samp{--verbose} or @samp{-V} options. If
3847the @samp{-m} option is not used, and the @code{LDEMULATION} environment
3848variable is not defined, the default emulation depends upon how the
3849linker was configured.
252b5132
RH
3850
3851@kindex COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE
3852@cindex demangling, default
3853Normally, the linker will default to demangling symbols. However, if
3854@code{COLLECT_NO_DEMANGLE} is set in the environment, then it will
3855default to not demangling symbols. This environment variable is used in
3856a similar fashion by the @code{gcc} linker wrapper program. The default
3857may be overridden by the @samp{--demangle} and @samp{--no-demangle}
3858options.
3859
0285c67d
NC
3860@c man end
3861@end ifset
3862
252b5132
RH
3863@node Scripts
3864@chapter Linker Scripts
3865
3866@cindex scripts
3867@cindex linker scripts
3868@cindex command files
3869Every link is controlled by a @dfn{linker script}. This script is
3870written in the linker command language.
3871
3872The main purpose of the linker script is to describe how the sections in
3873the input files should be mapped into the output file, and to control
3874the memory layout of the output file. Most linker scripts do nothing
3875more than this. However, when necessary, the linker script can also
3876direct the linker to perform many other operations, using the commands
3877described below.
3878
3879The linker always uses a linker script. If you do not supply one
3880yourself, the linker will use a default script that is compiled into the
a05a5b64
TP
3881linker executable. You can use the @samp{--verbose} command-line option
3882to display the default linker script. Certain command-line options,
252b5132
RH
3883such as @samp{-r} or @samp{-N}, will affect the default linker script.
3884
3885You may supply your own linker script by using the @samp{-T} command
3886line option. When you do this, your linker script will replace the
3887default linker script.
3888
3889You may also use linker scripts implicitly by naming them as input files
3890to the linker, as though they were files to be linked. @xref{Implicit
3891Linker Scripts}.
3892
3893@menu
3894* Basic Script Concepts:: Basic Linker Script Concepts
3895* Script Format:: Linker Script Format
3896* Simple Example:: Simple Linker Script Example
3897* Simple Commands:: Simple Linker Script Commands
3898* Assignments:: Assigning Values to Symbols
3899* SECTIONS:: SECTIONS Command
3900* MEMORY:: MEMORY Command
3901* PHDRS:: PHDRS Command
3902* VERSION:: VERSION Command
3903* Expressions:: Expressions in Linker Scripts
3904* Implicit Linker Scripts:: Implicit Linker Scripts
3905@end menu
3906
3907@node Basic Script Concepts
3908@section Basic Linker Script Concepts
3909@cindex linker script concepts
3910We need to define some basic concepts and vocabulary in order to
3911describe the linker script language.
3912
3913The linker combines input files into a single output file. The output
3914file and each input file are in a special data format known as an
3915@dfn{object file format}. Each file is called an @dfn{object file}.
3916The output file is often called an @dfn{executable}, but for our
3917purposes we will also call it an object file. Each object file has,
3918among other things, a list of @dfn{sections}. We sometimes refer to a
3919section in an input file as an @dfn{input section}; similarly, a section
3920in the output file is an @dfn{output section}.
3921
3922Each section in an object file has a name and a size. Most sections
3923also have an associated block of data, known as the @dfn{section
56dd11f0 3924contents}. A section may be marked as @dfn{loadable}, which means that
252b5132
RH
3925the contents should be loaded into memory when the output file is run.
3926A section with no contents may be @dfn{allocatable}, which means that an
3927area in memory should be set aside, but nothing in particular should be
3928loaded there (in some cases this memory must be zeroed out). A section
3929which is neither loadable nor allocatable typically contains some sort
3930of debugging information.
3931
3932Every loadable or allocatable output section has two addresses. The
3933first is the @dfn{VMA}, or virtual memory address. This is the address
3934the section will have when the output file is run. The second is the
3935@dfn{LMA}, or load memory address. This is the address at which the
3936section will be loaded. In most cases the two addresses will be the
3937same. An example of when they might be different is when a data section
3938is loaded into ROM, and then copied into RAM when the program starts up
3939(this technique is often used to initialize global variables in a ROM
3940based system). In this case the ROM address would be the LMA, and the
3941RAM address would be the VMA.
3942
3943You can see the sections in an object file by using the @code{objdump}
3944program with the @samp{-h} option.
3945
3946Every object file also has a list of @dfn{symbols}, known as the
3947@dfn{symbol table}. A symbol may be defined or undefined. Each symbol
3948has a name, and each defined symbol has an address, among other
3949information. If you compile a C or C++ program into an object file, you
3950will get a defined symbol for every defined function and global or
3951static variable. Every undefined function or global variable which is
3952referenced in the input file will become an undefined symbol.
3953
3954You can see the symbols in an object file by using the @code{nm}
3955program, or by using the @code{objdump} program with the @samp{-t}
3956option.
3957
3958@node Script Format
3959@section Linker Script Format
3960@cindex linker script format
3961Linker scripts are text files.
3962
3963You write a linker script as a series of commands. Each command is
3964either a keyword, possibly followed by arguments, or an assignment to a
3965symbol. You may separate commands using semicolons. Whitespace is
3966generally ignored.
3967
3968Strings such as file or format names can normally be entered directly.
3969If the file name contains a character such as a comma which would
3970otherwise serve to separate file names, you may put the file name in
3971double quotes. There is no way to use a double quote character in a
3972file name.
3973
3974You may include comments in linker scripts just as in C, delimited by
3975@samp{/*} and @samp{*/}. As in C, comments are syntactically equivalent
3976to whitespace.
3977
3978@node Simple Example
3979@section Simple Linker Script Example
3980@cindex linker script example
3981@cindex example of linker script
3982Many linker scripts are fairly simple.
3983
3984The simplest possible linker script has just one command:
3985@samp{SECTIONS}. You use the @samp{SECTIONS} command to describe the
3986memory layout of the output file.
3987
3988The @samp{SECTIONS} command is a powerful command. Here we will
3989describe a simple use of it. Let's assume your program consists only of
3990code, initialized data, and uninitialized data. These will be in the
3991@samp{.text}, @samp{.data}, and @samp{.bss} sections, respectively.
3992Let's assume further that these are the only sections which appear in
3993your input files.
3994
3995For this example, let's say that the code should be loaded at address
39960x10000, and that the data should start at address 0x8000000. Here is a
3997linker script which will do that:
3998@smallexample
3999SECTIONS
4000@{
4001 . = 0x10000;
4002 .text : @{ *(.text) @}
4003 . = 0x8000000;
4004 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
4005 .bss : @{ *(.bss) @}
4006@}
4007@end smallexample
4008
4009You write the @samp{SECTIONS} command as the keyword @samp{SECTIONS},
4010followed by a series of symbol assignments and output section
4011descriptions enclosed in curly braces.
4012
252b5132
RH
4013The first line inside the @samp{SECTIONS} command of the above example
4014sets the value of the special symbol @samp{.}, which is the location
4015counter. If you do not specify the address of an output section in some
4016other way (other ways are described later), the address is set from the
4017current value of the location counter. The location counter is then
4018incremented by the size of the output section. At the start of the
4019@samp{SECTIONS} command, the location counter has the value @samp{0}.
4020
4021The second line defines an output section, @samp{.text}. The colon is
4022required syntax which may be ignored for now. Within the curly braces
4023after the output section name, you list the names of the input sections
4024which should be placed into this output section. The @samp{*} is a
4025wildcard which matches any file name. The expression @samp{*(.text)}
4026means all @samp{.text} input sections in all input files.
4027
4028Since the location counter is @samp{0x10000} when the output section
4029@samp{.text} is defined, the linker will set the address of the
4030@samp{.text} section in the output file to be @samp{0x10000}.
4031
4032The remaining lines define the @samp{.data} and @samp{.bss} sections in
4033the output file. The linker will place the @samp{.data} output section
4034at address @samp{0x8000000}. After the linker places the @samp{.data}
4035output section, the value of the location counter will be
4036@samp{0x8000000} plus the size of the @samp{.data} output section. The
4037effect is that the linker will place the @samp{.bss} output section
58434bc1 4038immediately after the @samp{.data} output section in memory.
252b5132
RH
4039
4040The linker will ensure that each output section has the required
4041alignment, by increasing the location counter if necessary. In this
4042example, the specified addresses for the @samp{.text} and @samp{.data}
4043sections will probably satisfy any alignment constraints, but the linker
4044may have to create a small gap between the @samp{.data} and @samp{.bss}
4045sections.
4046
4047That's it! That's a simple and complete linker script.
4048
4049@node Simple Commands
4050@section Simple Linker Script Commands
4051@cindex linker script simple commands
4052In this section we describe the simple linker script commands.
4053
4054@menu
4055* Entry Point:: Setting the entry point
4056* File Commands:: Commands dealing with files
4057@ifclear SingleFormat
4058* Format Commands:: Commands dealing with object file formats
4059@end ifclear
4060
4a93e180 4061* REGION_ALIAS:: Assign alias names to memory regions
252b5132
RH
4062* Miscellaneous Commands:: Other linker script commands
4063@end menu
4064
4065@node Entry Point
36f63dca 4066@subsection Setting the Entry Point
252b5132
RH
4067@kindex ENTRY(@var{symbol})
4068@cindex start of execution
4069@cindex first instruction
4070@cindex entry point
4071The first instruction to execute in a program is called the @dfn{entry
4072point}. You can use the @code{ENTRY} linker script command to set the
4073entry point. The argument is a symbol name:
4074@smallexample
4075ENTRY(@var{symbol})
4076@end smallexample
4077
4078There are several ways to set the entry point. The linker will set the
4079entry point by trying each of the following methods in order, and
4080stopping when one of them succeeds:
4081@itemize @bullet
a1ab1d2a 4082@item
252b5132 4083the @samp{-e} @var{entry} command-line option;
a1ab1d2a 4084@item
252b5132 4085the @code{ENTRY(@var{symbol})} command in a linker script;
a1ab1d2a 4086@item
a094d01f 4087the value of a target-specific symbol, if it is defined; For many
8a758655 4088targets this is @code{start}, but PE- and BeOS-based systems for example
3ab904c4 4089check a list of possible entry symbols, matching the first one found.
a1ab1d2a 4090@item
5226a6a8
NC
4091the address of the first byte of the code section, if present and an
4092executable is being created - the code section is usually
5c14cc55 4093@samp{.text}, but can be something else;
a1ab1d2a 4094@item
252b5132
RH
4095The address @code{0}.
4096@end itemize
4097
4098@node File Commands
36f63dca 4099@subsection Commands Dealing with Files
252b5132
RH
4100@cindex linker script file commands
4101Several linker script commands deal with files.
4102
4103@table @code
4104@item INCLUDE @var{filename}
4105@kindex INCLUDE @var{filename}
4106@cindex including a linker script
4107Include the linker script @var{filename} at this point. The file will
4108be searched for in the current directory, and in any directory specified
ff5dcc92 4109with the @option{-L} option. You can nest calls to @code{INCLUDE} up to
252b5132
RH
411010 levels deep.
4111
4006703d
NS
4112You can place @code{INCLUDE} directives at the top level, in @code{MEMORY} or
4113@code{SECTIONS} commands, or in output section descriptions.
4114
252b5132
RH
4115@item INPUT(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
4116@itemx INPUT(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
4117@kindex INPUT(@var{files})
4118@cindex input files in linker scripts
4119@cindex input object files in linker scripts
4120@cindex linker script input object files
4121The @code{INPUT} command directs the linker to include the named files
4122in the link, as though they were named on the command line.
4123
4124For example, if you always want to include @file{subr.o} any time you do
4125a link, but you can't be bothered to put it on every link command line,
4126then you can put @samp{INPUT (subr.o)} in your linker script.
4127
4128In fact, if you like, you can list all of your input files in the linker
4129script, and then invoke the linker with nothing but a @samp{-T} option.
4130
e3f2db7f
AO
4131In case a @dfn{sysroot prefix} is configured, and the filename starts
4132with the @samp{/} character, and the script being processed was
4133located inside the @dfn{sysroot prefix}, the filename will be looked
16171946
FS
4134for in the @dfn{sysroot prefix}. The @dfn{sysroot prefix} can also be forced by specifying
4135@code{=} as the first character in the filename path, or prefixing the
4136filename path with @code{$SYSROOT}. See also the description of
4137@samp{-L} in @ref{Options,,Command-line Options}.
4138
4139If a @dfn{sysroot prefix} is not used then the linker will try to open
4140the file in the directory containing the linker script. If it is not
4141found the linker will then search the current directory. If it is still
4142not found the linker will search through the archive library search
4143path.
252b5132 4144
ff5dcc92 4145If you use @samp{INPUT (-l@var{file})}, @command{ld} will transform the
a05a5b64 4146name to @code{lib@var{file}.a}, as with the command-line argument
252b5132
RH
4147@samp{-l}.
4148
4149When you use the @code{INPUT} command in an implicit linker script, the
4150files will be included in the link at the point at which the linker
4151script file is included. This can affect archive searching.
4152
4153@item GROUP(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
4154@itemx GROUP(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
4155@kindex GROUP(@var{files})
4156@cindex grouping input files
4157The @code{GROUP} command is like @code{INPUT}, except that the named
4158files should all be archives, and they are searched repeatedly until no
4159new undefined references are created. See the description of @samp{-(}
a05a5b64 4160in @ref{Options,,Command-line Options}.
252b5132 4161
b717d30e
JJ
4162@item AS_NEEDED(@var{file}, @var{file}, @dots{})
4163@itemx AS_NEEDED(@var{file} @var{file} @dots{})
4164@kindex AS_NEEDED(@var{files})
4165This construct can appear only inside of the @code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP}
4166commands, among other filenames. The files listed will be handled
4167as if they appear directly in the @code{INPUT} or @code{GROUP} commands,
4168with the exception of ELF shared libraries, that will be added only
4169when they are actually needed. This construct essentially enables
4170@option{--as-needed} option for all the files listed inside of it
4171and restores previous @option{--as-needed} resp. @option{--no-as-needed}
4172setting afterwards.
4173
252b5132
RH
4174@item OUTPUT(@var{filename})
4175@kindex OUTPUT(@var{filename})
b45619c0 4176@cindex output file name in linker script
252b5132
RH
4177The @code{OUTPUT} command names the output file. Using
4178@code{OUTPUT(@var{filename})} in the linker script is exactly like using
4179@samp{-o @var{filename}} on the command line (@pxref{Options,,Command
a05a5b64 4180Line Options}). If both are used, the command-line option takes
252b5132
RH
4181precedence.
4182
4183You can use the @code{OUTPUT} command to define a default name for the
4184output file other than the usual default of @file{a.out}.
4185
4186@item SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})
4187@kindex SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})
4188@cindex library search path in linker script
4189@cindex archive search path in linker script
4190@cindex search path in linker script
4191The @code{SEARCH_DIR} command adds @var{path} to the list of paths where
ff5dcc92 4192@command{ld} looks for archive libraries. Using
252b5132 4193@code{SEARCH_DIR(@var{path})} is exactly like using @samp{-L @var{path}}
a05a5b64 4194on the command line (@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If both
252b5132 4195are used, then the linker will search both paths. Paths specified using
a05a5b64 4196the command-line option are searched first.
252b5132
RH
4197
4198@item STARTUP(@var{filename})
4199@kindex STARTUP(@var{filename})
4200@cindex first input file
4201The @code{STARTUP} command is just like the @code{INPUT} command, except
4202that @var{filename} will become the first input file to be linked, as
4203though it were specified first on the command line. This may be useful
4204when using a system in which the entry point is always the start of the
4205first file.
4206@end table
4207
4208@ifclear SingleFormat
4209@node Format Commands
36f63dca 4210@subsection Commands Dealing with Object File Formats
252b5132
RH
4211A couple of linker script commands deal with object file formats.
4212
4213@table @code
4214@item OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})
4215@itemx OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{default}, @var{big}, @var{little})
4216@kindex OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})
4217@cindex output file format in linker script
4218The @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} command names the BFD format to use for the
4219output file (@pxref{BFD}). Using @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT(@var{bfdname})} is
024531e2 4220exactly like using @samp{--oformat @var{bfdname}} on the command line
a05a5b64 4221(@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If both are used, the command
252b5132
RH
4222line option takes precedence.
4223
4224You can use @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} with three arguments to use different
a05a5b64 4225formats based on the @samp{-EB} and @samp{-EL} command-line options.
252b5132
RH
4226This permits the linker script to set the output format based on the
4227desired endianness.
4228
4229If neither @samp{-EB} nor @samp{-EL} are used, then the output format
4230will be the first argument, @var{default}. If @samp{-EB} is used, the
4231output format will be the second argument, @var{big}. If @samp{-EL} is
4232used, the output format will be the third argument, @var{little}.
4233
4234For example, the default linker script for the MIPS ELF target uses this
4235command:
4236@smallexample
4237OUTPUT_FORMAT(elf32-bigmips, elf32-bigmips, elf32-littlemips)
4238@end smallexample
4239This says that the default format for the output file is
a05a5b64 4240@samp{elf32-bigmips}, but if the user uses the @samp{-EL} command-line
252b5132
RH
4241option, the output file will be created in the @samp{elf32-littlemips}
4242format.
4243
4244@item TARGET(@var{bfdname})
4245@kindex TARGET(@var{bfdname})
4246@cindex input file format in linker script
4247The @code{TARGET} command names the BFD format to use when reading input
4248files. It affects subsequent @code{INPUT} and @code{GROUP} commands.
4249This command is like using @samp{-b @var{bfdname}} on the command line
a05a5b64 4250(@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}). If the @code{TARGET} command
252b5132
RH
4251is used but @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} is not, then the last @code{TARGET}
4252command is also used to set the format for the output file. @xref{BFD}.
4253@end table
4254@end ifclear
4255
4a93e180
NC
4256@node REGION_ALIAS
4257@subsection Assign alias names to memory regions
4258@kindex REGION_ALIAS(@var{alias}, @var{region})
4259@cindex region alias
4260@cindex region names
4261
4262Alias names can be added to existing memory regions created with the
4263@ref{MEMORY} command. Each name corresponds to at most one memory region.
4264
4265@smallexample
4266REGION_ALIAS(@var{alias}, @var{region})
4267@end smallexample
4268
4269The @code{REGION_ALIAS} function creates an alias name @var{alias} for the
4270memory region @var{region}. This allows a flexible mapping of output sections
4271to memory regions. An example follows.
4272
4273Suppose we have an application for embedded systems which come with various
4274memory storage devices. All have a general purpose, volatile memory @code{RAM}
4275that allows code execution or data storage. Some may have a read-only,
4276non-volatile memory @code{ROM} that allows code execution and read-only data
4277access. The last variant is a read-only, non-volatile memory @code{ROM2} with
4278read-only data access and no code execution capability. We have four output
4279sections:
4280
4281@itemize @bullet
4282@item
4283@code{.text} program code;
4284@item
4285@code{.rodata} read-only data;
4286@item
4287@code{.data} read-write initialized data;
4288@item
4289@code{.bss} read-write zero initialized data.
4290@end itemize
4291
4292The goal is to provide a linker command file that contains a system independent
4293part defining the output sections and a system dependent part mapping the
4294output sections to the memory regions available on the system. Our embedded
4295systems come with three different memory setups @code{A}, @code{B} and
4296@code{C}:
4297@multitable @columnfractions .25 .25 .25 .25
4298@item Section @tab Variant A @tab Variant B @tab Variant C
9d5777a3 4299@item .text @tab RAM @tab ROM @tab ROM
4a93e180
NC
4300@item .rodata @tab RAM @tab ROM @tab ROM2
4301@item .data @tab RAM @tab RAM/ROM @tab RAM/ROM2
4302@item .bss @tab RAM @tab RAM @tab RAM
4303@end multitable
4304The notation @code{RAM/ROM} or @code{RAM/ROM2} means that this section is
4305loaded into region @code{ROM} or @code{ROM2} respectively. Please note that
4306the load address of the @code{.data} section starts in all three variants at
4307the end of the @code{.rodata} section.
4308
4309The base linker script that deals with the output sections follows. It
4310includes the system dependent @code{linkcmds.memory} file that describes the
4311memory layout:
4312@smallexample
4313INCLUDE linkcmds.memory
4314
4315SECTIONS
4316 @{
4317 .text :
4318 @{
4319 *(.text)
4320 @} > REGION_TEXT
4321 .rodata :
4322 @{
4323 *(.rodata)
4324 rodata_end = .;
4325 @} > REGION_RODATA
4326 .data : AT (rodata_end)
4327 @{
4328 data_start = .;
4329 *(.data)
4330 @} > REGION_DATA
4331 data_size = SIZEOF(.data);
4332 data_load_start = LOADADDR(.data);
4333 .bss :
4334 @{
4335 *(.bss)
4336 @} > REGION_BSS
4337 @}
4338@end smallexample
4339
4340Now we need three different @code{linkcmds.memory} files to define memory
4341regions and alias names. The content of @code{linkcmds.memory} for the three
4342variants @code{A}, @code{B} and @code{C}:
4343@table @code
4344@item A
4345Here everything goes into the @code{RAM}.
4346@smallexample
4347MEMORY
4348 @{
4349 RAM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 4M
4350 @}
4351
4352REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", RAM);
4353REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", RAM);
4354REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4355REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4356@end smallexample
4357@item B
4358Program code and read-only data go into the @code{ROM}. Read-write data goes
4359into the @code{RAM}. An image of the initialized data is loaded into the
4360@code{ROM} and will be copied during system start into the @code{RAM}.
4361@smallexample
4362MEMORY
4363 @{
4364 ROM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 3M
4365 RAM : ORIGIN = 0x10000000, LENGTH = 1M
4366 @}
4367
4368REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", ROM);
4369REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", ROM);
4370REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4371REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4372@end smallexample
4373@item C
4374Program code goes into the @code{ROM}. Read-only data goes into the
4375@code{ROM2}. Read-write data goes into the @code{RAM}. An image of the
4376initialized data is loaded into the @code{ROM2} and will be copied during
4377system start into the @code{RAM}.
4378@smallexample
4379MEMORY
4380 @{
4381 ROM : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 2M
4382 ROM2 : ORIGIN = 0x10000000, LENGTH = 1M
4383 RAM : ORIGIN = 0x20000000, LENGTH = 1M
4384 @}
4385
4386REGION_ALIAS("REGION_TEXT", ROM);
4387REGION_ALIAS("REGION_RODATA", ROM2);
4388REGION_ALIAS("REGION_DATA", RAM);
4389REGION_ALIAS("REGION_BSS", RAM);
4390@end smallexample
4391@end table
4392
4393It is possible to write a common system initialization routine to copy the
4394@code{.data} section from @code{ROM} or @code{ROM2} into the @code{RAM} if
4395necessary:
4396@smallexample
4397#include <string.h>
4398
4399extern char data_start [];
4400extern char data_size [];
4401extern char data_load_start [];
4402
4403void copy_data(void)
4404@{
4405 if (data_start != data_load_start)
4406 @{
4407 memcpy(data_start, data_load_start, (size_t) data_size);
4408 @}
4409@}
4410@end smallexample
4411
252b5132 4412@node Miscellaneous Commands
36f63dca 4413@subsection Other Linker Script Commands
252b5132
RH
4414There are a few other linker scripts commands.
4415
4416@table @code
4417@item ASSERT(@var{exp}, @var{message})
4418@kindex ASSERT
4419@cindex assertion in linker script
4420Ensure that @var{exp} is non-zero. If it is zero, then exit the linker
4421with an error code, and print @var{message}.
4422
fd1c4238
NC
4423Note that assertions are checked before the final stages of linking
4424take place. This means that expressions involving symbols PROVIDEd
4425inside section definitions will fail if the user has not set values
4426for those symbols. The only exception to this rule is PROVIDEd
4427symbols that just reference dot. Thus an assertion like this:
4428
4429@smallexample
4430 .stack :
4431 @{
4432 PROVIDE (__stack = .);
4433 PROVIDE (__stack_size = 0x100);
4434 ASSERT ((__stack > (_end + __stack_size)), "Error: No room left for the stack");
4435 @}
4436@end smallexample
4437
4438will fail if @code{__stack_size} is not defined elsewhere. Symbols
4439PROVIDEd outside of section definitions are evaluated earlier, so they
4440can be used inside ASSERTions. Thus:
4441
4442@smallexample
4443 PROVIDE (__stack_size = 0x100);
4444 .stack :
4445 @{
4446 PROVIDE (__stack = .);
4447 ASSERT ((__stack > (_end + __stack_size)), "Error: No room left for the stack");
4448 @}
4449@end smallexample
4450
4451will work.
4452
252b5132
RH
4453@item EXTERN(@var{symbol} @var{symbol} @dots{})
4454@kindex EXTERN
4455@cindex undefined symbol in linker script
4456Force @var{symbol} to be entered in the output file as an undefined
4457symbol. Doing this may, for example, trigger linking of additional
4458modules from standard libraries. You may list several @var{symbol}s for
4459each @code{EXTERN}, and you may use @code{EXTERN} multiple times. This
4460command has the same effect as the @samp{-u} command-line option.
4461
4462@item FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4463@kindex FORCE_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4464@cindex common allocation in linker script
4465This command has the same effect as the @samp{-d} command-line option:
ff5dcc92 4466to make @command{ld} assign space to common symbols even if a relocatable
252b5132
RH
4467output file is specified (@samp{-r}).
4468
4818e05f
AM
4469@item INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4470@kindex INHIBIT_COMMON_ALLOCATION
4471@cindex common allocation in linker script
4472This command has the same effect as the @samp{--no-define-common}
4473command-line option: to make @code{ld} omit the assignment of addresses
4474to common symbols even for a non-relocatable output file.
4475
7bdf4127
AB
4476@item FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION
4477@kindex FORCE_GROUP_ALLOCATION
4478@cindex group allocation in linker script
4479@cindex section groups
4480@cindex COMDAT
4481This command has the same effect as the
4482@samp{--force-group-allocation} command-line option: to make
4483@command{ld} place section group members like normal input sections,
4484and to delete the section groups even if a relocatable output file is
4485specified (@samp{-r}).
4486
53d25da6
AM
4487@item INSERT [ AFTER | BEFORE ] @var{output_section}
4488@kindex INSERT
4489@cindex insert user script into default script
4490This command is typically used in a script specified by @samp{-T} to
4491augment the default @code{SECTIONS} with, for example, overlays. It
4492inserts all prior linker script statements after (or before)
4493@var{output_section}, and also causes @samp{-T} to not override the
4494default linker script. The exact insertion point is as for orphan
4495sections. @xref{Location Counter}. The insertion happens after the
4496linker has mapped input sections to output sections. Prior to the
4497insertion, since @samp{-T} scripts are parsed before the default
4498linker script, statements in the @samp{-T} script occur before the
4499default linker script statements in the internal linker representation
4500of the script. In particular, input section assignments will be made
4501to @samp{-T} output sections before those in the default script. Here
4502is an example of how a @samp{-T} script using @code{INSERT} might look:
4503
4504@smallexample
4505SECTIONS
4506@{
4507 OVERLAY :
4508 @{
4509 .ov1 @{ ov1*(.text) @}
4510 .ov2 @{ ov2*(.text) @}
4511 @}
4512@}
4513INSERT AFTER .text;
4514@end smallexample
4515
31f14901
AM
4516Note that when @samp{-T} is used twice, once to override the default
4517script and once to augment that script using @code{INSERT} the order
4518of parsing and section assignments apply as for the default script.
4519The script with @code{INSERT} should be specified @emph{first} on the
4520command line.
4521
252b5132
RH
4522@item NOCROSSREFS(@var{section} @var{section} @dots{})
4523@kindex NOCROSSREFS(@var{sections})
4524@cindex cross references
ff5dcc92 4525This command may be used to tell @command{ld} to issue an error about any
252b5132
RH
4526references among certain output sections.
4527
4528In certain types of programs, particularly on embedded systems when
4529using overlays, when one section is loaded into memory, another section
4530will not be. Any direct references between the two sections would be
4531errors. For example, it would be an error if code in one section called
4532a function defined in the other section.
4533
4534The @code{NOCROSSREFS} command takes a list of output section names. If
ff5dcc92 4535@command{ld} detects any cross references between the sections, it reports
252b5132
RH
4536an error and returns a non-zero exit status. Note that the
4537@code{NOCROSSREFS} command uses output section names, not input section
4538names.
4539
cdf96953
MF
4540@item NOCROSSREFS_TO(@var{tosection} @var{fromsection} @dots{})
4541@kindex NOCROSSREFS_TO(@var{tosection} @var{fromsections})
4542@cindex cross references
4543This command may be used to tell @command{ld} to issue an error about any
4544references to one section from a list of other sections.
4545
4546The @code{NOCROSSREFS} command is useful when ensuring that two or more
4547output sections are entirely independent but there are situations where
4548a one-way dependency is needed. For example, in a multi-core application
4549there may be shared code that can be called from each core but for safety
4550must never call back.
4551
4552The @code{NOCROSSREFS_TO} command takes a list of output section names.
4553The first section can not be referenced from any of the other sections.
4554If @command{ld} detects any references to the first section from any of
4555the other sections, it reports an error and returns a non-zero exit
4556status. Note that the @code{NOCROSSREFS_TO} command uses output section
4557names, not input section names.
4558
252b5132
RH
4559@ifclear SingleFormat
4560@item OUTPUT_ARCH(@var{bfdarch})
4561@kindex OUTPUT_ARCH(@var{bfdarch})
4562@cindex machine architecture
4563@cindex architecture
4564Specify a particular output machine architecture. The argument is one
4565of the names used by the BFD library (@pxref{BFD}). You can see the
4566architecture of an object file by using the @code{objdump} program with
4567the @samp{-f} option.
4568@end ifclear
01554a74
AM
4569
4570@item LD_FEATURE(@var{string})
4571@kindex LD_FEATURE(@var{string})
4572This command may be used to modify @command{ld} behavior. If
4573@var{string} is @code{"SANE_EXPR"} then absolute symbols and numbers
4574in a script are simply treated as numbers everywhere.
4575@xref{Expression Section}.
252b5132
RH
4576@end table
4577
4578@node Assignments
4579@section Assigning Values to Symbols
4580@cindex assignment in scripts
4581@cindex symbol definition, scripts
4582@cindex variables, defining
4583You may assign a value to a symbol in a linker script. This will define
73ae6183 4584the symbol and place it into the symbol table with a global scope.
252b5132
RH
4585
4586@menu
4587* Simple Assignments:: Simple Assignments
eb8476a6 4588* HIDDEN:: HIDDEN
252b5132 4589* PROVIDE:: PROVIDE
7af8e998 4590* PROVIDE_HIDDEN:: PROVIDE_HIDDEN
73ae6183 4591* Source Code Reference:: How to use a linker script defined symbol in source code
252b5132
RH
4592@end menu
4593
4594@node Simple Assignments
4595@subsection Simple Assignments
4596
4597You may assign to a symbol using any of the C assignment operators:
4598
4599@table @code
4600@item @var{symbol} = @var{expression} ;
4601@itemx @var{symbol} += @var{expression} ;
4602@itemx @var{symbol} -= @var{expression} ;
4603@itemx @var{symbol} *= @var{expression} ;
4604@itemx @var{symbol} /= @var{expression} ;
4605@itemx @var{symbol} <<= @var{expression} ;
4606@itemx @var{symbol} >>= @var{expression} ;
4607@itemx @var{symbol} &= @var{expression} ;
4608@itemx @var{symbol} |= @var{expression} ;
4609@end table
4610
4611The first case will define @var{symbol} to the value of
4612@var{expression}. In the other cases, @var{symbol} must already be
4613defined, and the value will be adjusted accordingly.
4614
4615The special symbol name @samp{.} indicates the location counter. You
b5666f2f 4616may only use this within a @code{SECTIONS} command. @xref{Location Counter}.
252b5132
RH
4617
4618The semicolon after @var{expression} is required.
4619
4620Expressions are defined below; see @ref{Expressions}.
4621
4622You may write symbol assignments as commands in their own right, or as
4623statements within a @code{SECTIONS} command, or as part of an output
4624section description in a @code{SECTIONS} command.
4625
4626The section of the symbol will be set from the section of the
4627expression; for more information, see @ref{Expression Section}.
4628
4629Here is an example showing the three different places that symbol
4630assignments may be used:
4631
4632@smallexample
4633floating_point = 0;
4634SECTIONS
4635@{
4636 .text :
4637 @{
4638 *(.text)
4639 _etext = .;
4640 @}
156e34dd 4641 _bdata = (. + 3) & ~ 3;
252b5132
RH
4642 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
4643@}
4644@end smallexample
4645@noindent
4646In this example, the symbol @samp{floating_point} will be defined as
4647zero. The symbol @samp{_etext} will be defined as the address following
4648the last @samp{.text} input section. The symbol @samp{_bdata} will be
4649defined as the address following the @samp{.text} output section aligned
4650upward to a 4 byte boundary.
4651
eb8476a6
MR
4652@node HIDDEN
4653@subsection HIDDEN
4654@cindex HIDDEN
4655For ELF targeted ports, define a symbol that will be hidden and won't be
4656exported. The syntax is @code{HIDDEN(@var{symbol} = @var{expression})}.
4657
4658Here is the example from @ref{Simple Assignments}, rewritten to use
4659@code{HIDDEN}:
4660
4661@smallexample
4662HIDDEN(floating_point = 0);
4663SECTIONS
4664@{
4665 .text :
4666 @{
4667 *(.text)
4668 HIDDEN(_etext = .);
4669 @}
4670 HIDDEN(_bdata = (. + 3) & ~ 3);
4671 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
4672@}
4673@end smallexample
4674@noindent
4675In this case none of the three symbols will be visible outside this module.
4676
252b5132
RH
4677@node PROVIDE
4678@subsection PROVIDE
4679@cindex PROVIDE
4680In some cases, it is desirable for a linker script to define a symbol
4681only if it is referenced and is not defined by any object included in
4682the link. For example, traditional linkers defined the symbol
4683@samp{etext}. However, ANSI C requires that the user be able to use
4684@samp{etext} as a function name without encountering an error. The
4685@code{PROVIDE} keyword may be used to define a symbol, such as
4686@samp{etext}, only if it is referenced but not defined. The syntax is
4687@code{PROVIDE(@var{symbol} = @var{expression})}.
4688
4689Here is an example of using @code{PROVIDE} to define @samp{etext}:
4690@smallexample
4691SECTIONS
4692@{
4693 .text :
4694 @{
4695 *(.text)
4696 _etext = .;
4697 PROVIDE(etext = .);
4698 @}
4699@}
4700@end smallexample
4701
4702In this example, if the program defines @samp{_etext} (with a leading
3c27360b
JB
4703underscore), the linker will give a multiple definition diagnostic. If,
4704on the other hand, the program defines @samp{etext} (with no leading
252b5132
RH
4705underscore), the linker will silently use the definition in the program.
4706If the program references @samp{etext} but does not define it, the
4707linker will use the definition in the linker script.
4708
b0daac83
NC
4709Note - the @code{PROVIDE} directive considers a common symbol to be
4710defined, even though such a symbol could be combined with the symbol
4711that the @code{PROVIDE} would create. This is particularly important
4712when considering constructor and destructor list symbols such as
4713@samp{__CTOR_LIST__} as these are often defined as common symbols.
4714
7af8e998
L
4715@node PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4716@subsection PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4717@cindex PROVIDE_HIDDEN
4718Similar to @code{PROVIDE}. For ELF targeted ports, the symbol will be
4719hidden and won't be exported.
4720
73ae6183
NC
4721@node Source Code Reference
4722@subsection Source Code Reference
4723
4724Accessing a linker script defined variable from source code is not
4725intuitive. In particular a linker script symbol is not equivalent to
4726a variable declaration in a high level language, it is instead a
4727symbol that does not have a value.
4728
4729Before going further, it is important to note that compilers often
4730transform names in the source code into different names when they are
4731stored in the symbol table. For example, Fortran compilers commonly
4732prepend or append an underscore, and C++ performs extensive @samp{name
4733mangling}. Therefore there might be a discrepancy between the name
4734of a variable as it is used in source code and the name of the same
4735variable as it is defined in a linker script. For example in C a
4736linker script variable might be referred to as:
4737
4738@smallexample
4739 extern int foo;
4740@end smallexample
4741
4742But in the linker script it might be defined as:
4743
4744@smallexample
4745 _foo = 1000;
4746@end smallexample
4747
4748In the remaining examples however it is assumed that no name
4749transformation has taken place.
4750
4751When a symbol is declared in a high level language such as C, two
4752things happen. The first is that the compiler reserves enough space
4753in the program's memory to hold the @emph{value} of the symbol. The
4754second is that the compiler creates an entry in the program's symbol
4755table which holds the symbol's @emph{address}. ie the symbol table
4756contains the address of the block of memory holding the symbol's
4757value. So for example the following C declaration, at file scope:
4758
4759@smallexample
4760 int foo = 1000;
4761@end smallexample
4762
10bf6894 4763creates an entry called @samp{foo} in the symbol table. This entry
73ae6183
NC
4764holds the address of an @samp{int} sized block of memory where the
4765number 1000 is initially stored.
4766
4767When a program references a symbol the compiler generates code that
4768first accesses the symbol table to find the address of the symbol's
4769memory block and then code to read the value from that memory block.
4770So:
4771
4772@smallexample
4773 foo = 1;
4774@end smallexample
4775
4776looks up the symbol @samp{foo} in the symbol table, gets the address
4777associated with this symbol and then writes the value 1 into that
4778address. Whereas:
4779
4780@smallexample
4781 int * a = & foo;
4782@end smallexample
4783
10bf6894 4784looks up the symbol @samp{foo} in the symbol table, gets its address
73ae6183
NC
4785and then copies this address into the block of memory associated with
4786the variable @samp{a}.
4787
4788Linker scripts symbol declarations, by contrast, create an entry in
4789the symbol table but do not assign any memory to them. Thus they are
4790an address without a value. So for example the linker script definition:
4791
4792@smallexample
4793 foo = 1000;
4794@end smallexample
4795
4796creates an entry in the symbol table called @samp{foo} which holds
4797the address of memory location 1000, but nothing special is stored at
4798address 1000. This means that you cannot access the @emph{value} of a
4799linker script defined symbol - it has no value - all you can do is
4800access the @emph{address} of a linker script defined symbol.
4801
4802Hence when you are using a linker script defined symbol in source code
4803you should always take the address of the symbol, and never attempt to
4804use its value. For example suppose you want to copy the contents of a
4805section of memory called .ROM into a section called .FLASH and the
4806linker script contains these declarations:
4807
4808@smallexample
4809@group
4810 start_of_ROM = .ROM;
a5e406b5 4811 end_of_ROM = .ROM + sizeof (.ROM);
73ae6183
NC
4812 start_of_FLASH = .FLASH;
4813@end group
4814@end smallexample
4815
4816Then the C source code to perform the copy would be:
4817
4818@smallexample
4819@group
4820 extern char start_of_ROM, end_of_ROM, start_of_FLASH;
c0065db7 4821
73ae6183
NC
4822 memcpy (& start_of_FLASH, & start_of_ROM, & end_of_ROM - & start_of_ROM);
4823@end group
4824@end smallexample
4825
4826Note the use of the @samp{&} operators. These are correct.
5707d2ad
NC
4827Alternatively the symbols can be treated as the names of vectors or
4828arrays and then the code will again work as expected:
4829
4830@smallexample
4831@group
4832 extern char start_of_ROM[], end_of_ROM[], start_of_FLASH[];
4833
4834 memcpy (start_of_FLASH, start_of_ROM, end_of_ROM - start_of_ROM);
4835@end group
4836@end smallexample
4837
4838Note how using this method does not require the use of @samp{&}
4839operators.
73ae6183 4840
252b5132 4841@node SECTIONS
36f63dca 4842@section SECTIONS Command
252b5132
RH
4843@kindex SECTIONS
4844The @code{SECTIONS} command tells the linker how to map input sections
4845into output sections, and how to place the output sections in memory.
4846
4847The format of the @code{SECTIONS} command is:
4848@smallexample
4849SECTIONS
4850@{
4851 @var{sections-command}
4852 @var{sections-command}
4853 @dots{}
4854@}
4855@end smallexample
4856
4857Each @var{sections-command} may of be one of the following:
4858
4859@itemize @bullet
4860@item
4861an @code{ENTRY} command (@pxref{Entry Point,,Entry command})
4862@item
4863a symbol assignment (@pxref{Assignments})
4864@item
4865an output section description
4866@item
4867an overlay description
4868@end itemize
4869
4870The @code{ENTRY} command and symbol assignments are permitted inside the
4871@code{SECTIONS} command for convenience in using the location counter in
4872those commands. This can also make the linker script easier to
4873understand because you can use those commands at meaningful points in
4874the layout of the output file.
4875
4876Output section descriptions and overlay descriptions are described
4877below.
4878
4879If you do not use a @code{SECTIONS} command in your linker script, the
4880linker will place each input section into an identically named output
4881section in the order that the sections are first encountered in the
4882input files. If all input sections are present in the first file, for
4883example, the order of sections in the output file will match the order
4884in the first input file. The first section will be at address zero.
4885
4886@menu
4887* Output Section Description:: Output section description
4888* Output Section Name:: Output section name
4889* Output Section Address:: Output section address
4890* Input Section:: Input section description
4891* Output Section Data:: Output section data
4892* Output Section Keywords:: Output section keywords
4893* Output Section Discarding:: Output section discarding
4894* Output Section Attributes:: Output section attributes
4895* Overlay Description:: Overlay description
4896@end menu
4897
4898@node Output Section Description
36f63dca 4899@subsection Output Section Description
252b5132
RH
4900The full description of an output section looks like this:
4901@smallexample
a1ab1d2a 4902@group
7e7d5768 4903@var{section} [@var{address}] [(@var{type})] :
0c71d759 4904 [AT(@var{lma})]
1eec346e 4905 [ALIGN(@var{section_align}) | ALIGN_WITH_INPUT]
0c71d759
NC
4906 [SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})]
4907 [@var{constraint}]
252b5132
RH
4908 @{
4909 @var{output-section-command}
4910 @var{output-section-command}
4911 @dots{}
abc9061b 4912 @} [>@var{region}] [AT>@var{lma_region}] [:@var{phdr} :@var{phdr} @dots{}] [=@var{fillexp}] [,]
252b5132
RH
4913@end group
4914@end smallexample
4915
4916Most output sections do not use most of the optional section attributes.
4917
4918The whitespace around @var{section} is required, so that the section
4919name is unambiguous. The colon and the curly braces are also required.
abc9061b
CC
4920The comma at the end may be required if a @var{fillexp} is used and
4921the next @var{sections-command} looks like a continuation of the expression.
252b5132
RH
4922The line breaks and other white space are optional.
4923
4924Each @var{output-section-command} may be one of the following:
4925
4926@itemize @bullet
4927@item
4928a symbol assignment (@pxref{Assignments})
4929@item
4930an input section description (@pxref{Input Section})
4931@item
4932data values to include directly (@pxref{Output Section Data})
4933@item
4934a special output section keyword (@pxref{Output Section Keywords})
4935@end itemize
4936
4937@node Output Section Name
36f63dca 4938@subsection Output Section Name
252b5132
RH
4939@cindex name, section
4940@cindex section name
4941The name of the output section is @var{section}. @var{section} must
4942meet the constraints of your output format. In formats which only
4943support a limited number of sections, such as @code{a.out}, the name
4944must be one of the names supported by the format (@code{a.out}, for
4945example, allows only @samp{.text}, @samp{.data} or @samp{.bss}). If the
4946output format supports any number of sections, but with numbers and not
4947names (as is the case for Oasys), the name should be supplied as a
4948quoted numeric string. A section name may consist of any sequence of
4949characters, but a name which contains any unusual characters such as
4950commas must be quoted.
4951
4952The output section name @samp{/DISCARD/} is special; @ref{Output Section
4953Discarding}.
4954
4955@node Output Section Address
2a16d82a 4956@subsection Output Section Address
252b5132
RH
4957@cindex address, section
4958@cindex section address
4959The @var{address} is an expression for the VMA (the virtual memory
ea5cae92
NC
4960address) of the output section. This address is optional, but if it
4961is provided then the output address will be set exactly as specified.
4962
4963If the output address is not specified then one will be chosen for the
4964section, based on the heuristic below. This address will be adjusted
4965to fit the alignment requirement of the output section. The
4966alignment requirement is the strictest alignment of any input section
4967contained within the output section.
4968
4969The output section address heuristic is as follows:
4970
4971@itemize @bullet
4972@item
4973If an output memory @var{region} is set for the section then it
4974is added to this region and its address will be the next free address
4975in that region.
4976
4977@item
4978If the MEMORY command has been used to create a list of memory
4979regions then the first region which has attributes compatible with the
4980section is selected to contain it. The section's output address will
4981be the next free address in that region; @ref{MEMORY}.
4982
4983@item
4984If no memory regions were specified, or none match the section then
4985the output address will be based on the current value of the location
4986counter.
4987@end itemize
4988
4989@noindent
4990For example:
4991
252b5132
RH
4992@smallexample
4993.text . : @{ *(.text) @}
4994@end smallexample
ea5cae92 4995
252b5132
RH
4996@noindent
4997and
ea5cae92 4998
252b5132
RH
4999@smallexample
5000.text : @{ *(.text) @}
5001@end smallexample
ea5cae92 5002
252b5132
RH
5003@noindent
5004are subtly different. The first will set the address of the
5005@samp{.text} output section to the current value of the location
5006counter. The second will set it to the current value of the location
ea5cae92
NC
5007counter aligned to the strictest alignment of any of the @samp{.text}
5008input sections.
252b5132
RH
5009
5010The @var{address} may be an arbitrary expression; @ref{Expressions}.
5011For example, if you want to align the section on a 0x10 byte boundary,
5012so that the lowest four bits of the section address are zero, you could
5013do something like this:
5014@smallexample
5015.text ALIGN(0x10) : @{ *(.text) @}
5016@end smallexample
5017@noindent
5018This works because @code{ALIGN} returns the current location counter
5019aligned upward to the specified value.
5020
5021Specifying @var{address} for a section will change the value of the
6ce340f1
NC
5022location counter, provided that the section is non-empty. (Empty
5023sections are ignored).
252b5132
RH
5024
5025@node Input Section
36f63dca 5026@subsection Input Section Description
252b5132
RH
5027@cindex input sections
5028@cindex mapping input sections to output sections
5029The most common output section command is an input section description.
5030
5031The input section description is the most basic linker script operation.
5032You use output sections to tell the linker how to lay out your program
5033in memory. You use input section descriptions to tell the linker how to
5034map the input files into your memory layout.
5035
5036@menu
5037* Input Section Basics:: Input section basics
5038* Input Section Wildcards:: Input section wildcard patterns
5039* Input Section Common:: Input section for common symbols
5040* Input Section Keep:: Input section and garbage collection
5041* Input Section Example:: Input section example
5042@end menu
5043
5044@node Input Section Basics
36f63dca 5045@subsubsection Input Section Basics
252b5132
RH
5046@cindex input section basics
5047An input section description consists of a file name optionally followed
5048by a list of section names in parentheses.
5049
5050The file name and the section name may be wildcard patterns, which we
5051describe further below (@pxref{Input Section Wildcards}).
5052
5053The most common input section description is to include all input
5054sections with a particular name in the output section. For example, to
5055include all input @samp{.text} sections, you would write:
5056@smallexample
5057*(.text)
5058@end smallexample
5059@noindent
18625d54 5060Here the @samp{*} is a wildcard which matches any file name. To exclude a list
8f1732fc 5061@cindex EXCLUDE_FILE
18625d54
CM
5062of files from matching the file name wildcard, EXCLUDE_FILE may be used to
5063match all files except the ones specified in the EXCLUDE_FILE list. For
5064example:
252b5132 5065@smallexample
8f1732fc
AB
5066EXCLUDE_FILE (*crtend.o *otherfile.o) *(.ctors)
5067@end smallexample
5068@noindent
5069will cause all .ctors sections from all files except @file{crtend.o}
5070and @file{otherfile.o} to be included. The EXCLUDE_FILE can also be
5071placed inside the section list, for example:
5072@smallexample
b4346c09 5073*(EXCLUDE_FILE (*crtend.o *otherfile.o) .ctors)
252b5132 5074@end smallexample
8f1732fc
AB
5075@noindent
5076The result of this is identically to the previous example. Supporting
5077two syntaxes for EXCLUDE_FILE is useful if the section list contains
5078more than one section, as described below.
252b5132
RH
5079
5080There are two ways to include more than one section:
5081@smallexample
5082*(.text .rdata)
5083*(.text) *(.rdata)
5084@end smallexample
5085@noindent
5086The difference between these is the order in which the @samp{.text} and
5087@samp{.rdata} input sections will appear in the output section. In the
b6bf44ba
AM
5088first example, they will be intermingled, appearing in the same order as
5089they are found in the linker input. In the second example, all
252b5132
RH
5090@samp{.text} input sections will appear first, followed by all
5091@samp{.rdata} input sections.
5092
8f1732fc
AB
5093When using EXCLUDE_FILE with more than one section, if the exclusion
5094is within the section list then the exclusion only applies to the
5095immediately following section, for example:
a5bf7d4f
AB
5096@smallexample
5097*(EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .text .rdata)
5098@end smallexample
5099@noindent
5100will cause all @samp{.text} sections from all files except
5101@file{somefile.o} to be included, while all @samp{.rdata} sections
5102from all files, including @file{somefile.o}, will be included. To
5103exclude the @samp{.rdata} sections from @file{somefile.o} the example
8f1732fc 5104could be modified to:
a5bf7d4f
AB
5105@smallexample
5106*(EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .text EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) .rdata)
5107@end smallexample
8f1732fc
AB
5108@noindent
5109Alternatively, placing the EXCLUDE_FILE outside of the section list,
5110before the input file selection, will cause the exclusion to apply for
5111all sections. Thus the previous example can be rewritten as:
5112@smallexample
5113EXCLUDE_FILE (*somefile.o) *(.text .rdata)
5114@end smallexample
a5bf7d4f 5115
252b5132
RH
5116You can specify a file name to include sections from a particular file.
5117You would do this if one or more of your files contain special data that
5118needs to be at a particular location in memory. For example:
5119@smallexample
5120data.o(.data)
5121@end smallexample
5122
ae17ab41
CM
5123To refine the sections that are included based on the section flags
5124of an input section, INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS may be used.
5125
5126Here is a simple example for using Section header flags for ELF sections:
5127
5128@smallexample
5129@group
5130SECTIONS @{
5131 .text : @{ INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS (SHF_MERGE & SHF_STRINGS) *(.text) @}
5132 .text2 : @{ INPUT_SECTION_FLAGS (!SHF_WRITE) *(.text) @}
5133@}
5134@end group
5135@end smallexample
5136
5137In this example, the output section @samp{.text} will be comprised of any
5138input section matching the name *(.text) whose section header flags
5139@code{SHF_MERGE} and @code{SHF_STRINGS} are set. The output section
5140@samp{.text2} will be comprised of any input section matching the name *(.text)
5141whose section header flag @code{SHF_WRITE} is clear.
5142
967928e9
AM
5143You can also specify files within archives by writing a pattern
5144matching the archive, a colon, then the pattern matching the file,
5145with no whitespace around the colon.
5146
5147@table @samp
5148@item archive:file
5149matches file within archive
5150@item archive:
5151matches the whole archive
5152@item :file
5153matches file but not one in an archive
5154@end table
5155
5156Either one or both of @samp{archive} and @samp{file} can contain shell
5157wildcards. On DOS based file systems, the linker will assume that a
5158single letter followed by a colon is a drive specifier, so
5159@samp{c:myfile.o} is a simple file specification, not @samp{myfile.o}
5160within an archive called @samp{c}. @samp{archive:file} filespecs may
5161also be used within an @code{EXCLUDE_FILE} list, but may not appear in
5162other linker script contexts. For instance, you cannot extract a file
5163from an archive by using @samp{archive:file} in an @code{INPUT}
5164command.
5165
252b5132
RH
5166If you use a file name without a list of sections, then all sections in
5167the input file will be included in the output section. This is not
5168commonly done, but it may by useful on occasion. For example:
5169@smallexample
5170data.o
5171@end smallexample
5172
967928e9
AM
5173When you use a file name which is not an @samp{archive:file} specifier
5174and does not contain any wild card
252b5132
RH
5175characters, the linker will first see if you also specified the file
5176name on the linker command line or in an @code{INPUT} command. If you
5177did not, the linker will attempt to open the file as an input file, as
5178though it appeared on the command line. Note that this differs from an
5179@code{INPUT} command, because the linker will not search for the file in
5180the archive search path.
5181
5182@node Input Section Wildcards
36f63dca 5183@subsubsection Input Section Wildcard Patterns
252b5132
RH
5184@cindex input section wildcards
5185@cindex wildcard file name patterns
5186@cindex file name wildcard patterns
5187@cindex section name wildcard patterns
5188In an input section description, either the file name or the section
5189name or both may be wildcard patterns.
5190
5191The file name of @samp{*} seen in many examples is a simple wildcard
5192pattern for the file name.
5193
5194The wildcard patterns are like those used by the Unix shell.
5195
5196@table @samp
5197@item *
5198matches any number of characters
5199@item ?
5200matches any single character
5201@item [@var{chars}]
5202matches a single instance of any of the @var{chars}; the @samp{-}
5203character may be used to specify a range of characters, as in
5204@samp{[a-z]} to match any lower case letter
5205@item \
5206quotes the following character
5207@end table
5208
252b5132
RH
5209File name wildcard patterns only match files which are explicitly
5210specified on the command line or in an @code{INPUT} command. The linker
5211does not search directories to expand wildcards.
5212
5213If a file name matches more than one wildcard pattern, or if a file name
5214appears explicitly and is also matched by a wildcard pattern, the linker
5215will use the first match in the linker script. For example, this
5216sequence of input section descriptions is probably in error, because the
5217@file{data.o} rule will not be used:
5218@smallexample
5219.data : @{ *(.data) @}
5220.data1 : @{ data.o(.data) @}
5221@end smallexample
5222
bcaa7b3e 5223@cindex SORT_BY_NAME
252b5132
RH
5224Normally, the linker will place files and sections matched by wildcards
5225in the order in which they are seen during the link. You can change
bcaa7b3e
L
5226this by using the @code{SORT_BY_NAME} keyword, which appears before a wildcard
5227pattern in parentheses (e.g., @code{SORT_BY_NAME(.text*)}). When the
5228@code{SORT_BY_NAME} keyword is used, the linker will sort the files or sections
252b5132
RH
5229into ascending order by name before placing them in the output file.
5230
bcaa7b3e 5231@cindex SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT
9a24a276
AM
5232@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} is similar to @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
5233@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} will sort sections into descending order of
5234alignment before placing them in the output file. Placing larger
5235alignments before smaller alignments can reduce the amount of padding
5236needed.
bcaa7b3e 5237
02ecc8e9 5238@cindex SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY
9a24a276
AM
5239@code{SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY} is also similar to @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
5240@code{SORT_BY_INIT_PRIORITY} will sort sections into ascending
5241numerical order of the GCC init_priority attribute encoded in the
5242section name before placing them in the output file. In
5243@code{.init_array.NNNNN} and @code{.fini_array.NNNNN}, @code{NNNNN} is
5244the init_priority. In @code{.ctors.NNNNN} and @code{.dtors.NNNNN},
5245@code{NNNNN} is 65535 minus the init_priority.
02ecc8e9 5246
bcaa7b3e
L
5247@cindex SORT
5248@code{SORT} is an alias for @code{SORT_BY_NAME}.
5249
5250When there are nested section sorting commands in linker script, there
5251can be at most 1 level of nesting for section sorting commands.
5252
5253@enumerate
5254@item
5255@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern)).
1ae5c3ae 5256It will sort the input sections by name first, then by alignment if two
bcaa7b3e
L
5257sections have the same name.
5258@item
5259@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)).
1ae5c3ae 5260It will sort the input sections by alignment first, then by name if two
bcaa7b3e
L
5261sections have the same alignment.
5262@item
c0065db7 5263@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)) is
bcaa7b3e
L
5264treated the same as @code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern).
5265@item
5266@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern))
5267is treated the same as @code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern).
5268@item
5269All other nested section sorting commands are invalid.
5270@end enumerate
5271
a05a5b64 5272When both command-line section sorting option and linker script
bcaa7b3e 5273section sorting command are used, section sorting command always
a05a5b64 5274takes precedence over the command-line option.
bcaa7b3e
L
5275
5276If the section sorting command in linker script isn't nested, the
a05a5b64 5277command-line option will make the section sorting command to be
bcaa7b3e
L
5278treated as nested sorting command.
5279
5280@enumerate
5281@item
5282@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern ) with
5283@option{--sort-sections alignment} is equivalent to
5284@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern)).
5285@item
5286@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (wildcard section pattern) with
5287@option{--sort-section name} is equivalent to
5288@code{SORT_BY_ALIGNMENT} (@code{SORT_BY_NAME} (wildcard section pattern)).
5289@end enumerate
5290
5291If the section sorting command in linker script is nested, the
a05a5b64 5292command-line option will be ignored.
bcaa7b3e 5293
eda680f8 5294@cindex SORT_NONE
a05a5b64 5295@code{SORT_NONE} disables section sorting by ignoring the command-line
eda680f8
L
5296section sorting option.
5297
252b5132
RH
5298If you ever get confused about where input sections are going, use the
5299@samp{-M} linker option to generate a map file. The map file shows
5300precisely how input sections are mapped to output sections.
5301
5302This example shows how wildcard patterns might be used to partition
5303files. This linker script directs the linker to place all @samp{.text}
5304sections in @samp{.text} and all @samp{.bss} sections in @samp{.bss}.
5305The linker will place the @samp{.data} section from all files beginning
5306with an upper case character in @samp{.DATA}; for all other files, the
5307linker will place the @samp{.data} section in @samp{.data}.
5308@smallexample
5309@group
5310SECTIONS @{
5311 .text : @{ *(.text) @}
5312 .DATA : @{ [A-Z]*(.data) @}
5313 .data : @{ *(.data) @}
5314 .bss : @{ *(.bss) @}
5315@}
5316@end group
5317@end smallexample
5318
5319@node Input Section Common
36f63dca 5320@subsubsection Input Section for Common Symbols
252b5132
RH
5321@cindex common symbol placement
5322@cindex uninitialized data placement
5323A special notation is needed for common symbols, because in many object
5324file formats common symbols do not have a particular input section. The
5325linker treats common symbols as though they are in an input section
5326named @samp{COMMON}.
5327
5328You may use file names with the @samp{COMMON} section just as with any
5329other input sections. You can use this to place common symbols from a
5330particular input file in one section while common symbols from other
5331input files are placed in another section.
5332
5333In most cases, common symbols in input files will be placed in the
5334@samp{.bss} section in the output file. For example:
5335@smallexample
5336.bss @{ *(.bss) *(COMMON) @}
5337@end smallexample
5338
5339@cindex scommon section
5340@cindex small common symbols
5341Some object file formats have more than one type of common symbol. For
5342example, the MIPS ELF object file format distinguishes standard common
5343symbols and small common symbols. In this case, the linker will use a
5344different special section name for other types of common symbols. In
5345the case of MIPS ELF, the linker uses @samp{COMMON} for standard common
5346symbols and @samp{.scommon} for small common symbols. This permits you
5347to map the different types of common symbols into memory at different
5348locations.
5349
5350@cindex [COMMON]
5351You will sometimes see @samp{[COMMON]} in old linker scripts. This
5352notation is now considered obsolete. It is equivalent to
5353@samp{*(COMMON)}.
5354
5355@node Input Section Keep
36f63dca 5356@subsubsection Input Section and Garbage Collection
252b5132
RH
5357@cindex KEEP
5358@cindex garbage collection
5359When link-time garbage collection is in use (@samp{--gc-sections}),
a1ab1d2a 5360it is often useful to mark sections that should not be eliminated.
252b5132
RH
5361This is accomplished by surrounding an input section's wildcard entry
5362with @code{KEEP()}, as in @code{KEEP(*(.init))} or
bcaa7b3e 5363@code{KEEP(SORT_BY_NAME(*)(.ctors))}.
252b5132
RH
5364
5365@node Input Section Example
36f63dca 5366@subsubsection Input Section Example
252b5132
RH
5367The following example is a complete linker script. It tells the linker
5368to read all of the sections from file @file{all.o} and place them at the
5369start of output section @samp{outputa} which starts at location
5370@samp{0x10000}. All of section @samp{.input1} from file @file{foo.o}
5371follows immediately, in the same output section. All of section
5372@samp{.input2} from @file{foo.o} goes into output section
5373@samp{outputb}, followed by section @samp{.input1} from @file{foo1.o}.
5374All of the remaining @samp{.input1} and @samp{.input2} sections from any
5375files are written to output section @samp{outputc}.
5376
5377@smallexample
5378@group
5379SECTIONS @{
5380 outputa 0x10000 :
5381 @{
5382 all.o
5383 foo.o (.input1)
5384 @}
36f63dca
NC
5385@end group
5386@group
252b5132
RH
5387 outputb :
5388 @{
5389 foo.o (.input2)
5390 foo1.o (.input1)
5391 @}
36f63dca
NC
5392@end group
5393@group
252b5132
RH
5394 outputc :
5395 @{
5396 *(.input1)
5397 *(.input2)
5398 @}
5399@}
5400@end group
a1ab1d2a 5401@end smallexample
252b5132 5402
cbd0eecf
L
5403If an output section's name is the same as the input section's name
5404and is representable as a C identifier, then the linker will
5405automatically @pxref{PROVIDE} two symbols: __start_SECNAME and
5406__stop_SECNAME, where SECNAME is the name of the section. These
5407indicate the start address and end address of the output section
5408respectively. Note: most section names are not representable as
5409C identifiers because they contain a @samp{.} character.
75bd292b 5410
252b5132 5411@node Output Section Data
36f63dca 5412@subsection Output Section Data
252b5132
RH
5413@cindex data
5414@cindex section data
5415@cindex output section data
a4d5aec7 5416@kindex ASCIZ ``@var{string}''
252b5132
RH
5417@kindex BYTE(@var{expression})
5418@kindex SHORT(@var{expression})
5419@kindex LONG(@var{expression})
5420@kindex QUAD(@var{expression})
5421@kindex SQUAD(@var{expression})
5422You can include explicit bytes of data in an output section by using
5423@code{BYTE}, @code{SHORT}, @code{LONG}, @code{QUAD}, or @code{SQUAD} as
5424an output section command. Each keyword is followed by an expression in
5425parentheses providing the value to store (@pxref{Expressions}). The
5426value of the expression is stored at the current value of the location
5427counter.
5428
5429The @code{BYTE}, @code{SHORT}, @code{LONG}, and @code{QUAD} commands
5430store one, two, four, and eight bytes (respectively). After storing the
5431bytes, the location counter is incremented by the number of bytes
5432stored.
5433
5434For example, this will store the byte 1 followed by the four byte value
5435of the symbol @samp{addr}:
5436@smallexample
5437BYTE(1)
5438LONG(addr)
5439@end smallexample
5440
5441When using a 64 bit host or target, @code{QUAD} and @code{SQUAD} are the
5442same; they both store an 8 byte, or 64 bit, value. When both host and
5443target are 32 bits, an expression is computed as 32 bits. In this case
5444@code{QUAD} stores a 32 bit value zero extended to 64 bits, and
5445@code{SQUAD} stores a 32 bit value sign extended to 64 bits.
5446
5447If the object file format of the output file has an explicit endianness,
5448which is the normal case, the value will be stored in that endianness.
5449When the object file format does not have an explicit endianness, as is
5450true of, for example, S-records, the value will be stored in the
5451endianness of the first input object file.
5452
a4d5aec7
AM
5453You can include a zero-terminated string in an output section by using
5454@code{ASCIZ}. The keyword is followed by a string which is stored at
5455the current value of the location counter adding a zero byte at the
5456end. If the string includes spaces it must be enclosed in double
5457quotes. The string may contain '\n', '\r', '\t' and octal numbers.
5458Hex numbers are not supported.
5459
5460For example, this string of 16 characters will create a 17 byte area
5461@smallexample
5462 ASCIZ "This is 16 bytes"
5463@end smallexample
5464
36f63dca 5465Note---these commands only work inside a section description and not
2b5fc1f5
NC
5466between them, so the following will produce an error from the linker:
5467@smallexample
5468SECTIONS @{@ .text : @{@ *(.text) @}@ LONG(1) .data : @{@ *(.data) @}@ @}@
5469@end smallexample
5470whereas this will work:
5471@smallexample
5472SECTIONS @{@ .text : @{@ *(.text) ; LONG(1) @}@ .data : @{@ *(.data) @}@ @}@
5473@end smallexample
75bd292b 5474
252b5132
RH
5475@kindex FILL(@var{expression})
5476@cindex holes, filling
5477@cindex unspecified memory
5478You may use the @code{FILL} command to set the fill pattern for the
5479current section. It is followed by an expression in parentheses. Any
5480otherwise unspecified regions of memory within the section (for example,
5481gaps left due to the required alignment of input sections) are filled
a139d329 5482with the value of the expression, repeated as
252b5132
RH
5483necessary. A @code{FILL} statement covers memory locations after the
5484point at which it occurs in the section definition; by including more
5485than one @code{FILL} statement, you can have different fill patterns in
5486different parts of an output section.
5487
5488This example shows how to fill unspecified regions of memory with the
563e308f 5489value @samp{0x90}:
252b5132 5490@smallexample
563e308f 5491FILL(0x90909090)
252b5132
RH
5492@end smallexample
5493
5494The @code{FILL} command is similar to the @samp{=@var{fillexp}} output
9673c93c 5495section attribute, but it only affects the
252b5132
RH
5496part of the section following the @code{FILL} command, rather than the
5497entire section. If both are used, the @code{FILL} command takes
9673c93c 5498precedence. @xref{Output Section Fill}, for details on the fill
a139d329 5499expression.
252b5132 5500
2d5783fa
NC
5501@kindex LINKER_VERSION
5502@cindex LINKER_VERSION
5503Inserts a string containing the version of the linker at the current
5504point. Note - by default this directive is disabled and will do
5505nothing. It only becomes active if the
5506@option{--enable-linker-version} command line option is used.
5507
5508Built-in linker scripts for ELF based targets already include this
5509directive in their @samp{.comment} section.
5510
252b5132 5511@node Output Section Keywords
36f63dca 5512@subsection Output Section Keywords
252b5132
RH
5513There are a couple of keywords which can appear as output section
5514commands.
5515
5516@table @code
5517@kindex CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS
5518@cindex input filename symbols
5519@cindex filename symbols
5520@item CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS
5521The command tells the linker to create a symbol for each input file.
5522The name of each symbol will be the name of the corresponding input
5523file. The section of each symbol will be the output section in which
5524the @code{CREATE_OBJECT_SYMBOLS} command appears.
5525
5526This is conventional for the a.out object file format. It is not
5527normally used for any other object file format.
5528
5529@kindex CONSTRUCTORS
5530@cindex C++ constructors, arranging in link
5531@cindex constructors, arranging in link
5532@item CONSTRUCTORS
5533When linking using the a.out object file format, the linker uses an
5534unusual set construct to support C++ global constructors and
5535destructors. When linking object file formats which do not support
5536arbitrary sections, such as ECOFF and XCOFF, the linker will
5537automatically recognize C++ global constructors and destructors by name.
5538For these object file formats, the @code{CONSTRUCTORS} command tells the
5539linker to place constructor information in the output section where the
5540@code{CONSTRUCTORS} command appears. The @code{CONSTRUCTORS} command is
5541ignored for other object file formats.
5542
5543The symbol @w{@code{__CTOR_LIST__}} marks the start of the global
7e69709c
AM
5544constructors, and the symbol @w{@code{__CTOR_END__}} marks the end.
5545Similarly, @w{@code{__DTOR_LIST__}} and @w{@code{__DTOR_END__}} mark
5546the start and end of the global destructors. The
252b5132
RH
5547first word in the list is the number of entries, followed by the address
5548of each constructor or destructor, followed by a zero word. The
5549compiler must arrange to actually run the code. For these object file
5550formats @sc{gnu} C++ normally calls constructors from a subroutine
5551@code{__main}; a call to @code{__main} is automatically inserted into
5552the startup code for @code{main}. @sc{gnu} C++ normally runs
5553destructors either by using @code{atexit}, or directly from the function
5554@code{exit}.
5555
5556For object file formats such as @code{COFF} or @code{ELF} which support
5557arbitrary section names, @sc{gnu} C++ will normally arrange to put the
5558addresses of global constructors and destructors into the @code{.ctors}
5559and @code{.dtors} sections. Placing the following sequence into your
5560linker script will build the sort of table which the @sc{gnu} C++
5561runtime code expects to see.
5562
5563@smallexample
5564 __CTOR_LIST__ = .;
5565 LONG((__CTOR_END__ - __CTOR_LIST__) / 4 - 2)
5566 *(.ctors)
5567 LONG(0)
5568 __CTOR_END__ = .;
5569 __DTOR_LIST__ = .;
5570 LONG((__DTOR_END__ - __DTOR_LIST__) / 4 - 2)
5571 *(.dtors)
5572 LONG(0)
5573 __DTOR_END__ = .;
5574@end smallexample
5575
5576If you are using the @sc{gnu} C++ support for initialization priority,
5577which provides some control over the order in which global constructors
5578are run, you must sort the constructors at link time to ensure that they
5579are executed in the correct order. When using the @code{CONSTRUCTORS}
bcaa7b3e
L
5580command, use @samp{SORT_BY_NAME(CONSTRUCTORS)} instead. When using the
5581@code{.ctors} and @code{.dtors} sections, use @samp{*(SORT_BY_NAME(.ctors))} and
5582@samp{*(SORT_BY_NAME(.dtors))} instead of just @samp{*(.ctors)} and
252b5132
RH
5583@samp{*(.dtors)}.
5584
5585Normally the compiler and linker will handle these issues automatically,
5586and you will not need to concern yourself with them. However, you may
5587need to consider this if you are using C++ and writing your own linker
5588scripts.
5589
5590@end table
5591
5592@node Output Section Discarding
36f63dca 5593@subsection Output Section Discarding
252b5132
RH
5594@cindex discarding sections
5595@cindex sections, discarding
5596@cindex removing sections
2edab91c
AM
5597The linker will not normally create output sections with no contents.
5598This is for convenience when referring to input sections that may or
5599may not be present in any of the input files. For example:
252b5132 5600@smallexample
49c13adb 5601.foo : @{ *(.foo) @}
252b5132
RH
5602@end smallexample
5603@noindent
5604will only create a @samp{.foo} section in the output file if there is a
74541ad4
AM
5605@samp{.foo} section in at least one input file, and if the input
5606sections are not all empty. Other link script directives that allocate
2edab91c
AM
5607space in an output section will also create the output section. So
5608too will assignments to dot even if the assignment does not create
5609space, except for @samp{. = 0}, @samp{. = . + 0}, @samp{. = sym},
5610@samp{. = . + sym} and @samp{. = ALIGN (. != 0, expr, 1)} when
5611@samp{sym} is an absolute symbol of value 0 defined in the script.
5612This allows you to force output of an empty section with @samp{. = .}.
74541ad4 5613
a0976ea4 5614The linker will ignore address assignments (@pxref{Output Section Address})
74541ad4
AM
5615on discarded output sections, except when the linker script defines
5616symbols in the output section. In that case the linker will obey
a0976ea4
AM
5617the address assignments, possibly advancing dot even though the
5618section is discarded.
252b5132
RH
5619
5620@cindex /DISCARD/
5621The special output section name @samp{/DISCARD/} may be used to discard
5622input sections. Any input sections which are assigned to an output
5623section named @samp{/DISCARD/} are not included in the output file.
5624
99fabbc9
JL
5625This can be used to discard input sections marked with the ELF flag
5626@code{SHF_GNU_RETAIN}, which would otherwise have been saved from linker
5627garbage collection.
5628
a2e098c3
NC
5629Note, sections that match the @samp{/DISCARD/} output section will be
5630discarded even if they are in an ELF section group which has other
5631members which are not being discarded. This is deliberate.
5632Discarding takes precedence over grouping.
5633
252b5132 5634@node Output Section Attributes
36f63dca 5635@subsection Output Section Attributes
252b5132
RH
5636@cindex output section attributes
5637We showed above that the full description of an output section looked
5638like this:
0c71d759 5639
252b5132 5640@smallexample
a1ab1d2a 5641@group
7e7d5768 5642@var{section} [@var{address}] [(@var{type})] :
0c71d759 5643 [AT(@var{lma})]
3bbec4bd 5644 [ALIGN(@var{section_align}) | ALIGN_WITH_INPUT]
0c71d759
NC
5645 [SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})]
5646 [@var{constraint}]
252b5132
RH
5647 @{
5648 @var{output-section-command}
5649 @var{output-section-command}
5650 @dots{}
562d3460 5651 @} [>@var{region}] [AT>@var{lma_region}] [:@var{phdr} :@var{phdr} @dots{}] [=@var{fillexp}]
252b5132
RH
5652@end group
5653@end smallexample
0c71d759 5654
252b5132
RH
5655We've already described @var{section}, @var{address}, and
5656@var{output-section-command}. In this section we will describe the
5657remaining section attributes.
5658
a1ab1d2a 5659@menu
252b5132
RH
5660* Output Section Type:: Output section type
5661* Output Section LMA:: Output section LMA
bbf115d3 5662* Forced Output Alignment:: Forced Output Alignment
7e7d5768 5663* Forced Input Alignment:: Forced Input Alignment
0c71d759 5664* Output Section Constraint:: Output section constraint
252b5132
RH
5665* Output Section Region:: Output section region
5666* Output Section Phdr:: Output section phdr
5667* Output Section Fill:: Output section fill
5668@end menu
5669
5670@node Output Section Type
36f63dca 5671@subsubsection Output Section Type
252b5132
RH
5672Each output section may have a type. The type is a keyword in
5673parentheses. The following types are defined:
5674
5675@table @code
dcb53d93 5676
252b5132
RH
5677@item NOLOAD
5678The section should be marked as not loadable, so that it will not be
5679loaded into memory when the program is run.
dcb53d93 5680
6b86da53
LB
5681@item READONLY
5682The section should be marked as read-only.
dcb53d93 5683
252b5132 5684@item DSECT
c212f39d
FS
5685@item COPY
5686@item INFO
5687@item OVERLAY
252b5132
RH
5688These type names are supported for backward compatibility, and are
5689rarely used. They all have the same effect: the section should be
5690marked as not allocatable, so that no memory is allocated for the
5691section when the program is run.
dcb53d93 5692
c212f39d
FS
5693@item TYPE = @var{type}
5694Set the section type to the integer @var{type}. When generating an ELF
5695output file, type names @code{SHT_PROGBITS}, @code{SHT_STRTAB},
5c14cc55 5696@code{SHT_NOTE}, @code{SHT_NOBITS}, @code{SHT_INIT_ARRAY},
c212f39d
FS
5697@code{SHT_FINI_ARRAY}, and @code{SHT_PREINIT_ARRAY} are also allowed
5698for @var{type}. It is the user's responsibility to ensure that any
5699special requirements of the section type are met.
dcb53d93
NC
5700
5701Note - the TYPE only is used if some or all of the contents of the
5702section do not have an implicit type of their own. So for example:
5703@smallexample
5704 .foo . TYPE = SHT_PROGBITS @{ *(.bar) @}
5705@end smallexample
5706will set the type of section @samp{.foo} to the type of the section
5707@samp{.bar} in the input files, which may not be the SHT_PROGBITS
5708type. Whereas:
5709@smallexample
5710 .foo . TYPE = SHT_PROGBITS @{ BYTE(1) @}
5711@end smallexample
5712will set the type of @samp{.foo} to SHT_PROGBBITS. If it is necessary
5713to override the type of incoming sections and force the output section
5714type then an extra piece of untyped data will be needed:
5715@smallexample
5716 .foo . TYPE = SHT_PROGBITS @{ BYTE(1); *(.bar) @}
5717@end smallexample
5718
c212f39d
FS
5719@item READONLY ( TYPE = @var{type} )
5720This form of the syntax combines the @var{READONLY} type with the
5721type specified by @var{type}.
dcb53d93 5722
252b5132
RH
5723@end table
5724
5725@kindex NOLOAD
5726@cindex prevent unnecessary loading
5727@cindex loading, preventing
5728The linker normally sets the attributes of an output section based on
5729the input sections which map into it. You can override this by using
5730the section type. For example, in the script sample below, the
5731@samp{ROM} section is addressed at memory location @samp{0} and does not
2e76e85a 5732need to be loaded when the program is run.
252b5132
RH
5733@smallexample
5734@group
5735SECTIONS @{
5736 ROM 0 (NOLOAD) : @{ @dots{} @}
5737 @dots{}
5738@}
5739@end group
5740@end smallexample
5741
5742@node Output Section LMA
36f63dca 5743@subsubsection Output Section LMA
562d3460 5744@kindex AT>@var{lma_region}
252b5132
RH
5745@kindex AT(@var{lma})
5746@cindex load address
5747@cindex section load address
5748Every section has a virtual address (VMA) and a load address (LMA); see
ea5cae92
NC
5749@ref{Basic Script Concepts}. The virtual address is specified by the
5750@pxref{Output Section Address} described earlier. The load address is
5751specified by the @code{AT} or @code{AT>} keywords. Specifying a load
5752address is optional.
6bdafbeb 5753
ea5cae92
NC
5754The @code{AT} keyword takes an expression as an argument. This
5755specifies the exact load address of the section. The @code{AT>} keyword
5756takes the name of a memory region as an argument. @xref{MEMORY}. The
5757load address of the section is set to the next free address in the
5758region, aligned to the section's alignment requirements.
dc0b6aa0
AM
5759
5760If neither @code{AT} nor @code{AT>} is specified for an allocatable
ea5cae92
NC
5761section, the linker will use the following heuristic to determine the
5762load address:
5763
5764@itemize @bullet
5765@item
5766If the section has a specific VMA address, then this is used as
5767the LMA address as well.
5768
5769@item
5770If the section is not allocatable then its LMA is set to its VMA.
5771
5772@item
5773Otherwise if a memory region can be found that is compatible
5774with the current section, and this region contains at least one
5775section, then the LMA is set so the difference between the
5776VMA and LMA is the same as the difference between the VMA and LMA of
5777the last section in the located region.
5778
5779@item
5780If no memory regions have been declared then a default region
5781that covers the entire address space is used in the previous step.
5782
5783@item
5784If no suitable region could be found, or there was no previous
5785section then the LMA is set equal to the VMA.
5786@end itemize
252b5132
RH
5787
5788@cindex ROM initialized data
5789@cindex initialized data in ROM
5790This feature is designed to make it easy to build a ROM image. For
5791example, the following linker script creates three output sections: one
5792called @samp{.text}, which starts at @code{0x1000}, one called
5793@samp{.mdata}, which is loaded at the end of the @samp{.text} section
5794even though its VMA is @code{0x2000}, and one called @samp{.bss} to hold
5795uninitialized data at address @code{0x3000}. The symbol @code{_data} is
5796defined with the value @code{0x2000}, which shows that the location
5797counter holds the VMA value, not the LMA value.
5798
5799@smallexample
5800@group
5801SECTIONS
5802 @{
5803 .text 0x1000 : @{ *(.text) _etext = . ; @}
a1ab1d2a 5804 .mdata 0x2000 :
252b5132
RH
5805 AT ( ADDR (.text) + SIZEOF (.text) )
5806 @{ _data = . ; *(.data); _edata = . ; @}
5807 .bss 0x3000 :
5808 @{ _bstart = . ; *(.bss) *(COMMON) ; _bend = . ;@}
5809@}
5810@end group
5811@end smallexample
5812
5813The run-time initialization code for use with a program generated with
5814this linker script would include something like the following, to copy
5815the initialized data from the ROM image to its runtime address. Notice
5816how this code takes advantage of the symbols defined by the linker
5817script.
5818
5819@smallexample
5820@group
5821extern char _etext, _data, _edata, _bstart, _bend;
5822char *src = &_etext;
5823char *dst = &_data;
5824
ea5cae92
NC
5825/* ROM has data at end of text; copy it. */
5826while (dst < &_edata)
252b5132 5827 *dst++ = *src++;
252b5132 5828
ea5cae92 5829/* Zero bss. */
252b5132
RH
5830for (dst = &_bstart; dst< &_bend; dst++)
5831 *dst = 0;
5832@end group
5833@end smallexample
5834
bbf115d3
L
5835@node Forced Output Alignment
5836@subsubsection Forced Output Alignment
5837@kindex ALIGN(@var{section_align})
5838@cindex forcing output section alignment
5839@cindex output section alignment
1eec346e 5840You can increase an output section's alignment by using ALIGN. As an
13075d04
SH
5841alternative you can enforce that the difference between the VMA and LMA remains
5842intact throughout this output section with the ALIGN_WITH_INPUT attribute.
bbf115d3 5843
7e7d5768
AM
5844@node Forced Input Alignment
5845@subsubsection Forced Input Alignment
5846@kindex SUBALIGN(@var{subsection_align})
5847@cindex forcing input section alignment
5848@cindex input section alignment
5849You can force input section alignment within an output section by using
5850SUBALIGN. The value specified overrides any alignment given by input
5851sections, whether larger or smaller.
5852
0c71d759
NC
5853@node Output Section Constraint
5854@subsubsection Output Section Constraint
5855@kindex ONLY_IF_RO
5856@kindex ONLY_IF_RW
5857@cindex constraints on output sections
5858You can specify that an output section should only be created if all
5859of its input sections are read-only or all of its input sections are
5860read-write by using the keyword @code{ONLY_IF_RO} and
5861@code{ONLY_IF_RW} respectively.
5862
252b5132 5863@node Output Section Region
36f63dca 5864@subsubsection Output Section Region
252b5132
RH
5865@kindex >@var{region}
5866@cindex section, assigning to memory region
5867@cindex memory regions and sections
5868You can assign a section to a previously defined region of memory by
5869using @samp{>@var{region}}. @xref{MEMORY}.
5870
5871Here is a simple example:
5872@smallexample
5873@group
5874MEMORY @{ rom : ORIGIN = 0x1000, LENGTH = 0x1000 @}
5875SECTIONS @{ ROM : @{ *(.text) @} >rom @}
5876@end group
5877@end smallexample
5878
5879@node Output Section Phdr
36f63dca 5880@subsubsection Output Section Phdr
252b5132
RH
5881@kindex :@var{phdr}
5882@cindex section, assigning to program header
5883@cindex program headers and sections
5884You can assign a section to a previously defined program segment by
5885using @samp{:@var{phdr}}. @xref{PHDRS}. If a section is assigned to
5886one or more segments, then all subsequent allocated sections will be
5887assigned to those segments as well, unless they use an explicitly
5888@code{:@var{phdr}} modifier. You can use @code{:NONE} to tell the
5889linker to not put the section in any segment at all.
5890
5891Here is a simple example:
5892@smallexample
5893@group
5894PHDRS @{ text PT_LOAD ; @}
5895SECTIONS @{ .text : @{ *(.text) @} :text @}
5896@end group
5897@end smallexample
5898
5899@node Output Section Fill
36f63dca 5900@subsubsection Output Section Fill
252b5132
RH
5901@kindex =@var{fillexp}
5902@cindex section fill pattern
5903@cindex fill pattern, entire section
5904You can set the fill pattern for an entire section by using
5905@samp{=@var{fillexp}}. @var{fillexp} is an expression
5906(@pxref{Expressions}). Any otherwise unspecified regions of memory
5907within the output section (for example, gaps left due to the required
a139d329
AM
5908alignment of input sections) will be filled with the value, repeated as
5909necessary. If the fill expression is a simple hex number, ie. a string
9673c93c 5910of hex digit starting with @samp{0x} and without a trailing @samp{k} or @samp{M}, then
a139d329
AM
5911an arbitrarily long sequence of hex digits can be used to specify the
5912fill pattern; Leading zeros become part of the pattern too. For all
9673c93c 5913other cases, including extra parentheses or a unary @code{+}, the fill
a139d329
AM
5914pattern is the four least significant bytes of the value of the
5915expression. In all cases, the number is big-endian.
252b5132
RH
5916
5917You can also change the fill value with a @code{FILL} command in the
9673c93c 5918output section commands; (@pxref{Output Section Data}).
252b5132
RH
5919
5920Here is a simple example:
5921@smallexample
5922@group
563e308f 5923SECTIONS @{ .text : @{ *(.text) @} =0x90909090 @}
252b5132
RH
5924@end group
5925@end smallexample
5926
5927@node Overlay Description
36f63dca 5928@subsection Overlay Description
252b5132
RH
5929@kindex OVERLAY
5930@cindex overlays
5931An overlay description provides an easy way to describe sections which
5932are to be loaded as part of a single memory image but are to be run at
5933the same memory address. At run time, some sort of overlay manager will
5934copy the overlaid sections in and out of the runtime memory address as
5935required, perhaps by simply manipulating addressing bits. This approach
5936can be useful, for example, when a certain region of memory is faster
5937than another.
5938
5939Overlays are described using the @code{OVERLAY} command. The
5940@code{OVERLAY} command is used within a @code{SECTIONS} command, like an
5941output section description. The full syntax of the @code{OVERLAY}
5942command is as follows:
5943@smallexample
5944@group
5945OVERLAY [@var{start}] : [NOCROSSREFS] [AT ( @var{ldaddr} )]
5946 @{
5947 @var{secname1}
5948 @{
5949 @var{output-section-command}
5950 @var{output-section-command}
5951 @dots{}
5952 @} [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}]
5953 @var{secname2}
5954 @{
5955 @var{output-section-command}
5956 @var{output-section-command}
5957 @dots{}
5958 @} [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}]
5959 @dots{}
abc9061b 5960 @} [>@var{region}] [:@var{phdr}@dots{}] [=@var{fill}] [,]
252b5132
RH
5961@end group
5962@end smallexample
5963
5964Everything is optional except @code{OVERLAY} (a keyword), and each
5965section must have a name (@var{secname1} and @var{secname2} above). The
5966section definitions within the @code{OVERLAY} construct are identical to
11e7fd74 5967those within the general @code{SECTIONS} construct (@pxref{SECTIONS}),
252b5132
RH
5968except that no addresses and no memory regions may be defined for
5969sections within an @code{OVERLAY}.
5970
abc9061b
CC
5971The comma at the end may be required if a @var{fill} is used and
5972the next @var{sections-command} looks like a continuation of the expression.
5973
252b5132
RH
5974The sections are all defined with the same starting address. The load
5975addresses of the sections are arranged such that they are consecutive in
5976memory starting at the load address used for the @code{OVERLAY} as a
5977whole (as with normal section definitions, the load address is optional,
5978and defaults to the start address; the start address is also optional,
5979and defaults to the current value of the location counter).
5980
56dd11f0
NC
5981If the @code{NOCROSSREFS} keyword is used, and there are any
5982references among the sections, the linker will report an error. Since
5983the sections all run at the same address, it normally does not make
5984sense for one section to refer directly to another.
5985@xref{Miscellaneous Commands, NOCROSSREFS}.
252b5132
RH
5986
5987For each section within the @code{OVERLAY}, the linker automatically
34711ca3 5988provides two symbols. The symbol @code{__load_start_@var{secname}} is
252b5132
RH
5989defined as the starting load address of the section. The symbol
5990@code{__load_stop_@var{secname}} is defined as the final load address of
5991the section. Any characters within @var{secname} which are not legal
5992within C identifiers are removed. C (or assembler) code may use these
5993symbols to move the overlaid sections around as necessary.
5994
5995At the end of the overlay, the value of the location counter is set to
5996the start address of the overlay plus the size of the largest section.
5997
5998Here is an example. Remember that this would appear inside a
5999@code{SECTIONS} construct.
6000@smallexample
6001@group
6002 OVERLAY 0x1000 : AT (0x4000)
6003 @{
6004 .text0 @{ o1/*.o(.text) @}
6005 .text1 @{ o2/*.o(.text) @}
6006 @}
6007@end group
6008@end smallexample
6009@noindent
6010This will define both @samp{.text0} and @samp{.text1} to start at
6011address 0x1000. @samp{.text0} will be loaded at address 0x4000, and
6012@samp{.text1} will be loaded immediately after @samp{.text0}. The
34711ca3 6013following symbols will be defined if referenced: @code{__load_start_text0},
252b5132
RH
6014@code{__load_stop_text0}, @code{__load_start_text1},
6015@code{__load_stop_text1}.
6016
6017C code to copy overlay @code{.text1} into the overlay area might look
6018like the following.
6019
6020@smallexample
6021@group
6022 extern char __load_start_text1, __load_stop_text1;
6023 memcpy ((char *) 0x1000, &__load_start_text1,
6024 &__load_stop_text1 - &__load_start_text1);
6025@end group
6026@end smallexample
6027
6028Note that the @code{OVERLAY} command is just syntactic sugar, since
6029everything it does can be done using the more basic commands. The above
6030example could have been written identically as follows.
6031
6032@smallexample
6033@group
6034 .text0 0x1000 : AT (0x4000) @{ o1/*.o(.text) @}
34711ca3
AM
6035 PROVIDE (__load_start_text0 = LOADADDR (.text0));
6036 PROVIDE (__load_stop_text0 = LOADADDR (.text0) + SIZEOF (.text0));
252b5132 6037 .text1 0x1000 : AT (0x4000 + SIZEOF (.text0)) @{ o2/*.o(.text) @}
34711ca3
AM
6038 PROVIDE (__load_start_text1 = LOADADDR (.text1));
6039 PROVIDE (__load_stop_text1 = LOADADDR (.text1) + SIZEOF (.text1));
252b5132
RH
6040 . = 0x1000 + MAX (SIZEOF (.text0), SIZEOF (.text1));
6041@end group
6042@end smallexample
6043
6044@node MEMORY
36f63dca 6045@section MEMORY Command
252b5132
RH
6046@kindex MEMORY
6047@cindex memory regions
6048@cindex regions of memory
6049@cindex allocating memory
6050@cindex discontinuous memory
6051The linker's default configuration permits allocation of all available
6052memory. You can override this by using the @code{MEMORY} command.
6053
6054The @code{MEMORY} command describes the location and size of blocks of
6055memory in the target. You can use it to describe which memory regions
6056may be used by the linker, and which memory regions it must avoid. You
6057can then assign sections to particular memory regions. The linker will
6058set section addresses based on the memory regions, and will warn about
6059regions that become too full. The linker will not shuffle sections
6060around to fit into the available regions.
6061
127fcdff
AB
6062A linker script may contain many uses of the @code{MEMORY} command,
6063however, all memory blocks defined are treated as if they were
6064specified inside a single @code{MEMORY} command. The syntax for
6065@code{MEMORY} is:
252b5132
RH
6066@smallexample
6067@group
a1ab1d2a 6068MEMORY
252b5132
RH
6069 @{
6070 @var{name} [(@var{attr})] : ORIGIN = @var{origin}, LENGTH = @var{len}
6071 @dots{}
6072 @}
6073@end group
6074@end smallexample
6075
6076The @var{name} is a name used in the linker script to refer to the
6077region. The region name has no meaning outside of the linker script.
6078Region names are stored in a separate name space, and will not conflict
6079with symbol names, file names, or section names. Each memory region
4a93e180
NC
6080must have a distinct name within the @code{MEMORY} command. However you can
6081add later alias names to existing memory regions with the @ref{REGION_ALIAS}
9d5777a3 6082command.
252b5132
RH
6083
6084@cindex memory region attributes
6085The @var{attr} string is an optional list of attributes that specify
6086whether to use a particular memory region for an input section which is
6087not explicitly mapped in the linker script. As described in
6088@ref{SECTIONS}, if you do not specify an output section for some input
6089section, the linker will create an output section with the same name as
6090the input section. If you define region attributes, the linker will use
6091them to select the memory region for the output section that it creates.
6092
6093The @var{attr} string must consist only of the following characters:
6094@table @samp
6095@item R
6096Read-only section
6097@item W
6098Read/write section
6099@item X
6100Executable section
6101@item A
6102Allocatable section
6103@item I
6104Initialized section
6105@item L
6106Same as @samp{I}
6107@item !
c09e9a8c 6108Invert the sense of any of the attributes that follow
252b5132
RH
6109@end table
6110
81c688d5 6111If an unmapped section matches any of the listed attributes other than
252b5132 6112@samp{!}, it will be placed in the memory region. The @samp{!}
81c688d5
NC
6113attribute reverses the test for the characters that follow, so that an
6114unmapped section will be placed in the memory region only if it does
6115not match any of the attributes listed afterwards. Thus an attribute
6116string of @samp{RW!X} will match any unmapped section that has either
6117or both of the @samp{R} and @samp{W} attributes, but only as long as
6118the section does not also have the @samp{X} attribute.
252b5132
RH
6119
6120@kindex ORIGIN =
6121@kindex o =
6122@kindex org =
9cd6d51a
NC
6123The @var{origin} is an numerical expression for the start address of
6124the memory region. The expression must evaluate to a constant and it
6125cannot involve any symbols. The keyword @code{ORIGIN} may be
6126abbreviated to @code{org} or @code{o} (but not, for example,
6127@code{ORG}).
252b5132
RH
6128
6129@kindex LENGTH =
6130@kindex len =
6131@kindex l =
6132The @var{len} is an expression for the size in bytes of the memory
6133region. As with the @var{origin} expression, the expression must
9cd6d51a
NC
6134be numerical only and must evaluate to a constant. The keyword
6135@code{LENGTH} may be abbreviated to @code{len} or @code{l}.
252b5132
RH
6136
6137In the following example, we specify that there are two memory regions
6138available for allocation: one starting at @samp{0} for 256 kilobytes,
6139and the other starting at @samp{0x40000000} for four megabytes. The
6140linker will place into the @samp{rom} memory region every section which
6141is not explicitly mapped into a memory region, and is either read-only
6142or executable. The linker will place other sections which are not
6143explicitly mapped into a memory region into the @samp{ram} memory
6144region.
6145
6146@smallexample
6147@group
a1ab1d2a 6148MEMORY
252b5132
RH
6149 @{
6150 rom (rx) : ORIGIN = 0, LENGTH = 256K
6151 ram (!rx) : org = 0x40000000, l = 4M
6152 @}
6153@end group
6154@end smallexample
6155
6156Once you define a memory region, you can direct the linker to place
6157specific output sections into that memory region by using the
6158@samp{>@var{region}} output section attribute. For example, if you have
6159a memory region named @samp{mem}, you would use @samp{>mem} in the
6160output section definition. @xref{Output Section Region}. If no address
6161was specified for the output section, the linker will set the address to
6162the next available address within the memory region. If the combined
6163output sections directed to a memory region are too large for the
6164region, the linker will issue an error message.
6165
3ec57632 6166It is possible to access the origin and length of a memory in an
c0065db7 6167expression via the @code{ORIGIN(@var{memory})} and
3ec57632
NC
6168@code{LENGTH(@var{memory})} functions:
6169
6170@smallexample
6171@group
c0065db7 6172 _fstack = ORIGIN(ram) + LENGTH(ram) - 4;
3ec57632
NC
6173@end group
6174@end smallexample
6175
252b5132
RH
6176@node PHDRS
6177@section PHDRS Command
6178@kindex PHDRS
6179@cindex program headers
6180@cindex ELF program headers
6181@cindex program segments
6182@cindex segments, ELF
6183The ELF object file format uses @dfn{program headers}, also knows as
6184@dfn{segments}. The program headers describe how the program should be
6185loaded into memory. You can print them out by using the @code{objdump}
6186program with the @samp{-p} option.
6187
6188When you run an ELF program on a native ELF system, the system loader
6189reads the program headers in order to figure out how to load the
6190program. This will only work if the program headers are set correctly.
6191This manual does not describe the details of how the system loader
6192interprets program headers; for more information, see the ELF ABI.
6193
6194The linker will create reasonable program headers by default. However,
6195in some cases, you may need to specify the program headers more
6196precisely. You may use the @code{PHDRS} command for this purpose. When
6197the linker sees the @code{PHDRS} command in the linker script, it will
6198not create any program headers other than the ones specified.
6199
6200The linker only pays attention to the @code{PHDRS} command when
6201generating an ELF output file. In other cases, the linker will simply
6202ignore @code{PHDRS}.
6203
6204This is the syntax of the @code{PHDRS} command. The words @code{PHDRS},
6205@code{FILEHDR}, @code{AT}, and @code{FLAGS} are keywords.
6206
6207@smallexample
6208@group
6209PHDRS
6210@{
6211 @var{name} @var{type} [ FILEHDR ] [ PHDRS ] [ AT ( @var{address} ) ]
6212 [ FLAGS ( @var{flags} ) ] ;
6213@}
6214@end group
6215@end smallexample
6216
6217The @var{name} is used only for reference in the @code{SECTIONS} command
6218of the linker script. It is not put into the output file. Program
6219header names are stored in a separate name space, and will not conflict
6220with symbol names, file names, or section names. Each program header
5c1a3f0f
NS
6221must have a distinct name. The headers are processed in order and it
6222is usual for them to map to sections in ascending load address order.
252b5132
RH
6223
6224Certain program header types describe segments of memory which the
6225system loader will load from the file. In the linker script, you
6226specify the contents of these segments by placing allocatable output
6227sections in the segments. You use the @samp{:@var{phdr}} output section
6228attribute to place a section in a particular segment. @xref{Output
6229Section Phdr}.
6230
6231It is normal to put certain sections in more than one segment. This
6232merely implies that one segment of memory contains another. You may
6233repeat @samp{:@var{phdr}}, using it once for each segment which should
6234contain the section.
6235
6236If you place a section in one or more segments using @samp{:@var{phdr}},
6237then the linker will place all subsequent allocatable sections which do
6238not specify @samp{:@var{phdr}} in the same segments. This is for
6239convenience, since generally a whole set of contiguous sections will be
6240placed in a single segment. You can use @code{:NONE} to override the
6241default segment and tell the linker to not put the section in any
6242segment at all.
6243
6244@kindex FILEHDR
6245@kindex PHDRS
5c1a3f0f 6246You may use the @code{FILEHDR} and @code{PHDRS} keywords after
252b5132
RH
6247the program header type to further describe the contents of the segment.
6248The @code{FILEHDR} keyword means that the segment should include the ELF
6249file header. The @code{PHDRS} keyword means that the segment should
5c1a3f0f 6250include the ELF program headers themselves. If applied to a loadable
4100cea3
AM
6251segment (@code{PT_LOAD}), all prior loadable segments must have one of
6252these keywords.
252b5132
RH
6253
6254The @var{type} may be one of the following. The numbers indicate the
6255value of the keyword.
6256
6257@table @asis
6258@item @code{PT_NULL} (0)
6259Indicates an unused program header.
6260
6261@item @code{PT_LOAD} (1)
6262Indicates that this program header describes a segment to be loaded from
6263the file.
6264
6265@item @code{PT_DYNAMIC} (2)
6266Indicates a segment where dynamic linking information can be found.
6267
6268@item @code{PT_INTERP} (3)
6269Indicates a segment where the name of the program interpreter may be
6270found.
6271
6272@item @code{PT_NOTE} (4)
6273Indicates a segment holding note information.
6274
6275@item @code{PT_SHLIB} (5)
6276A reserved program header type, defined but not specified by the ELF
6277ABI.
6278
6279@item @code{PT_PHDR} (6)
6280Indicates a segment where the program headers may be found.
6281
1a9ccd70
NC
6282@item @code{PT_TLS} (7)
6283Indicates a segment containing thread local storage.
6284
252b5132
RH
6285@item @var{expression}
6286An expression giving the numeric type of the program header. This may
6287be used for types not defined above.
6288@end table
6289
6290You can specify that a segment should be loaded at a particular address
6291in memory by using an @code{AT} expression. This is identical to the
6292@code{AT} command used as an output section attribute (@pxref{Output
6293Section LMA}). The @code{AT} command for a program header overrides the
6294output section attribute.
6295
6296The linker will normally set the segment flags based on the sections
6297which comprise the segment. You may use the @code{FLAGS} keyword to
6298explicitly specify the segment flags. The value of @var{flags} must be
6299an integer. It is used to set the @code{p_flags} field of the program
6300header.
6301
6302Here is an example of @code{PHDRS}. This shows a typical set of program
6303headers used on a native ELF system.
6304
6305@example
6306@group
6307PHDRS
6308@{
6309 headers PT_PHDR PHDRS ;
6310 interp PT_INTERP ;
6311 text PT_LOAD FILEHDR PHDRS ;
6312 data PT_LOAD ;
6313 dynamic PT_DYNAMIC ;
6314@}
6315
6316SECTIONS
6317@{
6318 . = SIZEOF_HEADERS;
6319 .interp : @{ *(.interp) @} :text :interp
6320 .text : @{ *(.text) @} :text
6321 .rodata : @{ *(.rodata) @} /* defaults to :text */
6322 @dots{}
6323 . = . + 0x1000; /* move to a new page in memory */
6324 .data : @{ *(.data) @} :data
6325 .dynamic : @{ *(.dynamic) @} :data :dynamic
6326 @dots{}
6327@}
6328@end group
6329@end example
6330
6331@node VERSION
6332@section VERSION Command
6333@kindex VERSION @{script text@}
6334@cindex symbol versions
6335@cindex version script
6336@cindex versions of symbols
6337The linker supports symbol versions when using ELF. Symbol versions are
6338only useful when using shared libraries. The dynamic linker can use
6339symbol versions to select a specific version of a function when it runs
6340a program that may have been linked against an earlier version of the
6341shared library.
6342
6343You can include a version script directly in the main linker script, or
6344you can supply the version script as an implicit linker script. You can
6345also use the @samp{--version-script} linker option.
6346
6347The syntax of the @code{VERSION} command is simply
6348@smallexample
6349VERSION @{ version-script-commands @}
6350@end smallexample
6351
6352The format of the version script commands is identical to that used by
6353Sun's linker in Solaris 2.5. The version script defines a tree of
6354version nodes. You specify the node names and interdependencies in the
6355version script. You can specify which symbols are bound to which
6356version nodes, and you can reduce a specified set of symbols to local
6357scope so that they are not globally visible outside of the shared
6358library.
6359
6360The easiest way to demonstrate the version script language is with a few
6361examples.
6362
6363@smallexample
6364VERS_1.1 @{
6365 global:
6366 foo1;
6367 local:
a1ab1d2a
UD
6368 old*;
6369 original*;
6370 new*;
252b5132
RH
6371@};
6372
6373VERS_1.2 @{
6374 foo2;
6375@} VERS_1.1;
6376
6377VERS_2.0 @{
6378 bar1; bar2;
c0065db7 6379 extern "C++" @{
86043bbb 6380 ns::*;
bb1515f2
MF
6381 "f(int, double)";
6382 @};
252b5132
RH
6383@} VERS_1.2;
6384@end smallexample
6385
6386This example version script defines three version nodes. The first
6387version node defined is @samp{VERS_1.1}; it has no other dependencies.
6388The script binds the symbol @samp{foo1} to @samp{VERS_1.1}. It reduces
6389a number of symbols to local scope so that they are not visible outside
313e35ee
AM
6390of the shared library; this is done using wildcard patterns, so that any
6391symbol whose name begins with @samp{old}, @samp{original}, or @samp{new}
6392is matched. The wildcard patterns available are the same as those used
6393in the shell when matching filenames (also known as ``globbing'').
86043bbb
MM
6394However, if you specify the symbol name inside double quotes, then the
6395name is treated as literal, rather than as a glob pattern.
252b5132
RH
6396
6397Next, the version script defines node @samp{VERS_1.2}. This node
6398depends upon @samp{VERS_1.1}. The script binds the symbol @samp{foo2}
6399to the version node @samp{VERS_1.2}.
6400
6401Finally, the version script defines node @samp{VERS_2.0}. This node
6402depends upon @samp{VERS_1.2}. The scripts binds the symbols @samp{bar1}
6403and @samp{bar2} are bound to the version node @samp{VERS_2.0}.
6404
6405When the linker finds a symbol defined in a library which is not
6406specifically bound to a version node, it will effectively bind it to an
6407unspecified base version of the library. You can bind all otherwise
a981ed6f 6408unspecified symbols to a given version node by using @samp{global: *;}
ae5a3597
AM
6409somewhere in the version script. Note that it's slightly crazy to use
6410wildcards in a global spec except on the last version node. Global
6411wildcards elsewhere run the risk of accidentally adding symbols to the
6412set exported for an old version. That's wrong since older versions
6413ought to have a fixed set of symbols.
252b5132
RH
6414
6415The names of the version nodes have no specific meaning other than what
6416they might suggest to the person reading them. The @samp{2.0} version
6417could just as well have appeared in between @samp{1.1} and @samp{1.2}.
6418However, this would be a confusing way to write a version script.
6419
0f6bf451 6420Node name can be omitted, provided it is the only version node
6b9b879a
JJ
6421in the version script. Such version script doesn't assign any versions to
6422symbols, only selects which symbols will be globally visible out and which
6423won't.
6424
6425@smallexample
7c9c73be 6426@{ global: foo; bar; local: *; @};
9d201f2f 6427@end smallexample
6b9b879a 6428
252b5132
RH
6429When you link an application against a shared library that has versioned
6430symbols, the application itself knows which version of each symbol it
6431requires, and it also knows which version nodes it needs from each
6432shared library it is linked against. Thus at runtime, the dynamic
6433loader can make a quick check to make sure that the libraries you have
6434linked against do in fact supply all of the version nodes that the
6435application will need to resolve all of the dynamic symbols. In this
6436way it is possible for the dynamic linker to know with certainty that
6437all external symbols that it needs will be resolvable without having to
6438search for each symbol reference.
6439
6440The symbol versioning is in effect a much more sophisticated way of
6441doing minor version checking that SunOS does. The fundamental problem
6442that is being addressed here is that typically references to external
6443functions are bound on an as-needed basis, and are not all bound when
6444the application starts up. If a shared library is out of date, a
6445required interface may be missing; when the application tries to use
6446that interface, it may suddenly and unexpectedly fail. With symbol
6447versioning, the user will get a warning when they start their program if
6448the libraries being used with the application are too old.
6449
6450There are several GNU extensions to Sun's versioning approach. The
6451first of these is the ability to bind a symbol to a version node in the
6452source file where the symbol is defined instead of in the versioning
6453script. This was done mainly to reduce the burden on the library
6454maintainer. You can do this by putting something like:
6455@smallexample
6456__asm__(".symver original_foo,foo@@VERS_1.1");
6457@end smallexample
6458@noindent
6459in the C source file. This renames the function @samp{original_foo} to
6460be an alias for @samp{foo} bound to the version node @samp{VERS_1.1}.
6461The @samp{local:} directive can be used to prevent the symbol
96a94295
L
6462@samp{original_foo} from being exported. A @samp{.symver} directive
6463takes precedence over a version script.
252b5132
RH
6464
6465The second GNU extension is to allow multiple versions of the same
6466function to appear in a given shared library. In this way you can make
6467an incompatible change to an interface without increasing the major
6468version number of the shared library, while still allowing applications
6469linked against the old interface to continue to function.
6470
6471To do this, you must use multiple @samp{.symver} directives in the
6472source file. Here is an example:
6473
6474@smallexample
6475__asm__(".symver original_foo,foo@@");
6476__asm__(".symver old_foo,foo@@VERS_1.1");
6477__asm__(".symver old_foo1,foo@@VERS_1.2");
6478__asm__(".symver new_foo,foo@@@@VERS_2.0");
6479@end smallexample
6480
6481In this example, @samp{foo@@} represents the symbol @samp{foo} bound to the
6482unspecified base version of the symbol. The source file that contains this
6483example would define 4 C functions: @samp{original_foo}, @samp{old_foo},
6484@samp{old_foo1}, and @samp{new_foo}.
6485
6486When you have multiple definitions of a given symbol, there needs to be
6487some way to specify a default version to which external references to
6488this symbol will be bound. You can do this with the
6489@samp{foo@@@@VERS_2.0} type of @samp{.symver} directive. You can only
6490declare one version of a symbol as the default in this manner; otherwise
6491you would effectively have multiple definitions of the same symbol.
6492
6493If you wish to bind a reference to a specific version of the symbol
6494within the shared library, you can use the aliases of convenience
36f63dca 6495(i.e., @samp{old_foo}), or you can use the @samp{.symver} directive to
252b5132
RH
6496specifically bind to an external version of the function in question.
6497
cb840a31
L
6498You can also specify the language in the version script:
6499
6500@smallexample
6501VERSION extern "lang" @{ version-script-commands @}
6502@end smallexample
6503
c0065db7 6504The supported @samp{lang}s are @samp{C}, @samp{C++}, and @samp{Java}.
cb840a31
L
6505The linker will iterate over the list of symbols at the link time and
6506demangle them according to @samp{lang} before matching them to the
bb1515f2
MF
6507patterns specified in @samp{version-script-commands}. The default
6508@samp{lang} is @samp{C}.
cb840a31 6509
86043bbb
MM
6510Demangled names may contains spaces and other special characters. As
6511described above, you can use a glob pattern to match demangled names,
6512or you can use a double-quoted string to match the string exactly. In
6513the latter case, be aware that minor differences (such as differing
6514whitespace) between the version script and the demangler output will
6515cause a mismatch. As the exact string generated by the demangler
6516might change in the future, even if the mangled name does not, you
6517should check that all of your version directives are behaving as you
6518expect when you upgrade.
6519
252b5132
RH
6520@node Expressions
6521@section Expressions in Linker Scripts
6522@cindex expressions
6523@cindex arithmetic
6524The syntax for expressions in the linker script language is identical to
fb0afe4c
AM
6525that of C expressions, except that whitespace is required in some
6526places to resolve syntactic ambiguities. All expressions are
6527evaluated as integers. All expressions are evaluated in the same
6528size, which is 32 bits if both the host and target are 32 bits, and is
6529otherwise 64 bits.
252b5132
RH
6530
6531You can use and set symbol values in expressions.
6532
6533The linker defines several special purpose builtin functions for use in
6534expressions.
6535
6536@menu
6537* Constants:: Constants
0c71d759 6538* Symbolic Constants:: Symbolic constants
252b5132 6539* Symbols:: Symbol Names
ecca9871 6540* Orphan Sections:: Orphan Sections
252b5132
RH
6541* Location Counter:: The Location Counter
6542* Operators:: Operators
6543* Evaluation:: Evaluation
6544* Expression Section:: The Section of an Expression
6545* Builtin Functions:: Builtin Functions
6546@end menu
6547
6548@node Constants
6549@subsection Constants
6550@cindex integer notation
6551@cindex constants in linker scripts
6552All constants are integers.
6553
6554As in C, the linker considers an integer beginning with @samp{0} to be
6555octal, and an integer beginning with @samp{0x} or @samp{0X} to be
8a308ae8 6556hexadecimal. Alternatively the linker accepts suffixes of @samp{h} or
11e7fd74 6557@samp{H} for hexadecimal, @samp{o} or @samp{O} for octal, @samp{b} or
8a308ae8
NC
6558@samp{B} for binary and @samp{d} or @samp{D} for decimal. Any integer
6559value without a prefix or a suffix is considered to be decimal.
252b5132
RH
6560
6561@cindex scaled integers
6562@cindex K and M integer suffixes
6563@cindex M and K integer suffixes
6564@cindex suffixes for integers
6565@cindex integer suffixes
6566In addition, you can use the suffixes @code{K} and @code{M} to scale a
6567constant by
6568@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
36f63dca 6569@ifnottex
252b5132
RH
6570@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6571@code{1024} or @code{1024*1024}
6572@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
36f63dca 6573@end ifnottex
252b5132
RH
6574@tex
6575${\rm 1024}$ or ${\rm 1024}^2$
6576@end tex
6577@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
8a308ae8
NC
6578respectively. For example, the following
6579all refer to the same quantity:
6580
252b5132 6581@smallexample
36f63dca
NC
6582_fourk_1 = 4K;
6583_fourk_2 = 4096;
6584_fourk_3 = 0x1000;
8a308ae8 6585_fourk_4 = 10000o;
252b5132
RH
6586@end smallexample
6587
8a308ae8
NC
6588Note - the @code{K} and @code{M} suffixes cannot be used in
6589conjunction with the base suffixes mentioned above.
6590
0c71d759
NC
6591@node Symbolic Constants
6592@subsection Symbolic Constants
6593@cindex symbolic constants
6594@kindex CONSTANT
a094d01f 6595It is possible to refer to target-specific constants via the use of
0c71d759
NC
6596the @code{CONSTANT(@var{name})} operator, where @var{name} is one of:
6597
6598@table @code
6599@item MAXPAGESIZE
6600@kindex MAXPAGESIZE
6601The target's maximum page size.
6602
6603@item COMMONPAGESIZE
6604@kindex COMMONPAGESIZE
6605The target's default page size.
6606@end table
6607
6608So for example:
6609
6610@smallexample
9d5777a3 6611 .text ALIGN (CONSTANT (MAXPAGESIZE)) : @{ *(.text) @}
0c71d759
NC
6612@end smallexample
6613
6614will create a text section aligned to the largest page boundary
6615supported by the target.
6616
252b5132
RH
6617@node Symbols
6618@subsection Symbol Names
6619@cindex symbol names
6620@cindex names
6621@cindex quoted symbol names
6622@kindex "
6623Unless quoted, symbol names start with a letter, underscore, or period
6624and may include letters, digits, underscores, periods, and hyphens.
6625Unquoted symbol names must not conflict with any keywords. You can
6626specify a symbol which contains odd characters or has the same name as a
6627keyword by surrounding the symbol name in double quotes:
6628@smallexample
36f63dca
NC
6629"SECTION" = 9;
6630"with a space" = "also with a space" + 10;
252b5132
RH
6631@end smallexample
6632
6633Since symbols can contain many non-alphabetic characters, it is safest
6634to delimit symbols with spaces. For example, @samp{A-B} is one symbol,
6635whereas @samp{A - B} is an expression involving subtraction.
6636
ecca9871
L
6637@node Orphan Sections
6638@subsection Orphan Sections
6639@cindex orphan
6640Orphan sections are sections present in the input files which
6641are not explicitly placed into the output file by the linker
6642script. The linker will still copy these sections into the
a87ded7b
AB
6643output file by either finding, or creating a suitable output section
6644in which to place the orphaned input section.
6645
6646If the name of an orphaned input section exactly matches the name of
6647an existing output section, then the orphaned input section will be
6648placed at the end of that output section.
6649
6650If there is no output section with a matching name then new output
6651sections will be created. Each new output section will have the same
6652name as the orphan section placed within it. If there are multiple
6653orphan sections with the same name, these will all be combined into
6654one new output section.
6655
6656If new output sections are created to hold orphaned input sections,
6657then the linker must decide where to place these new output sections
e299b355
AM
6658in relation to existing output sections. On most modern targets, the
6659linker attempts to place orphan sections after sections of the same
6660attribute, such as code vs data, loadable vs non-loadable, etc. If no
6661sections with matching attributes are found, or your target lacks this
6662support, the orphan section is placed at the end of the file.
ecca9871 6663
a05a5b64
TP
6664The command-line options @samp{--orphan-handling} and @samp{--unique}
6665(@pxref{Options,,Command-line Options}) can be used to control which
c005eb9e
AB
6666output sections an orphan is placed in.
6667
252b5132
RH
6668@node Location Counter
6669@subsection The Location Counter
6670@kindex .
6671@cindex dot
6672@cindex location counter
6673@cindex current output location
6674The special linker variable @dfn{dot} @samp{.} always contains the
6675current output location counter. Since the @code{.} always refers to a
6676location in an output section, it may only appear in an expression
6677within a @code{SECTIONS} command. The @code{.} symbol may appear
6678anywhere that an ordinary symbol is allowed in an expression.
6679
6680@cindex holes
6681Assigning a value to @code{.} will cause the location counter to be
6682moved. This may be used to create holes in the output section. The
dc0b6aa0
AM
6683location counter may not be moved backwards inside an output section,
6684and may not be moved backwards outside of an output section if so
6685doing creates areas with overlapping LMAs.
252b5132
RH
6686
6687@smallexample
6688SECTIONS
6689@{
6690 output :
6691 @{
6692 file1(.text)
6693 . = . + 1000;
6694 file2(.text)
6695 . += 1000;
6696 file3(.text)
563e308f 6697 @} = 0x12345678;
252b5132
RH
6698@}
6699@end smallexample
6700@noindent
6701In the previous example, the @samp{.text} section from @file{file1} is
6702located at the beginning of the output section @samp{output}. It is
6703followed by a 1000 byte gap. Then the @samp{.text} section from
6704@file{file2} appears, also with a 1000 byte gap following before the
563e308f 6705@samp{.text} section from @file{file3}. The notation @samp{= 0x12345678}
252b5132
RH
6706specifies what data to write in the gaps (@pxref{Output Section Fill}).
6707
5c6bbab8
NC
6708@cindex dot inside sections
6709Note: @code{.} actually refers to the byte offset from the start of the
6710current containing object. Normally this is the @code{SECTIONS}
69da35b5 6711statement, whose start address is 0, hence @code{.} can be used as an
5c6bbab8
NC
6712absolute address. If @code{.} is used inside a section description
6713however, it refers to the byte offset from the start of that section,
6714not an absolute address. Thus in a script like this:
6715
6716@smallexample
6717SECTIONS
6718@{
6719 . = 0x100
6720 .text: @{
6721 *(.text)
6722 . = 0x200
6723 @}
6724 . = 0x500
6725 .data: @{
6726 *(.data)
6727 . += 0x600
6728 @}
6729@}
6730@end smallexample
6731
6732The @samp{.text} section will be assigned a starting address of 0x100
6733and a size of exactly 0x200 bytes, even if there is not enough data in
6734the @samp{.text} input sections to fill this area. (If there is too
6735much data, an error will be produced because this would be an attempt to
6736move @code{.} backwards). The @samp{.data} section will start at 0x500
6737and it will have an extra 0x600 bytes worth of space after the end of
6738the values from the @samp{.data} input sections and before the end of
6739the @samp{.data} output section itself.
6740
b5666f2f
AM
6741@cindex dot outside sections
6742Setting symbols to the value of the location counter outside of an
6743output section statement can result in unexpected values if the linker
6744needs to place orphan sections. For example, given the following:
6745
6746@smallexample
6747SECTIONS
6748@{
6749 start_of_text = . ;
6750 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6751 end_of_text = . ;
6752
6753 start_of_data = . ;
6754 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6755 end_of_data = . ;
6756@}
6757@end smallexample
6758
6759If the linker needs to place some input section, e.g. @code{.rodata},
6760not mentioned in the script, it might choose to place that section
6761between @code{.text} and @code{.data}. You might think the linker
6762should place @code{.rodata} on the blank line in the above script, but
6763blank lines are of no particular significance to the linker. As well,
6764the linker doesn't associate the above symbol names with their
6765sections. Instead, it assumes that all assignments or other
6766statements belong to the previous output section, except for the
6767special case of an assignment to @code{.}. I.e., the linker will
6768place the orphan @code{.rodata} section as if the script was written
6769as follows:
6770
6771@smallexample
6772SECTIONS
6773@{
6774 start_of_text = . ;
6775 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6776 end_of_text = . ;
6777
6778 start_of_data = . ;
6779 .rodata: @{ *(.rodata) @}
6780 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6781 end_of_data = . ;
6782@}
6783@end smallexample
6784
6785This may or may not be the script author's intention for the value of
6786@code{start_of_data}. One way to influence the orphan section
6787placement is to assign the location counter to itself, as the linker
6788assumes that an assignment to @code{.} is setting the start address of
6789a following output section and thus should be grouped with that
6790section. So you could write:
6791
6792@smallexample
6793SECTIONS
6794@{
6795 start_of_text = . ;
6796 .text: @{ *(.text) @}
6797 end_of_text = . ;
6798
6799 . = . ;
6800 start_of_data = . ;
6801 .data: @{ *(.data) @}
6802 end_of_data = . ;
6803@}
6804@end smallexample
6805
6806Now, the orphan @code{.rodata} section will be placed between
6807@code{end_of_text} and @code{start_of_data}.
6808
252b5132
RH
6809@need 2000
6810@node Operators
6811@subsection Operators
6812@cindex operators for arithmetic
6813@cindex arithmetic operators
6814@cindex precedence in expressions
6815The linker recognizes the standard C set of arithmetic operators, with
6816the standard bindings and precedence levels:
6817@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
36f63dca 6818@ifnottex
252b5132
RH
6819@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6820@smallexample
f6f78318 6821precedence associativity Operators Notes
252b5132 6822(highest)
f6f78318 68231 left ! - ~ (1)
252b5132
RH
68242 left * / %
68253 left + -
68264 left >> <<
f6f78318
MM
68275 left > < <= >=
68286 left == !=
68297 left &
68308 left ^
68319 left |
683210 left &&
683311 left ||
683412 right ? :
c684d6c4 683513 right += -= *= /= <<= >>= &= |= ^= (2)
252b5132
RH
6836(lowest)
6837@end smallexample
6838Notes:
a1ab1d2a 6839(1) Prefix operators
252b5132
RH
6840(2) @xref{Assignments}.
6841@c TEXI2ROFF-KILL
36f63dca 6842@end ifnottex
252b5132
RH
6843@tex
6844\vskip \baselineskip
6845%"lispnarrowing" is the extra indent used generally for smallexample
6846\hskip\lispnarrowing\vbox{\offinterlineskip
6847\hrule
6848\halign
6849{\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ #\ \hfil&\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ #\ \hfil&\vrule#&\strut\hfil\ {\tt #}\ \hfil&\vrule#\cr
6850height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6851&Precedence&& Associativity &&{\rm Operators}&\cr
6852height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6853\noalign{\hrule}
6854height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr
6855&highest&&&&&\cr
6856% '176 is tilde, '~' in tt font
a1ab1d2a 6857&1&&left&&\qquad- \char'176\ !\qquad\dag&\cr
252b5132
RH
6858&2&&left&&* / \%&\cr
6859&3&&left&&+ -&\cr
6860&4&&left&&>> <<&\cr
f6f78318
MM
6861&5&&left&& > < <= >=&\cr
6862&6&&left&&== !=&\cr
6863&7&&left&&\&&\cr
36b6b459 6864&8&&left&&\^{}&\cr
f6f78318
MM
6865&9&&left&&|&\cr
6866&10&&left&&{\&\&}&\cr
6867&11&&left&&||&\cr
6868&12&&right&&? :&\cr
c684d6c4 6869&13&&right&&\qquad += -= *= /= <<= >>= \&= |= \^{}=\qquad\ddag&\cr
252b5132
RH
6870&lowest&&&&&\cr
6871height2pt&\omit&&\omit&&\omit&\cr}
6872\hrule}
6873@end tex
6874@iftex
6875{
6876@obeylines@parskip=0pt@parindent=0pt
6877@dag@quad Prefix operators.
6878@ddag@quad @xref{Assignments}.
6879}
6880@end iftex
6881@c END TEXI2ROFF-KILL
6882
6883@node Evaluation
6884@subsection Evaluation
6885@cindex lazy evaluation
6886@cindex expression evaluation order
6887The linker evaluates expressions lazily. It only computes the value of
6888an expression when absolutely necessary.
6889
6890The linker needs some information, such as the value of the start
6891address of the first section, and the origins and lengths of memory
6892regions, in order to do any linking at all. These values are computed
6893as soon as possible when the linker reads in the linker script.
6894
6895However, other values (such as symbol values) are not known or needed
6896until after storage allocation. Such values are evaluated later, when
6897other information (such as the sizes of output sections) is available
6898for use in the symbol assignment expression.
6899
6900The sizes of sections cannot be known until after allocation, so
6901assignments dependent upon these are not performed until after
6902allocation.
6903
6904Some expressions, such as those depending upon the location counter
6905@samp{.}, must be evaluated during section allocation.
6906
6907If the result of an expression is required, but the value is not
6908available, then an error results. For example, a script like the
6909following
6910@smallexample
6911@group
6912SECTIONS
6913 @{
a1ab1d2a 6914 .text 9+this_isnt_constant :
252b5132
RH
6915 @{ *(.text) @}
6916 @}
6917@end group
6918@end smallexample
6919@noindent
6920will cause the error message @samp{non constant expression for initial
6921address}.
6922
6923@node Expression Section
6924@subsection The Section of an Expression
6925@cindex expression sections
6926@cindex absolute expressions
6927@cindex relative expressions
6928@cindex absolute and relocatable symbols
6929@cindex relocatable and absolute symbols
6930@cindex symbols, relocatable and absolute
7542af2a
AM
6931Addresses and symbols may be section relative, or absolute. A section
6932relative symbol is relocatable. If you request relocatable output
6933using the @samp{-r} option, a further link operation may change the
6934value of a section relative symbol. On the other hand, an absolute
6935symbol will retain the same value throughout any further link
6936operations.
6937
abf4be64
AM
6938Some terms in linker expressions are addresses. This is true of
6939section relative symbols and for builtin functions that return an
6940address, such as @code{ADDR}, @code{LOADADDR}, @code{ORIGIN} and
6941@code{SEGMENT_START}. Other terms are simply numbers, or are builtin
6942functions that return a non-address value, such as @code{LENGTH}.
01554a74
AM
6943One complication is that unless you set @code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")}
6944(@pxref{Miscellaneous Commands}), numbers and absolute symbols are treated
5c3049d2
AM
6945differently depending on their location, for compatibility with older
6946versions of @code{ld}. Expressions appearing outside an output
6947section definition treat all numbers as absolute addresses.
6948Expressions appearing inside an output section definition treat
01554a74
AM
6949absolute symbols as numbers. If @code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")} is
6950given, then absolute symbols and numbers are simply treated as numbers
6951everywhere.
5c3049d2
AM
6952
6953In the following simple example,
252b5132 6954
7542af2a
AM
6955@smallexample
6956@group
6957SECTIONS
6958 @{
6959 . = 0x100;
6960 __executable_start = 0x100;
6961 .data :
6962 @{
6963 . = 0x10;
6964 __data_start = 0x10;
6965 *(.data)
6966 @}
6967 @dots{}
6968 @}
6969@end group
6970@end smallexample
252b5132 6971
7542af2a
AM
6972both @code{.} and @code{__executable_start} are set to the absolute
6973address 0x100 in the first two assignments, then both @code{.} and
6974@code{__data_start} are set to 0x10 relative to the @code{.data}
6975section in the second two assignments.
252b5132 6976
5c3049d2
AM
6977For expressions involving numbers, relative addresses and absolute
6978addresses, ld follows these rules to evaluate terms:
7542af2a
AM
6979
6980@itemize @bullet
6981@item
c05f749e
AM
6982Unary operations on an absolute address or number, and binary
6983operations on two absolute addresses or two numbers, or between one
6984absolute address and a number, apply the operator to the value(s).
6985@item
7542af2a
AM
6986Unary operations on a relative address, and binary operations on two
6987relative addresses in the same section or between one relative address
6988and a number, apply the operator to the offset part of the address(es).
6989@item
c05f749e
AM
6990Other binary operations, that is, between two relative addresses not
6991in the same section, or between a relative address and an absolute
6992address, first convert any non-absolute term to an absolute address
6993before applying the operator.
7542af2a
AM
6994@end itemize
6995
6996The result section of each sub-expression is as follows:
6997
6998@itemize @bullet
6999@item
7000An operation involving only numbers results in a number.
7001@item
7002The result of comparisons, @samp{&&} and @samp{||} is also a number.
7003@item
9bc8bb33 7004The result of other binary arithmetic and logical operations on two
11e7fd74 7005relative addresses in the same section or two absolute addresses
94b41882
AM
7006(after above conversions) is also a number when
7007@code{LD_FEATURE ("SANE_EXPR")} or inside an output section definition
7008but an absolute address otherwise.
9bc8bb33
AM
7009@item
7010The result of other operations on relative addresses or one
7011relative address and a number, is a relative address in the same
7012section as the relative operand(s).
7542af2a
AM
7013@item
7014The result of other operations on absolute addresses (after above
7015conversions) is an absolute address.
7016@end itemize
252b5132
RH
7017
7018You can use the builtin function @code{ABSOLUTE} to force an expression
7019to be absolute when it would otherwise be relative. For example, to
7020create an absolute symbol set to the address of the end of the output
7021section @samp{.data}:
7022@smallexample
7023SECTIONS
7024 @{
7025 .data : @{ *(.data) _edata = ABSOLUTE(.); @}
7026 @}
7027@end smallexample
7028@noindent
7029If @samp{ABSOLUTE} were not used, @samp{_edata} would be relative to the
7030@samp{.data} section.
7031
7542af2a
AM
7032Using @code{LOADADDR} also forces an expression absolute, since this
7033particular builtin function returns an absolute address.
7034
252b5132
RH
7035@node Builtin Functions
7036@subsection Builtin Functions
7037@cindex functions in expressions
7038The linker script language includes a number of builtin functions for
7039use in linker script expressions.
7040
7041@table @code
7042@item ABSOLUTE(@var{exp})
7043@kindex ABSOLUTE(@var{exp})
7044@cindex expression, absolute
7045Return the absolute (non-relocatable, as opposed to non-negative) value
7046of the expression @var{exp}. Primarily useful to assign an absolute
7047value to a symbol within a section definition, where symbol values are
7048normally section relative. @xref{Expression Section}.
7049
7050@item ADDR(@var{section})
7051@kindex ADDR(@var{section})
7052@cindex section address in expression
7542af2a 7053Return the address (VMA) of the named @var{section}. Your
252b5132 7054script must previously have defined the location of that section. In
7542af2a
AM
7055the following example, @code{start_of_output_1}, @code{symbol_1} and
7056@code{symbol_2} are assigned equivalent values, except that
7057@code{symbol_1} will be relative to the @code{.output1} section while
7058the other two will be absolute:
252b5132
RH
7059@smallexample
7060@group
7061SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
7062 .output1 :
a1ab1d2a 7063 @{
252b5132
RH
7064 start_of_output_1 = ABSOLUTE(.);
7065 @dots{}
7066 @}
7067 .output :
7068 @{
7069 symbol_1 = ADDR(.output1);
7070 symbol_2 = start_of_output_1;
7071 @}
7072@dots{} @}
7073@end group
7074@end smallexample
7075
876f4090
NS
7076@item ALIGN(@var{align})
7077@itemx ALIGN(@var{exp},@var{align})
7078@kindex ALIGN(@var{align})
7079@kindex ALIGN(@var{exp},@var{align})
252b5132
RH
7080@cindex round up location counter
7081@cindex align location counter
876f4090
NS
7082@cindex round up expression
7083@cindex align expression
7084Return the location counter (@code{.}) or arbitrary expression aligned
7085to the next @var{align} boundary. The single operand @code{ALIGN}
7086doesn't change the value of the location counter---it just does
7087arithmetic on it. The two operand @code{ALIGN} allows an arbitrary
7088expression to be aligned upwards (@code{ALIGN(@var{align})} is
e0a3af22 7089equivalent to @code{ALIGN(ABSOLUTE(.), @var{align})}).
876f4090
NS
7090
7091Here is an example which aligns the output @code{.data} section to the
7092next @code{0x2000} byte boundary after the preceding section and sets a
7093variable within the section to the next @code{0x8000} boundary after the
7094input sections:
252b5132
RH
7095@smallexample
7096@group
7097SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
7098 .data ALIGN(0x2000): @{
7099 *(.data)
7100 variable = ALIGN(0x8000);
7101 @}
7102@dots{} @}
7103@end group
7104@end smallexample
7105@noindent
7106The first use of @code{ALIGN} in this example specifies the location of
7107a section because it is used as the optional @var{address} attribute of
7108a section definition (@pxref{Output Section Address}). The second use
7109of @code{ALIGN} is used to defines the value of a symbol.
7110
7111The builtin function @code{NEXT} is closely related to @code{ALIGN}.
7112
362c1d1a
NS
7113@item ALIGNOF(@var{section})
7114@kindex ALIGNOF(@var{section})
7115@cindex section alignment
7116Return the alignment in bytes of the named @var{section}, if that section has
63e8fb86
AM
7117been allocated, or zero if the section has not been allocated. If the
7118section does not exist in the linker script the linker will report an
7119error. If @var{section} is @code{NEXT_SECTION} then @code{ALIGNOF} will
7120return the alignment of the next allocated section specified in the
7121linker script, or zero if there is no such section. In the following
7122example, the alignment of the @code{.output} section is stored as the
7123first value in that section.
362c1d1a
NS
7124@smallexample
7125@group
7126SECTIONS@{ @dots{}
7127 .output @{
7128 LONG (ALIGNOF (.output))
7129 @dots{}
7130 @}
7131@dots{} @}
7132@end group
7133@end smallexample
7134
252b5132
RH
7135@item BLOCK(@var{exp})
7136@kindex BLOCK(@var{exp})
7137This is a synonym for @code{ALIGN}, for compatibility with older linker
7138scripts. It is most often seen when setting the address of an output
7139section.
7140
2d20f7bf
JJ
7141@item DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}, @var{commonpagesize})
7142@kindex DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}, @var{commonpagesize})
7143This is equivalent to either
7144@smallexample
7145(ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize}) + (. & (@var{maxpagesize} - 1)))
7146@end smallexample
7147or
7148@smallexample
fe6052e1
AM
7149(ALIGN(@var{maxpagesize})
7150 + ((. + @var{commonpagesize} - 1) & (@var{maxpagesize} - @var{commonpagesize})))
2d20f7bf
JJ
7151@end smallexample
7152@noindent
7153depending on whether the latter uses fewer @var{commonpagesize} sized pages
7154for the data segment (area between the result of this expression and
7155@code{DATA_SEGMENT_END}) than the former or not.
7156If the latter form is used, it means @var{commonpagesize} bytes of runtime
7157memory will be saved at the expense of up to @var{commonpagesize} wasted
7158bytes in the on-disk file.
7159
7160This expression can only be used directly in @code{SECTIONS} commands, not in
7161any output section descriptions and only once in the linker script.
7162@var{commonpagesize} should be less or equal to @var{maxpagesize} and should
def5c83c
AM
7163be the system page size the object wants to be optimized for while still
7164running on system page sizes up to @var{maxpagesize}. Note however
7165that @samp{-z relro} protection will not be effective if the system
7166page size is larger than @var{commonpagesize}.
2d20f7bf
JJ
7167
7168@noindent
7169Example:
7170@smallexample
7171 . = DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN(0x10000, 0x2000);
7172@end smallexample
7173
7174@item DATA_SEGMENT_END(@var{exp})
7175@kindex DATA_SEGMENT_END(@var{exp})
7176This defines the end of data segment for @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN}
7177evaluation purposes.
7178
7179@smallexample
7180 . = DATA_SEGMENT_END(.);
7181@end smallexample
7182
a4f5ad88
JJ
7183@item DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(@var{offset}, @var{exp})
7184@kindex DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(@var{offset}, @var{exp})
7185This defines the end of the @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment when
eec2f3ed 7186@samp{-z relro} option is used.
a4f5ad88
JJ
7187When @samp{-z relro} option is not present, @code{DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END}
7188does nothing, otherwise @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN} is padded so that
def5c83c
AM
7189@var{exp} + @var{offset} is aligned to the @var{commonpagesize}
7190argument given to @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN}. If present in the linker
7191script, it must be placed between @code{DATA_SEGMENT_ALIGN} and
eec2f3ed
AM
7192@code{DATA_SEGMENT_END}. Evaluates to the second argument plus any
7193padding needed at the end of the @code{PT_GNU_RELRO} segment due to
7194section alignment.
a4f5ad88
JJ
7195
7196@smallexample
7197 . = DATA_SEGMENT_RELRO_END(24, .);
7198@end smallexample
7199
252b5132
RH
7200@item DEFINED(@var{symbol})
7201@kindex DEFINED(@var{symbol})
7202@cindex symbol defaults
7203Return 1 if @var{symbol} is in the linker global symbol table and is
420e579c
HPN
7204defined before the statement using DEFINED in the script, otherwise
7205return 0. You can use this function to provide
252b5132
RH
7206default values for symbols. For example, the following script fragment
7207shows how to set a global symbol @samp{begin} to the first location in
7208the @samp{.text} section---but if a symbol called @samp{begin} already
7209existed, its value is preserved:
7210
7211@smallexample
7212@group
7213SECTIONS @{ @dots{}
7214 .text : @{
7215 begin = DEFINED(begin) ? begin : . ;
7216 @dots{}
7217 @}
7218 @dots{}
7219@}
7220@end group
7221@end smallexample
7222
3ec57632
NC
7223@item LENGTH(@var{memory})
7224@kindex LENGTH(@var{memory})
7225Return the length of the memory region named @var{memory}.
7226
252b5132
RH
7227@item LOADADDR(@var{section})
7228@kindex LOADADDR(@var{section})
7229@cindex section load address in expression
7542af2a 7230Return the absolute LMA of the named @var{section}. (@pxref{Output
252b5132
RH
7231Section LMA}).
7232
2e53f7d6
NC
7233@item LOG2CEIL(@var{exp})
7234@kindex LOG2CEIL(@var{exp})
7235Return the binary logarithm of @var{exp} rounded towards infinity.
7236@code{LOG2CEIL(0)} returns 0.
7237
252b5132
RH
7238@kindex MAX
7239@item MAX(@var{exp1}, @var{exp2})
7240Returns the maximum of @var{exp1} and @var{exp2}.
7241
7242@kindex MIN
7243@item MIN(@var{exp1}, @var{exp2})
7244Returns the minimum of @var{exp1} and @var{exp2}.
7245
7246@item NEXT(@var{exp})
7247@kindex NEXT(@var{exp})
7248@cindex unallocated address, next
7249Return the next unallocated address that is a multiple of @var{exp}.
7250This function is closely related to @code{ALIGN(@var{exp})}; unless you
7251use the @code{MEMORY} command to define discontinuous memory for the
7252output file, the two functions are equivalent.
7253
3ec57632
NC
7254@item ORIGIN(@var{memory})
7255@kindex ORIGIN(@var{memory})
7256Return the origin of the memory region named @var{memory}.
7257
ba916c8a
MM
7258@item SEGMENT_START(@var{segment}, @var{default})
7259@kindex SEGMENT_START(@var{segment}, @var{default})
7260Return the base address of the named @var{segment}. If an explicit
c5da8c7d
NC
7261value has already been given for this segment (with a command-line
7262@samp{-T} option) then that value will be returned otherwise the value
7263will be @var{default}. At present, the @samp{-T} command-line option
7264can only be used to set the base address for the ``text'', ``data'', and
7542af2a 7265``bss'' sections, but you can use @code{SEGMENT_START} with any segment
ba916c8a
MM
7266name.
7267
252b5132
RH
7268@item SIZEOF(@var{section})
7269@kindex SIZEOF(@var{section})
7270@cindex section size
7271Return the size in bytes of the named @var{section}, if that section has
63e8fb86
AM
7272been allocated, or zero if the section has not been allocated. If the
7273section does not exist in the linker script the linker will report an
7274error. If @var{section} is @code{NEXT_SECTION} then @code{SIZEOF} will
7275return the alignment of the next allocated section specified in the
7276linker script, or zero if there is no such section. In the following
7277example, @code{symbol_1} and @code{symbol_2} are assigned identical
7278values:
252b5132
RH
7279@smallexample
7280@group
7281SECTIONS@{ @dots{}
7282 .output @{
7283 .start = . ;
7284 @dots{}
7285 .end = . ;
7286 @}
7287 symbol_1 = .end - .start ;
7288 symbol_2 = SIZEOF(.output);
7289@dots{} @}
7290@end group
7291@end smallexample
7292
7293@item SIZEOF_HEADERS
252b5132
RH
7294@kindex SIZEOF_HEADERS
7295@cindex header size
7296Return the size in bytes of the output file's headers. This is
7297information which appears at the start of the output file. You can use
7298this number when setting the start address of the first section, if you
7299choose, to facilitate paging.
7300
7301@cindex not enough room for program headers
7302@cindex program headers, not enough room
7303When producing an ELF output file, if the linker script uses the
7304@code{SIZEOF_HEADERS} builtin function, the linker must compute the
7305number of program headers before it has determined all the section
7306addresses and sizes. If the linker later discovers that it needs
7307additional program headers, it will report an error @samp{not enough
7308room for program headers}. To avoid this error, you must avoid using
7309the @code{SIZEOF_HEADERS} function, or you must rework your linker
7310script to avoid forcing the linker to use additional program headers, or
7311you must define the program headers yourself using the @code{PHDRS}
7312command (@pxref{PHDRS}).
7313@end table
7314
7315@node Implicit Linker Scripts
7316@section Implicit Linker Scripts
7317@cindex implicit linker scripts
7318If you specify a linker input file which the linker can not recognize as
7319an object file or an archive file, it will try to read the file as a
7320linker script. If the file can not be parsed as a linker script, the
7321linker will report an error.
7322
7323An implicit linker script will not replace the default linker script.
7324
7325Typically an implicit linker script would contain only symbol
7326assignments, or the @code{INPUT}, @code{GROUP}, or @code{VERSION}
7327commands.
7328
7329Any input files read because of an implicit linker script will be read
7330at the position in the command line where the implicit linker script was
7331read. This can affect archive searching.
7332
bf6d8037
HC
7333@node Plugins
7334@chapter Linker Plugins
7335
7336@cindex plugins
7337@cindex linker plugins
7338The linker can use dynamically loaded plugins to modify its behavior.
7339For example, the link-time optimization feature that some compilers
7340support is implemented with a linker plugin.
7341
7342Currently there is only one plugin shipped by default, but more may
7343be added here later.
7344
9b38b85e 7345Plugins are enabled via the use of the @option{-plugin @var{name}}
3a117c58 7346command line option. @xref{Options}.
9b38b85e 7347
bf6d8037
HC
7348@menu
7349* libdep Plugin:: Static Library Dependencies Plugin
7350@end menu
7351
7352@node libdep Plugin
7353@section Static Library Dependencies Plugin
7354@cindex static library dependencies
7355Originally, static libraries were contained in an archive file consisting
7356just of a collection of relocatable object files. Later they evolved to
7357optionally include a symbol table, to assist in finding the needed objects
7358within a library. There their evolution ended, and dynamic libraries
7359rose to ascendance.
7360
7361One useful feature of dynamic libraries was that, more than just collecting
7362multiple objects into a single file, they also included a list of their
7363dependencies, such that one could specify just the name of a single dynamic
7364library at link time, and all of its dependencies would be implicitly
7365referenced as well. But static libraries lacked this feature, so if a
7366link invocation was switched from using dynamic libraries to static
7367libraries, the link command would usually fail unless it was rewritten to
7368explicitly list the dependencies of the static library.
7369
7370The GNU @command{ar} utility now supports a @option{--record-libdeps} option
7371to embed dependency lists into static libraries as well, and the @file{libdep}
7372plugin may be used to read this dependency information at link time. The
7373dependency information is stored as a single string, carrying @option{-l}
7374and @option{-L} arguments as they would normally appear in a linker
7375command line. As such, the information can be written with any text
7376utility and stored into any archive, even if GNU @command{ar} is not
7377being used to create the archive. The information is stored in an
7378archive member named @samp{__.LIBDEP}.
7379
7380For example, given a library @file{libssl.a} that depends on another
7381library @file{libcrypto.a} which may be found in @file{/usr/local/lib},
7382the @samp{__.LIBDEP} member of @file{libssl.a} would contain
7383
7384@smallexample
7385-L/usr/local/lib -lcrypto
7386@end smallexample
7387
252b5132
RH
7388@ifset GENERIC
7389@node Machine Dependent
7390@chapter Machine Dependent Features
7391
7392@cindex machine dependencies
ff5dcc92
SC
7393@command{ld} has additional features on some platforms; the following
7394sections describe them. Machines where @command{ld} has no additional
252b5132
RH
7395functionality are not listed.
7396
7397@menu
36f63dca
NC
7398@ifset H8300
7399* H8/300:: @command{ld} and the H8/300
7400@end ifset
7ca01ed9
NC
7401@ifset M68HC11
7402* M68HC11/68HC12:: @code{ld} and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
7403@end ifset
36f63dca
NC
7404@ifset ARM
7405* ARM:: @command{ld} and the ARM family
7406@end ifset
7407@ifset HPPA
7408* HPPA ELF32:: @command{ld} and HPPA 32-bit ELF
7409@end ifset
7fb9f789
NC
7410@ifset M68K
7411* M68K:: @command{ld} and the Motorola 68K family
7412@end ifset
833794fc
MR
7413@ifset MIPS
7414* MIPS:: @command{ld} and the MIPS family
7415@end ifset
3c3bdf30 7416@ifset MMIX
36f63dca 7417* MMIX:: @command{ld} and MMIX
3c3bdf30 7418@end ifset
2469cfa2 7419@ifset MSP430
36f63dca 7420* MSP430:: @command{ld} and MSP430
2469cfa2 7421@end ifset
35c08157
KLC
7422@ifset NDS32
7423* NDS32:: @command{ld} and NDS32
7424@end ifset
78058a5e
SL
7425@ifset NIOSII
7426* Nios II:: @command{ld} and the Altera Nios II
7427@end ifset
2a60a7a8
AM
7428@ifset POWERPC
7429* PowerPC ELF32:: @command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
7430@end ifset
7431@ifset POWERPC64
7432* PowerPC64 ELF64:: @command{ld} and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
7433@end ifset
b4cbbe8f
AK
7434@ifset S/390
7435* S/390 ELF:: @command{ld} and S/390 ELF Support
7436@end ifset
49fa1e15
AM
7437@ifset SPU
7438* SPU ELF:: @command{ld} and SPU ELF Support
7439@end ifset
74459f0e 7440@ifset TICOFF
ff5dcc92 7441* TI COFF:: @command{ld} and TI COFF
74459f0e 7442@end ifset
2ca22b03
NC
7443@ifset WIN32
7444* WIN32:: @command{ld} and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
7445@end ifset
e0001a05
NC
7446@ifset XTENSA
7447* Xtensa:: @command{ld} and Xtensa Processors
7448@end ifset
252b5132
RH
7449@end menu
7450@end ifset
7451
252b5132
RH
7452@ifset H8300
7453@ifclear GENERIC
7454@raisesections
7455@end ifclear
7456
7457@node H8/300
ff5dcc92 7458@section @command{ld} and the H8/300
252b5132
RH
7459
7460@cindex H8/300 support
ff5dcc92 7461For the H8/300, @command{ld} can perform these global optimizations when
252b5132
RH
7462you specify the @samp{--relax} command-line option.
7463
7464@table @emph
7465@cindex relaxing on H8/300
7466@item relaxing address modes
ff5dcc92 7467@command{ld} finds all @code{jsr} and @code{jmp} instructions whose
252b5132
RH
7468targets are within eight bits, and turns them into eight-bit
7469program-counter relative @code{bsr} and @code{bra} instructions,
7470respectively.
7471
7472@cindex synthesizing on H8/300
7473@item synthesizing instructions
81f5558e 7474@c FIXME: specifically mov.b, or any mov instructions really? -> mov.b only, at least on H8, H8H, H8S
ff5dcc92 7475@command{ld} finds all @code{mov.b} instructions which use the
252b5132
RH
7476sixteen-bit absolute address form, but refer to the top
7477page of memory, and changes them to use the eight-bit address form.
7478(That is: the linker turns @samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{aa}:16} into
7479@samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{aa}:8} whenever the address @var{aa} is in the
7480top page of memory).
1502569c 7481
81f5558e
NC
7482@command{ld} finds all @code{mov} instructions which use the register
7483indirect with 32-bit displacement addressing mode, but use a small
7484displacement inside 16-bit displacement range, and changes them to use
7485the 16-bit displacement form. (That is: the linker turns @samp{mov.b
7486@code{@@}@var{d}:32,ERx} into @samp{mov.b @code{@@}@var{d}:16,ERx}
7487whenever the displacement @var{d} is in the 16 bit signed integer
7488range. Only implemented in ELF-format ld).
7489
1502569c 7490@item bit manipulation instructions
c0065db7 7491@command{ld} finds all bit manipulation instructions like @code{band, bclr,
1502569c 7492biand, bild, bior, bist, bixor, bld, bnot, bor, bset, bst, btst, bxor}
c0065db7 7493which use 32 bit and 16 bit absolute address form, but refer to the top
1502569c
NC
7494page of memory, and changes them to use the 8 bit address form.
7495(That is: the linker turns @samp{bset #xx:3,@code{@@}@var{aa}:32} into
c0065db7 7496@samp{bset #xx:3,@code{@@}@var{aa}:8} whenever the address @var{aa} is in
1502569c
NC
7497the top page of memory).
7498
7499@item system control instructions
c0065db7
RM
7500@command{ld} finds all @code{ldc.w, stc.w} instructions which use the
750132 bit absolute address form, but refer to the top page of memory, and
1502569c
NC
7502changes them to use 16 bit address form.
7503(That is: the linker turns @samp{ldc.w @code{@@}@var{aa}:32,ccr} into
c0065db7 7504@samp{ldc.w @code{@@}@var{aa}:16,ccr} whenever the address @var{aa} is in
1502569c 7505the top page of memory).
252b5132
RH
7506@end table
7507
7508@ifclear GENERIC
7509@lowersections
7510@end ifclear
7511@end ifset
7512
36f63dca 7513@ifclear GENERIC
c2dcd04e 7514@ifset Renesas
36f63dca 7515@c This stuff is pointless to say unless you're especially concerned
c2dcd04e
NC
7516@c with Renesas chips; don't enable it for generic case, please.
7517@node Renesas
7518@chapter @command{ld} and Other Renesas Chips
36f63dca 7519
c2dcd04e
NC
7520@command{ld} also supports the Renesas (formerly Hitachi) H8/300H,
7521H8/500, and SH chips. No special features, commands, or command-line
7522options are required for these chips.
36f63dca
NC
7523@end ifset
7524@end ifclear
7525
36f63dca
NC
7526@ifset ARM
7527@ifclear GENERIC
7528@raisesections
7529@end ifclear
7530
93fd0973
SC
7531@ifset M68HC11
7532@ifclear GENERIC
7533@raisesections
7534@end ifclear
7535
7536@node M68HC11/68HC12
7537@section @command{ld} and the Motorola 68HC11 and 68HC12 families
7538
7539@cindex M68HC11 and 68HC12 support
7540
7541@subsection Linker Relaxation
7542
7543For the Motorola 68HC11, @command{ld} can perform these global
7544optimizations when you specify the @samp{--relax} command-line option.
7545
7546@table @emph
7547@cindex relaxing on M68HC11
7548@item relaxing address modes
7549@command{ld} finds all @code{jsr} and @code{jmp} instructions whose
7550targets are within eight bits, and turns them into eight-bit
7551program-counter relative @code{bsr} and @code{bra} instructions,
7552respectively.
7553
7554@command{ld} also looks at all 16-bit extended addressing modes and
7555transforms them in a direct addressing mode when the address is in
7556page 0 (between 0 and 0x0ff).
7557
7558@item relaxing gcc instruction group
7559When @command{gcc} is called with @option{-mrelax}, it can emit group
7560of instructions that the linker can optimize to use a 68HC11 direct
7561addressing mode. These instructions consists of @code{bclr} or
7562@code{bset} instructions.
7563
7564@end table
7565
7566@subsection Trampoline Generation
7567
7568@cindex trampoline generation on M68HC11
7569@cindex trampoline generation on M68HC12
7570For 68HC11 and 68HC12, @command{ld} can generate trampoline code to
7571call a far function using a normal @code{jsr} instruction. The linker
c0065db7 7572will also change the relocation to some far function to use the
93fd0973
SC
7573trampoline address instead of the function address. This is typically the
7574case when a pointer to a function is taken. The pointer will in fact
7575point to the function trampoline.
7576
7577@ifclear GENERIC
7578@lowersections
7579@end ifclear
7580@end ifset
7581
36f63dca 7582@node ARM
3674e28a 7583@section @command{ld} and the ARM family
36f63dca
NC
7584
7585@cindex ARM interworking support
7586@kindex --support-old-code
7587For the ARM, @command{ld} will generate code stubs to allow functions calls
b45619c0 7588between ARM and Thumb code. These stubs only work with code that has
36f63dca
NC
7589been compiled and assembled with the @samp{-mthumb-interwork} command
7590line option. If it is necessary to link with old ARM object files or
7591libraries, which have not been compiled with the -mthumb-interwork
a05a5b64 7592option then the @samp{--support-old-code} command-line switch should be
36f63dca
NC
7593given to the linker. This will make it generate larger stub functions
7594which will work with non-interworking aware ARM code. Note, however,
7595the linker does not support generating stubs for function calls to
7596non-interworking aware Thumb code.
7597
7598@cindex thumb entry point
7599@cindex entry point, thumb
7600@kindex --thumb-entry=@var{entry}
7601The @samp{--thumb-entry} switch is a duplicate of the generic
7602@samp{--entry} switch, in that it sets the program's starting address.
7603But it also sets the bottom bit of the address, so that it can be
7604branched to using a BX instruction, and the program will start
7605executing in Thumb mode straight away.
7606
ce11ba6c
KT
7607@cindex PE import table prefixing
7608@kindex --use-nul-prefixed-import-tables
7609The @samp{--use-nul-prefixed-import-tables} switch is specifying, that
7610the import tables idata4 and idata5 have to be generated with a zero
11e7fd74 7611element prefix for import libraries. This is the old style to generate
ce11ba6c
KT
7612import tables. By default this option is turned off.
7613
e489d0ae
PB
7614@cindex BE8
7615@kindex --be8
7616The @samp{--be8} switch instructs @command{ld} to generate BE8 format
080bb7bb
NC
7617executables. This option is only valid when linking big-endian
7618objects - ie ones which have been assembled with the @option{-EB}
7619option. The resulting image will contain big-endian data and
7620little-endian code.
e489d0ae 7621
3674e28a
PB
7622@cindex TARGET1
7623@kindex --target1-rel
7624@kindex --target1-abs
7625The @samp{R_ARM_TARGET1} relocation is typically used for entries in the
7626@samp{.init_array} section. It is interpreted as either @samp{R_ARM_REL32}
7627or @samp{R_ARM_ABS32}, depending on the target. The @samp{--target1-rel}
7628and @samp{--target1-abs} switches override the default.
7629
7630@cindex TARGET2
7631@kindex --target2=@var{type}
7632The @samp{--target2=type} switch overrides the default definition of the
7633@samp{R_ARM_TARGET2} relocation. Valid values for @samp{type}, their
7634meanings, and target defaults are as follows:
7635@table @samp
7636@item rel
eeac373a
PB
7637@samp{R_ARM_REL32} (arm*-*-elf, arm*-*-eabi)
7638@item abs
a57d1773 7639@samp{R_ARM_ABS32}
3674e28a
PB
7640@item got-rel
7641@samp{R_ARM_GOT_PREL} (arm*-*-linux, arm*-*-*bsd)
7642@end table
7643
319850b4
JB
7644@cindex FIX_V4BX
7645@kindex --fix-v4bx
7646The @samp{R_ARM_V4BX} relocation (defined by the ARM AAELF
7647specification) enables objects compiled for the ARMv4 architecture to be
7648interworking-safe when linked with other objects compiled for ARMv4t, but
7649also allows pure ARMv4 binaries to be built from the same ARMv4 objects.
7650
7651In the latter case, the switch @option{--fix-v4bx} must be passed to the
7652linker, which causes v4t @code{BX rM} instructions to be rewritten as
7653@code{MOV PC,rM}, since v4 processors do not have a @code{BX} instruction.
7654
7655In the former case, the switch should not be used, and @samp{R_ARM_V4BX}
7656relocations are ignored.
7657
845b51d6
PB
7658@cindex FIX_V4BX_INTERWORKING
7659@kindex --fix-v4bx-interworking
7660Replace @code{BX rM} instructions identified by @samp{R_ARM_V4BX}
7661relocations with a branch to the following veneer:
7662
7663@smallexample
7664TST rM, #1
7665MOVEQ PC, rM
7666BX Rn
7667@end smallexample
7668
7669This allows generation of libraries/applications that work on ARMv4 cores
7670and are still interworking safe. Note that the above veneer clobbers the
11e7fd74 7671condition flags, so may cause incorrect program behavior in rare cases.
845b51d6 7672
33bfe774
JB
7673@cindex USE_BLX
7674@kindex --use-blx
7675The @samp{--use-blx} switch enables the linker to use ARM/Thumb
7676BLX instructions (available on ARMv5t and above) in various
7677situations. Currently it is used to perform calls via the PLT from Thumb
7678code using BLX rather than using BX and a mode-switching stub before
7679each PLT entry. This should lead to such calls executing slightly faster.
7680
c6dd86c6
JB
7681@cindex VFP11_DENORM_FIX
7682@kindex --vfp11-denorm-fix
7683The @samp{--vfp11-denorm-fix} switch enables a link-time workaround for a
7684bug in certain VFP11 coprocessor hardware, which sometimes allows
7685instructions with denorm operands (which must be handled by support code)
7686to have those operands overwritten by subsequent instructions before
7687the support code can read the intended values.
7688
7689The bug may be avoided in scalar mode if you allow at least one
7690intervening instruction between a VFP11 instruction which uses a register
7691and another instruction which writes to the same register, or at least two
7692intervening instructions if vector mode is in use. The bug only affects
7693full-compliance floating-point mode: you do not need this workaround if
7694you are using "runfast" mode. Please contact ARM for further details.
7695
7696If you know you are using buggy VFP11 hardware, you can
7697enable this workaround by specifying the linker option
7698@samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=scalar} if you are using the VFP11 scalar
7699mode only, or @samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=vector} if you are using
7700vector mode (the latter also works for scalar code). The default is
7701@samp{--vfp-denorm-fix=none}.
7702
7703If the workaround is enabled, instructions are scanned for
7704potentially-troublesome sequences, and a veneer is created for each
7705such sequence which may trigger the erratum. The veneer consists of the
7706first instruction of the sequence and a branch back to the subsequent
7707instruction. The original instruction is then replaced with a branch to
7708the veneer. The extra cycles required to call and return from the veneer
7709are sufficient to avoid the erratum in both the scalar and vector cases.
7710
2de70689
MGD
7711@cindex ARM1176 erratum workaround
7712@kindex --fix-arm1176
7713@kindex --no-fix-arm1176
9d5777a3
RM
7714The @samp{--fix-arm1176} switch enables a link-time workaround for an erratum
7715in certain ARM1176 processors. The workaround is enabled by default if you
7716are targeting ARM v6 (excluding ARM v6T2) or earlier. It can be disabled
2de70689
MGD
7717unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-arm1176}.
7718
9d5777a3 7719Further information is available in the ``ARM1176JZ-S and ARM1176JZF-S
11e7fd74 7720Programmer Advice Notice'' available on the ARM documentation website at:
2de70689
MGD
7721http://infocenter.arm.com/.
7722
a504d23a
LA
7723@cindex STM32L4xx erratum workaround
7724@kindex --fix-stm32l4xx-629360
7725
7726The @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360} switch enables a link-time
7727workaround for a bug in the bus matrix / memory controller for some of
7728the STM32 Cortex-M4 based products (STM32L4xx). When accessing
7729off-chip memory via the affected bus for bus reads of 9 words or more,
7730the bus can generate corrupt data and/or abort. These are only
7731core-initiated accesses (not DMA), and might affect any access:
7732integer loads such as LDM, POP and floating-point loads such as VLDM,
7733VPOP. Stores are not affected.
7734
7735The bug can be avoided by splitting memory accesses into the
7736necessary chunks to keep bus reads below 8 words.
7737
7738The workaround is not enabled by default, this is equivalent to use
7739@samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360=none}. If you know you are using buggy
7740STM32L4xx hardware, you can enable the workaround by specifying the
7741linker option @samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360}, or the equivalent
7742@samp{--fix-stm32l4xx-629360=default}.
7743
7744If the workaround is enabled, instructions are scanned for
7745potentially-troublesome sequences, and a veneer is created for each
7746such sequence which may trigger the erratum. The veneer consists in a
7747replacement sequence emulating the behaviour of the original one and a
7748branch back to the subsequent instruction. The original instruction is
7749then replaced with a branch to the veneer.
7750
7751The workaround does not always preserve the memory access order for
7752the LDMDB instruction, when the instruction loads the PC.
7753
7754The workaround is not able to handle problematic instructions when
7755they are in the middle of an IT block, since a branch is not allowed
7756there. In that case, the linker reports a warning and no replacement
7757occurs.
7758
7759The workaround is not able to replace problematic instructions with a
7760PC-relative branch instruction if the @samp{.text} section is too
7761large. In that case, when the branch that replaces the original code
7762cannot be encoded, the linker reports a warning and no replacement
7763occurs.
7764
bf21ed78
MS
7765@cindex NO_ENUM_SIZE_WARNING
7766@kindex --no-enum-size-warning
726150b7 7767The @option{--no-enum-size-warning} switch prevents the linker from
bf21ed78
MS
7768warning when linking object files that specify incompatible EABI
7769enumeration size attributes. For example, with this switch enabled,
7770linking of an object file using 32-bit enumeration values with another
7771using enumeration values fitted into the smallest possible space will
7772not be diagnosed.
a9dc9481
JM
7773
7774@cindex NO_WCHAR_SIZE_WARNING
7775@kindex --no-wchar-size-warning
7776The @option{--no-wchar-size-warning} switch prevents the linker from
7777warning when linking object files that specify incompatible EABI
7778@code{wchar_t} size attributes. For example, with this switch enabled,
7779linking of an object file using 32-bit @code{wchar_t} values with another
7780using 16-bit @code{wchar_t} values will not be diagnosed.
bf21ed78 7781
726150b7
NC
7782@cindex PIC_VENEER
7783@kindex --pic-veneer
7784The @samp{--pic-veneer} switch makes the linker use PIC sequences for
7785ARM/Thumb interworking veneers, even if the rest of the binary
7786is not PIC. This avoids problems on uClinux targets where
7787@samp{--emit-relocs} is used to generate relocatable binaries.
7788
7789@cindex STUB_GROUP_SIZE
7790@kindex --stub-group-size=@var{N}
7791The linker will automatically generate and insert small sequences of
7792code into a linked ARM ELF executable whenever an attempt is made to
7793perform a function call to a symbol that is too far away. The
7794placement of these sequences of instructions - called stubs - is
a05a5b64 7795controlled by the command-line option @option{--stub-group-size=N}.
726150b7 7796The placement is important because a poor choice can create a need for
11e7fd74 7797duplicate stubs, increasing the code size. The linker will try to
726150b7
NC
7798group stubs together in order to reduce interruptions to the flow of
7799code, but it needs guidance as to how big these groups should be and
7800where they should be placed.
7801
7802The value of @samp{N}, the parameter to the
7803@option{--stub-group-size=} option controls where the stub groups are
07d72278 7804placed. If it is negative then all stubs are placed after the first
726150b7
NC
7805branch that needs them. If it is positive then the stubs can be
7806placed either before or after the branches that need them. If the
7807value of @samp{N} is 1 (either +1 or -1) then the linker will choose
7808exactly where to place groups of stubs, using its built in heuristics.
7809A value of @samp{N} greater than 1 (or smaller than -1) tells the
7810linker that a single group of stubs can service at most @samp{N} bytes
7811from the input sections.
7812
7813The default, if @option{--stub-group-size=} is not specified, is
7814@samp{N = +1}.
7815
1a51c1a4
NC
7816Farcalls stubs insertion is fully supported for the ARM-EABI target
7817only, because it relies on object files properties not present
7818otherwise.
7819
1db37fe6
YG
7820@cindex Cortex-A8 erratum workaround
7821@kindex --fix-cortex-a8
7822@kindex --no-fix-cortex-a8
7823The @samp{--fix-cortex-a8} switch enables a link-time workaround for an erratum in certain Cortex-A8 processors. The workaround is enabled by default if you are targeting the ARM v7-A architecture profile. It can be enabled otherwise by specifying @samp{--fix-cortex-a8}, or disabled unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-cortex-a8}.
7824
7825The erratum only affects Thumb-2 code. Please contact ARM for further details.
7826
68fcca92
JW
7827@cindex Cortex-A53 erratum 835769 workaround
7828@kindex --fix-cortex-a53-835769
7829@kindex --no-fix-cortex-a53-835769
7830The @samp{--fix-cortex-a53-835769} switch enables a link-time workaround for erratum 835769 present on certain early revisions of Cortex-A53 processors. The workaround is disabled by default. It can be enabled by specifying @samp{--fix-cortex-a53-835769}, or disabled unconditionally by specifying @samp{--no-fix-cortex-a53-835769}.
7831
7832Please contact ARM for further details.
7833
1db37fe6
YG
7834@kindex --merge-exidx-entries
7835@kindex --no-merge-exidx-entries
7836@cindex Merging exidx entries
7837The @samp{--no-merge-exidx-entries} switch disables the merging of adjacent exidx entries in debuginfo.
7838
7839@kindex --long-plt
7840@cindex 32-bit PLT entries
7841The @samp{--long-plt} option enables the use of 16 byte PLT entries
7842which support up to 4Gb of code. The default is to use 12 byte PLT
7843entries which only support 512Mb of code.
7844
1f56df9d
JW
7845@kindex --no-apply-dynamic-relocs
7846@cindex AArch64 rela addend
7847The @samp{--no-apply-dynamic-relocs} option makes AArch64 linker do not apply
7848link-time values for dynamic relocations.
7849
4ba2ef8f
TP
7850@cindex Placement of SG veneers
7851All SG veneers are placed in the special output section @code{.gnu.sgstubs}.
a05a5b64 7852Its start address must be set, either with the command-line option
4ba2ef8f
TP
7853@samp{--section-start} or in a linker script, to indicate where to place these
7854veneers in memory.
7855
54ddd295
TP
7856@kindex --cmse-implib
7857@cindex Secure gateway import library
7858The @samp{--cmse-implib} option requests that the import libraries
7859specified by the @samp{--out-implib} and @samp{--in-implib} options are
7860secure gateway import libraries, suitable for linking a non-secure
7861executable against secure code as per ARMv8-M Security Extensions.
7862
0955507f
TP
7863@kindex --in-implib=@var{file}
7864@cindex Input import library
7865The @samp{--in-implib=file} specifies an input import library whose symbols
7866must keep the same address in the executable being produced. A warning is
7867given if no @samp{--out-implib} is given but new symbols have been introduced
7868in the executable that should be listed in its import library. Otherwise, if
7869@samp{--out-implib} is specified, the symbols are added to the output import
7870library. A warning is also given if some symbols present in the input import
7871library have disappeared from the executable. This option is only effective
7872for Secure Gateway import libraries, ie. when @samp{--cmse-implib} is
7873specified.
7874
36f63dca
NC
7875@ifclear GENERIC
7876@lowersections
7877@end ifclear
7878@end ifset
7879
7880@ifset HPPA
7881@ifclear GENERIC
7882@raisesections
7883@end ifclear
7884
7885@node HPPA ELF32
7886@section @command{ld} and HPPA 32-bit ELF Support
7887@cindex HPPA multiple sub-space stubs
7888@kindex --multi-subspace
7889When generating a shared library, @command{ld} will by default generate
7890import stubs suitable for use with a single sub-space application.
7891The @samp{--multi-subspace} switch causes @command{ld} to generate export
7892stubs, and different (larger) import stubs suitable for use with
7893multiple sub-spaces.
7894
7895@cindex HPPA stub grouping
7896@kindex --stub-group-size=@var{N}
7897Long branch stubs and import/export stubs are placed by @command{ld} in
7898stub sections located between groups of input sections.
7899@samp{--stub-group-size} specifies the maximum size of a group of input
7900sections handled by one stub section. Since branch offsets are signed,
7901a stub section may serve two groups of input sections, one group before
7902the stub section, and one group after it. However, when using
7903conditional branches that require stubs, it may be better (for branch
7904prediction) that stub sections only serve one group of input sections.
7905A negative value for @samp{N} chooses this scheme, ensuring that
7906branches to stubs always use a negative offset. Two special values of
7907@samp{N} are recognized, @samp{1} and @samp{-1}. These both instruct
7908@command{ld} to automatically size input section groups for the branch types
7909detected, with the same behaviour regarding stub placement as other
7910positive or negative values of @samp{N} respectively.
7911
7912Note that @samp{--stub-group-size} does not split input sections. A
7913single input section larger than the group size specified will of course
7914create a larger group (of one section). If input sections are too
7915large, it may not be possible for a branch to reach its stub.
7916
7917@ifclear GENERIC
7918@lowersections
7919@end ifclear
7920@end ifset
7921
7fb9f789
NC
7922@ifset M68K
7923@ifclear GENERIC
7924@raisesections
7925@end ifclear
7926
7927@node M68K
7928@section @command{ld} and the Motorola 68K family
7929
7930@cindex Motorola 68K GOT generation
7931@kindex --got=@var{type}
7932The @samp{--got=@var{type}} option lets you choose the GOT generation scheme.
7933The choices are @samp{single}, @samp{negative}, @samp{multigot} and
7934@samp{target}. When @samp{target} is selected the linker chooses
7935the default GOT generation scheme for the current target.
7936@samp{single} tells the linker to generate a single GOT with
7937entries only at non-negative offsets.
7938@samp{negative} instructs the linker to generate a single GOT with
7939entries at both negative and positive offsets. Not all environments
7940support such GOTs.
7941@samp{multigot} allows the linker to generate several GOTs in the
7942output file. All GOT references from a single input object
7943file access the same GOT, but references from different input object
7944files might access different GOTs. Not all environments support such GOTs.
7945
7946@ifclear GENERIC
7947@lowersections
7948@end ifclear
7949@end ifset
7950
833794fc
MR
7951@ifset MIPS
7952@ifclear GENERIC
7953@raisesections
7954@end ifclear
7955
7956@node MIPS
7957@section @command{ld} and the MIPS family
7958
7959@cindex MIPS microMIPS instruction choice selection
7960@kindex --insn32
7961@kindex --no-insn32
7962The @samp{--insn32} and @samp{--no-insn32} options control the choice of
7963microMIPS instructions used in code generated by the linker, such as that
7964in the PLT or lazy binding stubs, or in relaxation. If @samp{--insn32} is
7965used, then the linker only uses 32-bit instruction encodings. By default
7966or if @samp{--no-insn32} is used, all instruction encodings are used,
7967including 16-bit ones where possible.
7968
8b10b0b3
MR
7969@cindex MIPS branch relocation check control
7970@kindex --ignore-branch-isa
7971@kindex --no-ignore-branch-isa
7972The @samp{--ignore-branch-isa} and @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} options
7973control branch relocation checks for invalid ISA mode transitions. If
7974@samp{--ignore-branch-isa} is used, then the linker accepts any branch
7975relocations and any ISA mode transition required is lost in relocation
7976calculation, except for some cases of @code{BAL} instructions which meet
7977relaxation conditions and are converted to equivalent @code{JALX}
7978instructions as the associated relocation is calculated. By default
7979or if @samp{--no-ignore-branch-isa} is used a check is made causing
7980the loss of an ISA mode transition to produce an error.
7981
833794fc
MR
7982@ifclear GENERIC
7983@lowersections
7984@end ifclear
7985@end ifset
7986
36f63dca
NC
7987@ifset MMIX
7988@ifclear GENERIC
7989@raisesections
7990@end ifclear
7991
7992@node MMIX
7993@section @code{ld} and MMIX
7994For MMIX, there is a choice of generating @code{ELF} object files or
7995@code{mmo} object files when linking. The simulator @code{mmix}
7996understands the @code{mmo} format. The binutils @code{objcopy} utility
7997can translate between the two formats.
7998
7999There is one special section, the @samp{.MMIX.reg_contents} section.
8000Contents in this section is assumed to correspond to that of global
8001registers, and symbols referring to it are translated to special symbols,
8002equal to registers. In a final link, the start address of the
8003@samp{.MMIX.reg_contents} section corresponds to the first allocated
8004global register multiplied by 8. Register @code{$255} is not included in
8005this section; it is always set to the program entry, which is at the
8006symbol @code{Main} for @code{mmo} files.
8007
7a2de473
HPN
8008Global symbols with the prefix @code{__.MMIX.start.}, for example
8009@code{__.MMIX.start..text} and @code{__.MMIX.start..data} are special.
8010The default linker script uses these to set the default start address
8011of a section.
36f63dca
NC
8012
8013Initial and trailing multiples of zero-valued 32-bit words in a section,
8014are left out from an mmo file.
8015
8016@ifclear GENERIC
8017@lowersections
8018@end ifclear
8019@end ifset
8020
8021@ifset MSP430
8022@ifclear GENERIC
8023@raisesections
8024@end ifclear
8025
8026@node MSP430
8027@section @code{ld} and MSP430
8028For the MSP430 it is possible to select the MPU architecture. The flag @samp{-m [mpu type]}
8029will select an appropriate linker script for selected MPU type. (To get a list of known MPUs
8030just pass @samp{-m help} option to the linker).
8031
8032@cindex MSP430 extra sections
8033The linker will recognize some extra sections which are MSP430 specific:
8034
8035@table @code
8036@item @samp{.vectors}
8037Defines a portion of ROM where interrupt vectors located.
8038
8039@item @samp{.bootloader}
8040Defines the bootloader portion of the ROM (if applicable). Any code
8041in this section will be uploaded to the MPU.
8042
8043@item @samp{.infomem}
8044Defines an information memory section (if applicable). Any code in
8045this section will be uploaded to the MPU.
8046
c0065db7 8047@item @samp{.infomemnobits}
36f63dca
NC
8048This is the same as the @samp{.infomem} section except that any code
8049in this section will not be uploaded to the MPU.
8050
8051@item @samp{.noinit}
8052Denotes a portion of RAM located above @samp{.bss} section.
8053
c0065db7 8054The last two sections are used by gcc.
36f63dca
NC
8055@end table
8056
7ef3addb
JL
8057@table @option
8058@cindex MSP430 Options
8059@kindex --code-region
8060@item --code-region=[either,lower,upper,none]
8061This will transform .text* sections to [either,lower,upper].text* sections. The
8062argument passed to GCC for -mcode-region is propagated to the linker
8063using this option.
8064
8065@kindex --data-region
8066@item --data-region=[either,lower,upper,none]
8067This will transform .data*, .bss* and .rodata* sections to
8068[either,lower,upper].[data,bss,rodata]* sections. The argument passed to GCC
8069for -mdata-region is propagated to the linker using this option.
8070
8071@kindex --disable-sec-transformation
8072@item --disable-sec-transformation
8073Prevent the transformation of sections as specified by the @code{--code-region}
8074and @code{--data-region} options.
8075This is useful if you are compiling and linking using a single call to the GCC
8076wrapper, and want to compile the source files using -m[code,data]-region but
8077not transform the sections for prebuilt libraries and objects.
8078@end table
8079
36f63dca
NC
8080@ifclear GENERIC
8081@lowersections
8082@end ifclear
8083@end ifset
8084
35c08157
KLC
8085@ifset NDS32
8086@ifclear GENERIC
8087@raisesections
8088@end ifclear
8089
8090@node NDS32
8091@section @code{ld} and NDS32
8092@kindex relaxing on NDS32
8093For NDS32, there are some options to select relaxation behavior. The linker
8094relaxes objects according to these options.
8095
8096@table @code
8097@item @samp{--m[no-]fp-as-gp}
8098Disable/enable fp-as-gp relaxation.
8099
8100@item @samp{--mexport-symbols=FILE}
8101Exporting symbols and their address into FILE as linker script.
8102
8103@item @samp{--m[no-]ex9}
8104Disable/enable link-time EX9 relaxation.
8105
8106@item @samp{--mexport-ex9=FILE}
8107Export the EX9 table after linking.
8108
8109@item @samp{--mimport-ex9=FILE}
8110Import the Ex9 table for EX9 relaxation.
8111
8112@item @samp{--mupdate-ex9}
8113Update the existing EX9 table.
8114
8115@item @samp{--mex9-limit=NUM}
8116Maximum number of entries in the ex9 table.
8117
8118@item @samp{--mex9-loop-aware}
8119Avoid generating the EX9 instruction inside the loop.
8120
8121@item @samp{--m[no-]ifc}
8122Disable/enable the link-time IFC optimization.
8123
8124@item @samp{--mifc-loop-aware}
8125Avoid generating the IFC instruction inside the loop.
8126@end table
8127
8128@ifclear GENERIC
8129@lowersections
8130@end ifclear
8131@end ifset
8132
78058a5e
SL
8133@ifset NIOSII
8134@ifclear GENERIC
8135@raisesections
8136@end ifclear
8137
8138@node Nios II
8139@section @command{ld} and the Altera Nios II
8140@cindex Nios II call relaxation
8141@kindex --relax on Nios II
8142
8143Call and immediate jump instructions on Nios II processors are limited to
8144transferring control to addresses in the same 256MB memory segment,
8145which may result in @command{ld} giving
8146@samp{relocation truncated to fit} errors with very large programs.
8147The command-line option @option{--relax} enables the generation of
8148trampolines that can access the entire 32-bit address space for calls
8149outside the normal @code{call} and @code{jmpi} address range. These
8150trampolines are inserted at section boundaries, so may not themselves
8151be reachable if an input section and its associated call trampolines are
8152larger than 256MB.
8153
8154The @option{--relax} option is enabled by default unless @option{-r}
8155is also specified. You can disable trampoline generation by using the
8156@option{--no-relax} linker option. You can also disable this optimization
8157locally by using the @samp{set .noat} directive in assembly-language
8158source files, as the linker-inserted trampolines use the @code{at}
8159register as a temporary.
8160
8161Note that the linker @option{--relax} option is independent of assembler
8162relaxation options, and that using the GNU assembler's @option{-relax-all}
8163option interferes with the linker's more selective call instruction relaxation.
8164
8165@ifclear GENERIC
8166@lowersections
8167@end ifclear
8168@end ifset
8169
2a60a7a8
AM
8170@ifset POWERPC
8171@ifclear GENERIC
8172@raisesections
8173@end ifclear
8174
8175@node PowerPC ELF32
8176@section @command{ld} and PowerPC 32-bit ELF Support
8177@cindex PowerPC long branches
8178@kindex --relax on PowerPC
8179Branches on PowerPC processors are limited to a signed 26-bit
8180displacement, which may result in @command{ld} giving
8181@samp{relocation truncated to fit} errors with very large programs.
8182@samp{--relax} enables the generation of trampolines that can access
8183the entire 32-bit address space. These trampolines are inserted at
8184section boundaries, so may not themselves be reachable if an input
c8a1f254
NS
8185section exceeds 33M in size. You may combine @samp{-r} and
8186@samp{--relax} to add trampolines in a partial link. In that case
8187both branches to undefined symbols and inter-section branches are also
8188considered potentially out of range, and trampolines inserted.
2a60a7a8
AM
8189
8190@cindex PowerPC ELF32 options
8191@table @option
8192@cindex PowerPC PLT
8193@kindex --bss-plt
8194@item --bss-plt
8195Current PowerPC GCC accepts a @samp{-msecure-plt} option that
8196generates code capable of using a newer PLT and GOT layout that has
8197the security advantage of no executable section ever needing to be
8198writable and no writable section ever being executable. PowerPC
8199@command{ld} will generate this layout, including stubs to access the
8200PLT, if all input files (including startup and static libraries) were
8201compiled with @samp{-msecure-plt}. @samp{--bss-plt} forces the old
8202BSS PLT (and GOT layout) which can give slightly better performance.
8203
016687f8
AM
8204@kindex --secure-plt
8205@item --secure-plt
8206@command{ld} will use the new PLT and GOT layout if it is linking new
8207@samp{-fpic} or @samp{-fPIC} code, but does not do so automatically
8208when linking non-PIC code. This option requests the new PLT and GOT
8209layout. A warning will be given if some object file requires the old
8210style BSS PLT.
8211
2a60a7a8
AM
8212@cindex PowerPC GOT
8213@kindex --sdata-got
8214@item --sdata-got
8215The new secure PLT and GOT are placed differently relative to other
8216sections compared to older BSS PLT and GOT placement. The location of
8217@code{.plt} must change because the new secure PLT is an initialized
8218section while the old PLT is uninitialized. The reason for the
8219@code{.got} change is more subtle: The new placement allows
8220@code{.got} to be read-only in applications linked with
8221@samp{-z relro -z now}. However, this placement means that
8222@code{.sdata} cannot always be used in shared libraries, because the
8223PowerPC ABI accesses @code{.sdata} in shared libraries from the GOT
8224pointer. @samp{--sdata-got} forces the old GOT placement. PowerPC
8225GCC doesn't use @code{.sdata} in shared libraries, so this option is
8226really only useful for other compilers that may do so.
8227
8228@cindex PowerPC stub symbols
8229@kindex --emit-stub-syms
8230@item --emit-stub-syms
8231This option causes @command{ld} to label linker stubs with a local
8232symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
8233
8234@cindex PowerPC TLS optimization
8235@kindex --no-tls-optimize
8236@item --no-tls-optimize
8237PowerPC @command{ld} normally performs some optimization of code
8238sequences used to access Thread-Local Storage. Use this option to
8239disable the optimization.
8240@end table
8241
8242@ifclear GENERIC
8243@lowersections
8244@end ifclear
8245@end ifset
8246
8247@ifset POWERPC64
8248@ifclear GENERIC
8249@raisesections
8250@end ifclear
8251
8252@node PowerPC64 ELF64
8253@section @command{ld} and PowerPC64 64-bit ELF Support
8254
8255@cindex PowerPC64 ELF64 options
8256@table @option
8257@cindex PowerPC64 stub grouping
8258@kindex --stub-group-size
8259@item --stub-group-size
8260Long branch stubs, PLT call stubs and TOC adjusting stubs are placed
8261by @command{ld} in stub sections located between groups of input sections.
8262@samp{--stub-group-size} specifies the maximum size of a group of input
8263sections handled by one stub section. Since branch offsets are signed,
8264a stub section may serve two groups of input sections, one group before
8265the stub section, and one group after it. However, when using
8266conditional branches that require stubs, it may be better (for branch
8267prediction) that stub sections only serve one group of input sections.
8268A negative value for @samp{N} chooses this scheme, ensuring that
8269branches to stubs always use a negative offset. Two special values of
8270@samp{N} are recognized, @samp{1} and @samp{-1}. These both instruct
8271@command{ld} to automatically size input section groups for the branch types
8272detected, with the same behaviour regarding stub placement as other
8273positive or negative values of @samp{N} respectively.
8274
8275Note that @samp{--stub-group-size} does not split input sections. A
8276single input section larger than the group size specified will of course
8277create a larger group (of one section). If input sections are too
8278large, it may not be possible for a branch to reach its stub.
8279
8280@cindex PowerPC64 stub symbols
8281@kindex --emit-stub-syms
8282@item --emit-stub-syms
8283This option causes @command{ld} to label linker stubs with a local
8284symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
8285
8286@cindex PowerPC64 dot symbols
8287@kindex --dotsyms
8288@kindex --no-dotsyms
95421fb9
AM
8289@item --dotsyms
8290@itemx --no-dotsyms
2a60a7a8
AM
8291These two options control how @command{ld} interprets version patterns
8292in a version script. Older PowerPC64 compilers emitted both a
8293function descriptor symbol with the same name as the function, and a
8294code entry symbol with the name prefixed by a dot (@samp{.}). To
8295properly version a function @samp{foo}, the version script thus needs
8296to control both @samp{foo} and @samp{.foo}. The option
8297@samp{--dotsyms}, on by default, automatically adds the required
8298dot-prefixed patterns. Use @samp{--no-dotsyms} to disable this
8299feature.
8300
7ae4ea7d
AM
8301@cindex PowerPC64 register save/restore functions
8302@kindex --save-restore-funcs
8303@kindex --no-save-restore-funcs
95421fb9
AM
8304@item --save-restore-funcs
8305@itemx --no-save-restore-funcs
7ae4ea7d
AM
8306These two options control whether PowerPC64 @command{ld} automatically
8307provides out-of-line register save and restore functions used by
8308@samp{-Os} code. The default is to provide any such referenced
8309function for a normal final link, and to not do so for a relocatable
8310link.
8311
2a60a7a8
AM
8312@cindex PowerPC64 TLS optimization
8313@kindex --no-tls-optimize
8314@item --no-tls-optimize
8315PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally performs some optimization of code
8316sequences used to access Thread-Local Storage. Use this option to
8317disable the optimization.
8318
7c9cf415
AM
8319@cindex PowerPC64 __tls_get_addr optimization
8320@kindex --tls-get-addr-optimize
8321@kindex --no-tls-get-addr-optimize
9e7028aa
AM
8322@kindex --tls-get-addr-regsave
8323@kindex --no-tls-get-addr-regsave
95421fb9
AM
8324@item --tls-get-addr-optimize
8325@itemx --no-tls-get-addr-optimize
9e7028aa 8326These options control how PowerPC64 @command{ld} uses a special
7c9cf415
AM
8327stub to call __tls_get_addr. PowerPC64 glibc 2.22 and later support
8328an optimization that allows the second and subsequent calls to
8329@code{__tls_get_addr} for a given symbol to be resolved by the special
9e7028aa
AM
8330stub without calling in to glibc. By default the linker enables
8331generation of the stub when glibc advertises the availability of
8332__tls_get_addr_opt.
8333Using @option{--tls-get-addr-optimize} with an older glibc won't do
8334much besides slow down your applications, but may be useful if linking
8335an application against an older glibc with the expectation that it
8336will normally be used on systems having a newer glibc.
8337@option{--tls-get-addr-regsave} forces generation of a stub that saves
8338and restores volatile registers around the call into glibc. Normally,
8339this is done when the linker detects a call to __tls_get_addr_desc.
8340Such calls then go via the register saving stub to __tls_get_addr_opt.
5cebc931 8341@option{--no-tls-get-addr-regsave} disables generation of the
9e7028aa 8342register saves.
7c9cf415 8343
2a60a7a8
AM
8344@cindex PowerPC64 OPD optimization
8345@kindex --no-opd-optimize
8346@item --no-opd-optimize
8347PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally removes @code{.opd} section entries
8348corresponding to deleted link-once functions, or functions removed by
e7fc76dd 8349the action of @samp{--gc-sections} or linker script @code{/DISCARD/}.
2a60a7a8
AM
8350Use this option to disable @code{.opd} optimization.
8351
8352@cindex PowerPC64 OPD spacing
8353@kindex --non-overlapping-opd
8354@item --non-overlapping-opd
8355Some PowerPC64 compilers have an option to generate compressed
8356@code{.opd} entries spaced 16 bytes apart, overlapping the third word,
8357the static chain pointer (unused in C) with the first word of the next
8358entry. This option expands such entries to the full 24 bytes.
8359
8360@cindex PowerPC64 TOC optimization
8361@kindex --no-toc-optimize
8362@item --no-toc-optimize
8363PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally removes unused @code{.toc} section
8364entries. Such entries are detected by examining relocations that
8365reference the TOC in code sections. A reloc in a deleted code section
8366marks a TOC word as unneeded, while a reloc in a kept code section
8367marks a TOC word as needed. Since the TOC may reference itself, TOC
8368relocs are also examined. TOC words marked as both needed and
8369unneeded will of course be kept. TOC words without any referencing
8370reloc are assumed to be part of a multi-word entry, and are kept or
8371discarded as per the nearest marked preceding word. This works
8372reliably for compiler generated code, but may be incorrect if assembly
8373code is used to insert TOC entries. Use this option to disable the
8374optimization.
8375
d882c988
AM
8376@cindex PowerPC64 inline PLT call optimization
8377@kindex --no-inline-optimize
8378@item --no-inline-optimize
8379PowerPC64 @command{ld} normally replaces inline PLT call sequences
8380marked with @code{R_PPC64_PLTSEQ}, @code{R_PPC64_PLTCALL},
8381@code{R_PPC64_PLT16_HA} and @code{R_PPC64_PLT16_LO_DS} relocations by
8382a number of @code{nop}s and a direct call when the function is defined
8383locally and can't be overridden by some other definition. This option
8384disables that optimization.
8385
2a60a7a8
AM
8386@cindex PowerPC64 multi-TOC
8387@kindex --no-multi-toc
8388@item --no-multi-toc
794e51c0
AM
8389If given any toc option besides @code{-mcmodel=medium} or
8390@code{-mcmodel=large}, PowerPC64 GCC generates code for a TOC model
8391where TOC
2a60a7a8
AM
8392entries are accessed with a 16-bit offset from r2. This limits the
8393total TOC size to 64K. PowerPC64 @command{ld} extends this limit by
8394grouping code sections such that each group uses less than 64K for its
8395TOC entries, then inserts r2 adjusting stubs between inter-group
8396calls. @command{ld} does not split apart input sections, so cannot
8397help if a single input file has a @code{.toc} section that exceeds
839864K, most likely from linking multiple files with @command{ld -r}.
8399Use this option to turn off this feature.
794e51c0
AM
8400
8401@cindex PowerPC64 TOC sorting
8402@kindex --no-toc-sort
8403@item --no-toc-sort
8404By default, @command{ld} sorts TOC sections so that those whose file
8405happens to have a section called @code{.init} or @code{.fini} are
8406placed first, followed by TOC sections referenced by code generated
8407with PowerPC64 gcc's @code{-mcmodel=small}, and lastly TOC sections
8408referenced only by code generated with PowerPC64 gcc's
8409@code{-mcmodel=medium} or @code{-mcmodel=large} options. Doing this
8410results in better TOC grouping for multi-TOC. Use this option to turn
8411off this feature.
8412
8413@cindex PowerPC64 PLT stub alignment
8414@kindex --plt-align
8415@kindex --no-plt-align
8416@item --plt-align
8417@itemx --no-plt-align
8418Use these options to control whether individual PLT call stubs are
2420fff6
AM
8419aligned to a 32-byte boundary, or to the specified power of two
8420boundary when using @code{--plt-align=}. A negative value may be
8421specified to pad PLT call stubs so that they do not cross the
8422specified power of two boundary (or the minimum number of boundaries
8423if a PLT stub is so large that it must cross a boundary). By default
8424PLT call stubs are aligned to 32-byte boundaries.
794e51c0
AM
8425
8426@cindex PowerPC64 PLT call stub static chain
8427@kindex --plt-static-chain
8428@kindex --no-plt-static-chain
8429@item --plt-static-chain
8430@itemx --no-plt-static-chain
8431Use these options to control whether PLT call stubs load the static
8432chain pointer (r11). @code{ld} defaults to not loading the static
8433chain since there is never any need to do so on a PLT call.
8434
8435@cindex PowerPC64 PLT call stub thread safety
8436@kindex --plt-thread-safe
8437@kindex --no-plt-thread-safe
8438@item --plt-thread-safe
1be5d8d3 8439@itemx --no-plt-thread-safe
794e51c0
AM
8440With power7's weakly ordered memory model, it is possible when using
8441lazy binding for ld.so to update a plt entry in one thread and have
8442another thread see the individual plt entry words update in the wrong
8443order, despite ld.so carefully writing in the correct order and using
8444memory write barriers. To avoid this we need some sort of read
8445barrier in the call stub, or use LD_BIND_NOW=1. By default, @code{ld}
8446looks for calls to commonly used functions that create threads, and if
8447seen, adds the necessary barriers. Use these options to change the
8448default behaviour.
8b5f1ed8
AM
8449
8450@cindex PowerPC64 ELFv2 PLT localentry optimization
8451@kindex --plt-localentry
8452@kindex --no-plt-localentry
8453@item --plt-localentry
8454@itemx --no-localentry
8455ELFv2 functions with localentry:0 are those with a single entry point,
8456ie. global entry == local entry, and that have no requirement on r2
8457(the TOC/GOT pointer) or r12, and guarantee r2 is unchanged on return.
8458Such an external function can be called via the PLT without saving r2
8459or restoring it on return, avoiding a common load-hit-store for small
8460functions. The optimization is attractive, with up to 40% reduction
8461in execution time for a small function, but can result in symbol
d44c746a
AM
8462interposition failures. Also, minor changes in a shared library,
8463including system libraries, can cause a function that was localentry:0
8464to become localentry:8. This will result in a dynamic loader
8465complaint and failure to run. The option is experimental, use with
8466care. @option{--no-plt-localentry} is the default.
d882c988
AM
8467
8468@cindex PowerPC64 Power10 stubs
8469@kindex --power10-stubs
8470@kindex --no-power10-stubs
8471@item --power10-stubs
8472@itemx --no-power10-stubs
8473When PowerPC64 @command{ld} links input object files containing
8474relocations used on power10 prefixed instructions it normally creates
e10a07b3
AM
8475linkage stubs (PLT call and long branch) using power10 instructions
8476for @code{@@notoc} PLT calls where @code{r2} is not known. The
8477power10 notoc stubs are smaller and faster, so are preferred for
d882c988
AM
8478power10. @option{--power10-stubs} and @option{--no-power10-stubs}
8479allow you to override the linker's selection of stub instructions.
e10a07b3
AM
8480@option{--power10-stubs=auto} allows the user to select the default
8481auto mode.
2a60a7a8
AM
8482@end table
8483
8484@ifclear GENERIC
8485@lowersections
8486@end ifclear
8487@end ifset
8488
b4cbbe8f
AK
8489@ifset S/390
8490@ifclear GENERIC
8491@raisesections
8492@end ifclear
8493
8494@node S/390 ELF
8495@section @command{ld} and S/390 ELF Support
8496
8497@cindex S/390 ELF options
8498@table @option
8499
8500@cindex S/390
8501@kindex --s390-pgste
8502@item --s390-pgste
8503This option marks the result file with a @code{PT_S390_PGSTE}
8504segment. The Linux kernel is supposed to allocate 4k page tables for
8505binaries marked that way.
8506@end table
8507
8508@ifclear GENERIC
8509@lowersections
8510@end ifclear
8511@end ifset
8512
49fa1e15
AM
8513@ifset SPU
8514@ifclear GENERIC
8515@raisesections
8516@end ifclear
8517
8518@node SPU ELF
8519@section @command{ld} and SPU ELF Support
8520
8521@cindex SPU ELF options
8522@table @option
8523
8524@cindex SPU plugins
8525@kindex --plugin
8526@item --plugin
8527This option marks an executable as a PIC plugin module.
8528
8529@cindex SPU overlays
8530@kindex --no-overlays
8531@item --no-overlays
8532Normally, @command{ld} recognizes calls to functions within overlay
8533regions, and redirects such calls to an overlay manager via a stub.
8534@command{ld} also provides a built-in overlay manager. This option
8535turns off all this special overlay handling.
8536
8537@cindex SPU overlay stub symbols
8538@kindex --emit-stub-syms
8539@item --emit-stub-syms
8540This option causes @command{ld} to label overlay stubs with a local
8541symbol that encodes the stub type and destination.
8542
8543@cindex SPU extra overlay stubs
8544@kindex --extra-overlay-stubs
8545@item --extra-overlay-stubs
8546This option causes @command{ld} to add overlay call stubs on all
8547function calls out of overlay regions. Normally stubs are not added
8548on calls to non-overlay regions.
8549
8550@cindex SPU local store size
8551@kindex --local-store=lo:hi
8552@item --local-store=lo:hi
8553@command{ld} usually checks that a final executable for SPU fits in
8554the address range 0 to 256k. This option may be used to change the
8555range. Disable the check entirely with @option{--local-store=0:0}.
8556
c0065db7 8557@cindex SPU
49fa1e15
AM
8558@kindex --stack-analysis
8559@item --stack-analysis
8560SPU local store space is limited. Over-allocation of stack space
8561unnecessarily limits space available for code and data, while
8562under-allocation results in runtime failures. If given this option,
8563@command{ld} will provide an estimate of maximum stack usage.
8564@command{ld} does this by examining symbols in code sections to
8565determine the extents of functions, and looking at function prologues
8566for stack adjusting instructions. A call-graph is created by looking
8567for relocations on branch instructions. The graph is then searched
8568for the maximum stack usage path. Note that this analysis does not
8569find calls made via function pointers, and does not handle recursion
8570and other cycles in the call graph. Stack usage may be
8571under-estimated if your code makes such calls. Also, stack usage for
8572dynamic allocation, e.g. alloca, will not be detected. If a link map
8573is requested, detailed information about each function's stack usage
8574and calls will be given.
8575
c0065db7 8576@cindex SPU
49fa1e15
AM
8577@kindex --emit-stack-syms
8578@item --emit-stack-syms
8579This option, if given along with @option{--stack-analysis} will result
8580in @command{ld} emitting stack sizing symbols for each function.
8581These take the form @code{__stack_<function_name>} for global
8582functions, and @code{__stack_<number>_<function_name>} for static
8583functions. @code{<number>} is the section id in hex. The value of
8584such symbols is the stack requirement for the corresponding function.
8585The symbol size will be zero, type @code{STT_NOTYPE}, binding
c0065db7 8586@code{STB_LOCAL}, and section @code{SHN_ABS}.
49fa1e15
AM
8587@end table
8588
8589@ifclear GENERIC
8590@lowersections
8591@end ifclear
8592@end ifset
8593
36f63dca
NC
8594@ifset TICOFF
8595@ifclear GENERIC
8596@raisesections
8597@end ifclear
8598
8599@node TI COFF
8600@section @command{ld}'s Support for Various TI COFF Versions
8601@cindex TI COFF versions
8602@kindex --format=@var{version}
8603The @samp{--format} switch allows selection of one of the various
8604TI COFF versions. The latest of this writing is 2; versions 0 and 1 are
8605also supported. The TI COFF versions also vary in header byte-order
8606format; @command{ld} will read any version or byte order, but the output
8607header format depends on the default specified by the specific target.
8608
8609@ifclear GENERIC
8610@lowersections
8611@end ifclear
8612@end ifset
8613
2ca22b03
NC
8614@ifset WIN32
8615@ifclear GENERIC
8616@raisesections
8617@end ifclear
8618
8619@node WIN32
8620@section @command{ld} and WIN32 (cygwin/mingw)
8621
c0065db7 8622This section describes some of the win32 specific @command{ld} issues.
a05a5b64
TP
8623See @ref{Options,,Command-line Options} for detailed description of the
8624command-line options mentioned here.
2ca22b03
NC
8625
8626@table @emph
c0065db7
RM
8627@cindex import libraries
8628@item import libraries
69da35b5 8629The standard Windows linker creates and uses so-called import
2ca22b03 8630libraries, which contains information for linking to dll's. They are
69da35b5
NC
8631regular static archives and are handled as any other static
8632archive. The cygwin and mingw ports of @command{ld} have specific
2ca22b03 8633support for creating such libraries provided with the
a05a5b64 8634@samp{--out-implib} command-line option.
2ca22b03 8635
d1792f72
NC
8636@item Resource only DLLs
8637It is possible to create a DLL that only contains resources, ie just a
8638@samp{.rsrc} section, but in order to do so a custom linker script
8639must be used. This is because the built-in default linker scripts
05d31a0b 8640will always create @samp{.text} and @samp{.idata} sections, even if
d1792f72
NC
8641there is no input to go into them.
8642
8643The script should look like this, although the @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT}
8644should be changed to match the desired format.
8645
8646@example
8647OUTPUT_FORMAT(pei-i386)
8648SECTIONS
8649@{
8650 . = SIZEOF_HEADERS;
8651 . = ALIGN(__section_alignment__);
8652 .rsrc __image_base__ + __section_alignment__ : ALIGN(4)
8653 @{
8654 KEEP (*(.rsrc))
8655 KEEP (*(.rsrc$*))
8656 @}
8657 /DISCARD/ : @{ *(*) @}
8658@}
8659@end example
8660
8661With this script saved to a file called, eg @file{rsrc.ld}, a command
8662line like this can be used to create the resource only DLL
8663@file{rsrc.dll} from an input file called @file{rsrc.o}:
8664
8665@smallexample
8666ld -dll --subsystem windows -e 0 -s rsrc.o -o rsrc.dll -T rsrc.ld
8667@end smallexample
8668
c0065db7
RM
8669@item exporting DLL symbols
8670@cindex exporting DLL symbols
dc8465bf
NC
8671The cygwin/mingw @command{ld} has several ways to export symbols for dll's.
8672
8673@table @emph
8674@item using auto-export functionality
8675@cindex using auto-export functionality
8676By default @command{ld} exports symbols with the auto-export functionality,
a05a5b64 8677which is controlled by the following command-line options:
dc8465bf 8678
0a5d968e
NC
8679@itemize
8680@item --export-all-symbols [This is the default]
8681@item --exclude-symbols
8682@item --exclude-libs
e1c37eb5 8683@item --exclude-modules-for-implib
09e2aba4 8684@item --version-script
0a5d968e
NC
8685@end itemize
8686
09e2aba4
DK
8687When auto-export is in operation, @command{ld} will export all the non-local
8688(global and common) symbols it finds in a DLL, with the exception of a few
8689symbols known to belong to the system's runtime and libraries. As it will
8690often not be desirable to export all of a DLL's symbols, which may include
8691private functions that are not part of any public interface, the command-line
9d5777a3 8692options listed above may be used to filter symbols out from the list for
09e2aba4
DK
8693exporting. The @samp{--output-def} option can be used in order to see the
8694final list of exported symbols with all exclusions taken into effect.
8695
8696If @samp{--export-all-symbols} is not given explicitly on the
0a5d968e
NC
8697command line, then the default auto-export behavior will be @emph{disabled}
8698if either of the following are true:
8699
8700@itemize
8701@item A DEF file is used.
8702@item Any symbol in any object file was marked with the __declspec(dllexport) attribute.
8703@end itemize
dc8465bf 8704
c0065db7
RM
8705@item using a DEF file
8706@cindex using a DEF file
dc8465bf
NC
8707Another way of exporting symbols is using a DEF file. A DEF file is
8708an ASCII file containing definitions of symbols which should be
8709exported when a dll is created. Usually it is named @samp{<dll
8710name>.def} and is added as any other object file to the linker's
0a5d968e 8711command line. The file's name must end in @samp{.def} or @samp{.DEF}.
dc8465bf
NC
8712
8713@example
8714gcc -o <output> <objectfiles> <dll name>.def
8715@end example
8716
0a5d968e
NC
8717Using a DEF file turns off the normal auto-export behavior, unless the
8718@samp{--export-all-symbols} option is also used.
8719
dc8465bf
NC
8720Here is an example of a DEF file for a shared library called @samp{xyz.dll}:
8721
8722@example
4b5bd4e7 8723LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x20000000
dc8465bf
NC
8724
8725EXPORTS
8726foo
8727bar
8728_bar = bar
4b5bd4e7
DS
8729another_foo = abc.dll.afoo
8730var1 DATA
7fcab871
KT
8731doo = foo == foo2
8732eoo DATA == var1
c0065db7 8733@end example
dc8465bf 8734
7fcab871 8735This example defines a DLL with a non-default base address and seven
4b5bd4e7
DS
8736symbols in the export table. The third exported symbol @code{_bar} is an
8737alias for the second. The fourth symbol, @code{another_foo} is resolved
8738by "forwarding" to another module and treating it as an alias for
8739@code{afoo} exported from the DLL @samp{abc.dll}. The final symbol
7fcab871
KT
8740@code{var1} is declared to be a data object. The @samp{doo} symbol in
8741export library is an alias of @samp{foo}, which gets the string name
8742in export table @samp{foo2}. The @samp{eoo} symbol is an data export
8743symbol, which gets in export table the name @samp{var1}.
4b5bd4e7 8744
6b31ad16
DS
8745The optional @code{LIBRARY <name>} command indicates the @emph{internal}
8746name of the output DLL. If @samp{<name>} does not include a suffix,
8747the default library suffix, @samp{.DLL} is appended.
8748
b45619c0
NC
8749When the .DEF file is used to build an application, rather than a
8750library, the @code{NAME <name>} command should be used instead of
6b31ad16 8751@code{LIBRARY}. If @samp{<name>} does not include a suffix, the default
c0065db7 8752executable suffix, @samp{.EXE} is appended.
6b31ad16
DS
8753
8754With either @code{LIBRARY <name>} or @code{NAME <name>} the optional
8755specification @code{BASE = <number>} may be used to specify a
c0065db7 8756non-default base address for the image.
6b31ad16
DS
8757
8758If neither @code{LIBRARY <name>} nor @code{NAME <name>} is specified,
a2877985
DS
8759or they specify an empty string, the internal name is the same as the
8760filename specified on the command line.
6b31ad16 8761
4b5bd4e7
DS
8762The complete specification of an export symbol is:
8763
8764@example
8765EXPORTS
8766 ( ( ( <name1> [ = <name2> ] )
8767 | ( <name1> = <module-name> . <external-name>))
7fcab871 8768 [ @@ <integer> ] [NONAME] [DATA] [CONSTANT] [PRIVATE] [== <name3>] ) *
c0065db7 8769@end example
4b5bd4e7
DS
8770
8771Declares @samp{<name1>} as an exported symbol from the DLL, or declares
8772@samp{<name1>} as an exported alias for @samp{<name2>}; or declares
8773@samp{<name1>} as a "forward" alias for the symbol
8774@samp{<external-name>} in the DLL @samp{<module-name>}.
8775Optionally, the symbol may be exported by the specified ordinal
7fcab871
KT
8776@samp{<integer>} alias. The optional @samp{<name3>} is the to be used
8777string in import/export table for the symbol.
4b5bd4e7
DS
8778
8779The optional keywords that follow the declaration indicate:
8780
8781@code{NONAME}: Do not put the symbol name in the DLL's export table. It
8782will still be exported by its ordinal alias (either the value specified
8783by the .def specification or, otherwise, the value assigned by the
8784linker). The symbol name, however, does remain visible in the import
8785library (if any), unless @code{PRIVATE} is also specified.
8786
8787@code{DATA}: The symbol is a variable or object, rather than a function.
8788The import lib will export only an indirect reference to @code{foo} as
8789the symbol @code{_imp__foo} (ie, @code{foo} must be resolved as
8790@code{*_imp__foo}).
8791
8792@code{CONSTANT}: Like @code{DATA}, but put the undecorated @code{foo} as
8793well as @code{_imp__foo} into the import library. Both refer to the
8794read-only import address table's pointer to the variable, not to the
8795variable itself. This can be dangerous. If the user code fails to add
8796the @code{dllimport} attribute and also fails to explicitly add the
8797extra indirection that the use of the attribute enforces, the
8798application will behave unexpectedly.
8799
8800@code{PRIVATE}: Put the symbol in the DLL's export table, but do not put
8801it into the static import library used to resolve imports at link time. The
8802symbol can still be imported using the @code{LoadLibrary/GetProcAddress}
de194d85 8803API at runtime or by using the GNU ld extension of linking directly to
4b5bd4e7 8804the DLL without an import library.
c0065db7 8805
4b5bd4e7
DS
8806See ld/deffilep.y in the binutils sources for the full specification of
8807other DEF file statements
dc8465bf
NC
8808
8809@cindex creating a DEF file
8810While linking a shared dll, @command{ld} is able to create a DEF file
a05a5b64 8811with the @samp{--output-def <file>} command-line option.
0a5d968e
NC
8812
8813@item Using decorations
8814@cindex Using decorations
8815Another way of marking symbols for export is to modify the source code
8816itself, so that when building the DLL each symbol to be exported is
8817declared as:
8818
8819@example
8820__declspec(dllexport) int a_variable
8821__declspec(dllexport) void a_function(int with_args)
8822@end example
8823
8824All such symbols will be exported from the DLL. If, however,
8825any of the object files in the DLL contain symbols decorated in
8826this way, then the normal auto-export behavior is disabled, unless
8827the @samp{--export-all-symbols} option is also used.
8828
8829Note that object files that wish to access these symbols must @emph{not}
c0065db7 8830decorate them with dllexport. Instead, they should use dllimport,
0a5d968e
NC
8831instead:
8832
8833@example
8834__declspec(dllimport) int a_variable
8835__declspec(dllimport) void a_function(int with_args)
8836@end example
8837
c0065db7
RM
8838This complicates the structure of library header files, because
8839when included by the library itself the header must declare the
0a5d968e
NC
8840variables and functions as dllexport, but when included by client
8841code the header must declare them as dllimport. There are a number
c0065db7 8842of idioms that are typically used to do this; often client code can
0a5d968e
NC
8843omit the __declspec() declaration completely. See
8844@samp{--enable-auto-import} and @samp{automatic data imports} for more
b45619c0 8845information.
c0065db7 8846@end table
dc8465bf 8847
2ca22b03
NC
8848@cindex automatic data imports
8849@item automatic data imports
8850The standard Windows dll format supports data imports from dlls only
69da35b5 8851by adding special decorations (dllimport/dllexport), which let the
2ca22b03 8852compiler produce specific assembler instructions to deal with this
c0065db7 8853issue. This increases the effort necessary to port existing Un*x
69da35b5 8854code to these platforms, especially for large
2ca22b03 8855c++ libraries and applications. The auto-import feature, which was
c0065db7 8856initially provided by Paul Sokolovsky, allows one to omit the
b45619c0 8857decorations to achieve a behavior that conforms to that on POSIX/Un*x
c0065db7 8858platforms. This feature is enabled with the @samp{--enable-auto-import}
69da35b5
NC
8859command-line option, although it is enabled by default on cygwin/mingw.
8860The @samp{--enable-auto-import} option itself now serves mainly to
8861suppress any warnings that are ordinarily emitted when linked objects
8862trigger the feature's use.
8863
c0065db7 8864auto-import of variables does not always work flawlessly without
69da35b5
NC
8865additional assistance. Sometimes, you will see this message
8866
c0065db7 8867"variable '<var>' can't be auto-imported. Please read the
69da35b5
NC
8868documentation for ld's @code{--enable-auto-import} for details."
8869
c0065db7
RM
8870The @samp{--enable-auto-import} documentation explains why this error
8871occurs, and several methods that can be used to overcome this difficulty.
8872One of these methods is the @emph{runtime pseudo-relocs} feature, described
69da35b5
NC
8873below.
8874
8875@cindex runtime pseudo-relocation
c0065db7
RM
8876For complex variables imported from DLLs (such as structs or classes),
8877object files typically contain a base address for the variable and an
8878offset (@emph{addend}) within the variable--to specify a particular
8879field or public member, for instance. Unfortunately, the runtime loader used
8880in win32 environments is incapable of fixing these references at runtime
69da35b5 8881without the additional information supplied by dllimport/dllexport decorations.
c0065db7 8882The standard auto-import feature described above is unable to resolve these
69da35b5
NC
8883references.
8884
c0065db7
RM
8885The @samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} switch allows these references to
8886be resolved without error, while leaving the task of adjusting the references
8887themselves (with their non-zero addends) to specialized code provided by the
8888runtime environment. Recent versions of the cygwin and mingw environments and
8889compilers provide this runtime support; older versions do not. However, the
8890support is only necessary on the developer's platform; the compiled result will
69da35b5
NC
8891run without error on an older system.
8892
c0065db7
RM
8893@samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} is not the default; it must be explicitly
8894enabled as needed.
2ca22b03
NC
8895
8896@cindex direct linking to a dll
8897@item direct linking to a dll
8898The cygwin/mingw ports of @command{ld} support the direct linking,
8899including data symbols, to a dll without the usage of any import
69da35b5 8900libraries. This is much faster and uses much less memory than does the
b45619c0 8901traditional import library method, especially when linking large
c0065db7
RM
8902libraries or applications. When @command{ld} creates an import lib, each
8903function or variable exported from the dll is stored in its own bfd, even
8904though a single bfd could contain many exports. The overhead involved in
69da35b5 8905storing, loading, and processing so many bfd's is quite large, and explains the
c0065db7 8906tremendous time, memory, and storage needed to link against particularly
69da35b5
NC
8907large or complex libraries when using import libs.
8908
c0065db7 8909Linking directly to a dll uses no extra command-line switches other than
69da35b5 8910@samp{-L} and @samp{-l}, because @command{ld} already searches for a number
c0065db7 8911of names to match each library. All that is needed from the developer's
69da35b5
NC
8912perspective is an understanding of this search, in order to force ld to
8913select the dll instead of an import library.
8914
2ca22b03 8915
69da35b5
NC
8916For instance, when ld is called with the argument @samp{-lxxx} it will attempt
8917to find, in the first directory of its search path,
2ca22b03
NC
8918
8919@example
45e948fe
NC
8920libxxx.dll.a
8921xxx.dll.a
8922libxxx.a
8923xxx.lib
f6c4d4b1 8924libxxx.lib
69da35b5 8925cygxxx.dll (*)
45e948fe
NC
8926libxxx.dll
8927xxx.dll
2ca22b03
NC
8928@end example
8929
69da35b5
NC
8930before moving on to the next directory in the search path.
8931
c0065db7
RM
8932(*) Actually, this is not @samp{cygxxx.dll} but in fact is @samp{<prefix>xxx.dll},
8933where @samp{<prefix>} is set by the @command{ld} option
8934@samp{--dll-search-prefix=<prefix>}. In the case of cygwin, the standard gcc spec
8935file includes @samp{--dll-search-prefix=cyg}, so in effect we actually search for
69da35b5
NC
8936@samp{cygxxx.dll}.
8937
c0065db7
RM
8938Other win32-based unix environments, such as mingw or pw32, may use other
8939@samp{<prefix>}es, although at present only cygwin makes use of this feature. It
69da35b5
NC
8940was originally intended to help avoid name conflicts among dll's built for the
8941various win32/un*x environments, so that (for example) two versions of a zlib dll
8942could coexist on the same machine.
8943
2ca22b03
NC
8944The generic cygwin/mingw path layout uses a @samp{bin} directory for
8945applications and dll's and a @samp{lib} directory for the import
69da35b5 8946libraries (using cygwin nomenclature):
2ca22b03
NC
8947
8948@example
8949bin/
8950 cygxxx.dll
8951lib/
8952 libxxx.dll.a (in case of dll's)
c0065db7 8953 libxxx.a (in case of static archive)
2ca22b03
NC
8954@end example
8955
c0065db7
RM
8956Linking directly to a dll without using the import library can be
8957done two ways:
2ca22b03
NC
8958
89591. Use the dll directly by adding the @samp{bin} path to the link line
8960@example
8961gcc -Wl,-verbose -o a.exe -L../bin/ -lxxx
c0065db7 8962@end example
2ca22b03 8963
69da35b5
NC
8964However, as the dll's often have version numbers appended to their names
8965(@samp{cygncurses-5.dll}) this will often fail, unless one specifies
8966@samp{-L../bin -lncurses-5} to include the version. Import libs are generally
8967not versioned, and do not have this difficulty.
8968
2ca22b03
NC
89692. Create a symbolic link from the dll to a file in the @samp{lib}
8970directory according to the above mentioned search pattern. This
8971should be used to avoid unwanted changes in the tools needed for
8972making the app/dll.
8973
8974@example
8975ln -s bin/cygxxx.dll lib/[cyg|lib|]xxx.dll[.a]
c0065db7 8976@end example
2ca22b03
NC
8977
8978Then you can link without any make environment changes.
8979
8980@example
8981gcc -Wl,-verbose -o a.exe -L../lib/ -lxxx
c0065db7 8982@end example
69da35b5
NC
8983
8984This technique also avoids the version number problems, because the following is
8985perfectly legal
8986
8987@example
8988bin/
8989 cygxxx-5.dll
8990lib/
c0065db7 8991 libxxx.dll.a -> ../bin/cygxxx-5.dll
69da35b5
NC
8992@end example
8993
dc8465bf 8994Linking directly to a dll without using an import lib will work
69da35b5
NC
8995even when auto-import features are exercised, and even when
8996@samp{--enable-runtime-pseudo-relocs} is used.
8997
8998Given the improvements in speed and memory usage, one might justifiably
45e948fe 8999wonder why import libraries are used at all. There are three reasons:
69da35b5
NC
9000
90011. Until recently, the link-directly-to-dll functionality did @emph{not}
9002work with auto-imported data.
9003
dc8465bf
NC
90042. Sometimes it is necessary to include pure static objects within the
9005import library (which otherwise contains only bfd's for indirection
9006symbols that point to the exports of a dll). Again, the import lib
9007for the cygwin kernel makes use of this ability, and it is not
9008possible to do this without an import lib.
69da35b5 9009
45e948fe
NC
90103. Symbol aliases can only be resolved using an import lib. This is
9011critical when linking against OS-supplied dll's (eg, the win32 API)
9012in which symbols are usually exported as undecorated aliases of their
9013stdcall-decorated assembly names.
9014
69da35b5 9015So, import libs are not going away. But the ability to replace
c0065db7
RM
9016true import libs with a simple symbolic link to (or a copy of)
9017a dll, in many cases, is a useful addition to the suite of tools
9018binutils makes available to the win32 developer. Given the
69da35b5
NC
9019massive improvements in memory requirements during linking, storage
9020requirements, and linking speed, we expect that many developers
9021will soon begin to use this feature whenever possible.
dc8465bf 9022
c0065db7 9023@item symbol aliasing
dc8465bf 9024@table @emph
c0065db7
RM
9025@item adding additional names
9026Sometimes, it is useful to export symbols with additional names.
dc8465bf
NC
9027A symbol @samp{foo} will be exported as @samp{foo}, but it can also be
9028exported as @samp{_foo} by using special directives in the DEF file
9029when creating the dll. This will affect also the optional created
c0065db7 9030import library. Consider the following DEF file:
dc8465bf 9031
c0065db7 9032@example
dc8465bf
NC
9033LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x61000000
9034
9035EXPORTS
c0065db7 9036foo
dc8465bf 9037_foo = foo
c0065db7 9038@end example
dc8465bf
NC
9039
9040The line @samp{_foo = foo} maps the symbol @samp{foo} to @samp{_foo}.
9041
9042Another method for creating a symbol alias is to create it in the
9043source code using the "weak" attribute:
9044
c0065db7
RM
9045@example
9046void foo () @{ /* Do something. */; @}
dc8465bf 9047void _foo () __attribute__ ((weak, alias ("foo")));
c0065db7 9048@end example
dc8465bf
NC
9049
9050See the gcc manual for more information about attributes and weak
9051symbols.
9052
9053@item renaming symbols
9054Sometimes it is useful to rename exports. For instance, the cygwin
c0065db7 9055kernel does this regularly. A symbol @samp{_foo} can be exported as
dc8465bf
NC
9056@samp{foo} but not as @samp{_foo} by using special directives in the
9057DEF file. (This will also affect the import library, if it is
c0065db7 9058created). In the following example:
dc8465bf 9059
c0065db7 9060@example
dc8465bf
NC
9061LIBRARY "xyz.dll" BASE=0x61000000
9062
9063EXPORTS
9064_foo = foo
c0065db7 9065@end example
dc8465bf
NC
9066
9067The line @samp{_foo = foo} maps the exported symbol @samp{foo} to
9068@samp{_foo}.
c0065db7 9069@end table
dc8465bf 9070
0a5d968e 9071Note: using a DEF file disables the default auto-export behavior,
a05a5b64 9072unless the @samp{--export-all-symbols} command-line option is used.
0a5d968e 9073If, however, you are trying to rename symbols, then you should list
c0065db7
RM
9074@emph{all} desired exports in the DEF file, including the symbols
9075that are not being renamed, and do @emph{not} use the
9076@samp{--export-all-symbols} option. If you list only the
9077renamed symbols in the DEF file, and use @samp{--export-all-symbols}
9078to handle the other symbols, then the both the new names @emph{and}
9079the original names for the renamed symbols will be exported.
9080In effect, you'd be aliasing those symbols, not renaming them,
0a5d968e 9081which is probably not what you wanted.
c87db184
CF
9082
9083@cindex weak externals
9084@item weak externals
9085The Windows object format, PE, specifies a form of weak symbols called
9086weak externals. When a weak symbol is linked and the symbol is not
9087defined, the weak symbol becomes an alias for some other symbol. There
9088are three variants of weak externals:
9089@itemize
9090@item Definition is searched for in objects and libraries, historically
9091called lazy externals.
9092@item Definition is searched for only in other objects, not in libraries.
9093This form is not presently implemented.
9094@item No search; the symbol is an alias. This form is not presently
9095implemented.
9096@end itemize
9097As a GNU extension, weak symbols that do not specify an alternate symbol
9098are supported. If the symbol is undefined when linking, the symbol
9099uses a default value.
c1711530
DK
9100
9101@cindex aligned common symbols
9102@item aligned common symbols
9103As a GNU extension to the PE file format, it is possible to specify the
9104desired alignment for a common symbol. This information is conveyed from
9105the assembler or compiler to the linker by means of GNU-specific commands
9106carried in the object file's @samp{.drectve} section, which are recognized
9107by @command{ld} and respected when laying out the common symbols. Native
9108tools will be able to process object files employing this GNU extension,
9109but will fail to respect the alignment instructions, and may issue noisy
9110warnings about unknown linker directives.
5063daf7 9111
2ca22b03
NC
9112@end table
9113
9114@ifclear GENERIC
9115@lowersections
9116@end ifclear
9117@end ifset
9118
e0001a05
NC
9119@ifset XTENSA
9120@ifclear GENERIC
9121@raisesections
9122@end ifclear
9123
9124@node Xtensa
9125@section @code{ld} and Xtensa Processors
9126
9127@cindex Xtensa processors
9128The default @command{ld} behavior for Xtensa processors is to interpret
9129@code{SECTIONS} commands so that lists of explicitly named sections in a
9130specification with a wildcard file will be interleaved when necessary to
9131keep literal pools within the range of PC-relative load offsets. For
9132example, with the command:
9133
9134@smallexample
9135SECTIONS
9136@{
9137 .text : @{
9138 *(.literal .text)
9139 @}
9140@}
9141@end smallexample
9142
9143@noindent
9144@command{ld} may interleave some of the @code{.literal}
9145and @code{.text} sections from different object files to ensure that the
9146literal pools are within the range of PC-relative load offsets. A valid
9147interleaving might place the @code{.literal} sections from an initial
9148group of files followed by the @code{.text} sections of that group of
9149files. Then, the @code{.literal} sections from the rest of the files
9150and the @code{.text} sections from the rest of the files would follow.
e0001a05 9151
43cd72b9 9152@cindex @option{--relax} on Xtensa
e0001a05 9153@cindex relaxing on Xtensa
43cd72b9
BW
9154Relaxation is enabled by default for the Xtensa version of @command{ld} and
9155provides two important link-time optimizations. The first optimization
9156is to combine identical literal values to reduce code size. A redundant
9157literal will be removed and all the @code{L32R} instructions that use it
9158will be changed to reference an identical literal, as long as the
9159location of the replacement literal is within the offset range of all
9160the @code{L32R} instructions. The second optimization is to remove
9161unnecessary overhead from assembler-generated ``longcall'' sequences of
9162@code{L32R}/@code{CALLX@var{n}} when the target functions are within
9163range of direct @code{CALL@var{n}} instructions.
9164
9165For each of these cases where an indirect call sequence can be optimized
9166to a direct call, the linker will change the @code{CALLX@var{n}}
9167instruction to a @code{CALL@var{n}} instruction, remove the @code{L32R}
9168instruction, and remove the literal referenced by the @code{L32R}
9169instruction if it is not used for anything else. Removing the
9170@code{L32R} instruction always reduces code size but can potentially
9171hurt performance by changing the alignment of subsequent branch targets.
9172By default, the linker will always preserve alignments, either by
9173switching some instructions between 24-bit encodings and the equivalent
9174density instructions or by inserting a no-op in place of the @code{L32R}
9175instruction that was removed. If code size is more important than
9176performance, the @option{--size-opt} option can be used to prevent the
9177linker from widening density instructions or inserting no-ops, except in
9178a few cases where no-ops are required for correctness.
9179
9180The following Xtensa-specific command-line options can be used to
9181control the linker:
9182
9183@cindex Xtensa options
9184@table @option
43cd72b9
BW
9185@item --size-opt
9186When optimizing indirect calls to direct calls, optimize for code size
9187more than performance. With this option, the linker will not insert
9188no-ops or widen density instructions to preserve branch target
9189alignment. There may still be some cases where no-ops are required to
9190preserve the correctness of the code.
7a77f1ac
MF
9191
9192@item --abi-windowed
9193@itemx --abi-call0
9194Choose ABI for the output object and for the generated PLT code.
9195PLT code inserted by the linker must match ABI of the output object
9196because windowed and call0 ABI use incompatible function call
9197conventions.
9198Default ABI is chosen by the ABI tag in the @code{.xtensa.info} section
9199of the first input object.
9200A warning is issued if ABI tags of input objects do not match each other
9201or the chosen output object ABI.
43cd72b9 9202@end table
e0001a05
NC
9203
9204@ifclear GENERIC
9205@lowersections
9206@end ifclear
9207@end ifset
9208
252b5132
RH
9209@ifclear SingleFormat
9210@node BFD
9211@chapter BFD
9212
9213@cindex back end
9214@cindex object file management
9215@cindex object formats available
9216@kindex objdump -i
9217The linker accesses object and archive files using the BFD libraries.
9218These libraries allow the linker to use the same routines to operate on
9219object files whatever the object file format. A different object file
9220format can be supported simply by creating a new BFD back end and adding
9221it to the library. To conserve runtime memory, however, the linker and
9222associated tools are usually configured to support only a subset of the
9223object file formats available. You can use @code{objdump -i}
9224(@pxref{objdump,,objdump,binutils.info,The GNU Binary Utilities}) to
9225list all the formats available for your configuration.
9226
9227@cindex BFD requirements
9228@cindex requirements for BFD
9229As with most implementations, BFD is a compromise between
9230several conflicting requirements. The major factor influencing
9231BFD design was efficiency: any time used converting between
9232formats is time which would not have been spent had BFD not
9233been involved. This is partly offset by abstraction payback; since
9234BFD simplifies applications and back ends, more time and care
9235may be spent optimizing algorithms for a greater speed.
9236
9237One minor artifact of the BFD solution which you should bear in
9238mind is the potential for information loss. There are two places where
9239useful information can be lost using the BFD mechanism: during
9240conversion and during output. @xref{BFD information loss}.
9241
9242@menu
9243* BFD outline:: How it works: an outline of BFD
9244@end menu
9245
9246@node BFD outline
36f63dca 9247@section How It Works: An Outline of BFD
252b5132
RH
9248@cindex opening object files
9249@include bfdsumm.texi
9250@end ifclear
9251
9252@node Reporting Bugs
9253@chapter Reporting Bugs
ff5dcc92
SC
9254@cindex bugs in @command{ld}
9255@cindex reporting bugs in @command{ld}
252b5132 9256
ff5dcc92 9257Your bug reports play an essential role in making @command{ld} reliable.
252b5132
RH
9258
9259Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or
9260it may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is
ff5dcc92 9261to help the entire community by making the next version of @command{ld}
252b5132 9262work better. Bug reports are your contribution to the maintenance of
ff5dcc92 9263@command{ld}.
252b5132
RH
9264
9265In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
9266information that enables us to fix the bug.
9267
9268@menu
9269* Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
9270* Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
9271@end menu
9272
9273@node Bug Criteria
36f63dca 9274@section Have You Found a Bug?
252b5132
RH
9275@cindex bug criteria
9276
9277If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
9278
9279@itemize @bullet
9280@cindex fatal signal
9281@cindex linker crash
9282@cindex crash of linker
9283@item
9284If the linker gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
ff5dcc92 9285@command{ld} bug. Reliable linkers never crash.
252b5132
RH
9286
9287@cindex error on valid input
9288@item
ff5dcc92 9289If @command{ld} produces an error message for valid input, that is a bug.
252b5132
RH
9290
9291@cindex invalid input
9292@item
ff5dcc92 9293If @command{ld} does not produce an error message for invalid input, that
252b5132
RH
9294may be a bug. In the general case, the linker can not verify that
9295object files are correct.
9296
9297@item
9298If you are an experienced user of linkers, your suggestions for
ff5dcc92 9299improvement of @command{ld} are welcome in any case.
252b5132
RH
9300@end itemize
9301
9302@node Bug Reporting
36f63dca 9303@section How to Report Bugs
252b5132 9304@cindex bug reports
ff5dcc92 9305@cindex @command{ld} bugs, reporting
252b5132
RH
9306
9307A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu}
ff5dcc92 9308products. If you obtained @command{ld} from a support organization, we
252b5132
RH
9309recommend you contact that organization first.
9310
9311You can find contact information for many support companies and
9312individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
9313distribution.
9314
ad22bfe8 9315@ifset BUGURL
ff5dcc92 9316Otherwise, send bug reports for @command{ld} to
ad22bfe8
JM
9317@value{BUGURL}.
9318@end ifset
252b5132
RH
9319
9320The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
9321@strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
9322fact or leave it out, state it!
9323
9324Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
9325problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
b553b183
NC
9326assume that the name of a symbol you use in an example does not
9327matter. Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps
9328the bug is a stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the
9329location where that name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name
9330were different, the contents of that location would fool the linker
9331into doing the right thing despite the bug. Play it safe and give a
9332specific, complete example. That is the easiest thing for you to do,
c0065db7 9333and the most helpful.
b553b183
NC
9334
9335Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix
9336the bug if it is new to us. Therefore, always write your bug reports
9337on the assumption that the bug has not been reported previously.
252b5132
RH
9338
9339Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
36f63dca
NC
9340bell?'' This cannot help us fix a bug, so it is basically useless. We
9341respond by asking for enough details to enable us to investigate.
9342You might as well expedite matters by sending them to begin with.
252b5132
RH
9343
9344To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
9345
9346@itemize @bullet
9347@item
ff5dcc92 9348The version of @command{ld}. @command{ld} announces it if you start it with
252b5132
RH
9349the @samp{--version} argument.
9350
9351Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
ff5dcc92 9352the bug in the current version of @command{ld}.
252b5132
RH
9353
9354@item
ff5dcc92 9355Any patches you may have applied to the @command{ld} source, including any
252b5132
RH
9356patches made to the @code{BFD} library.
9357
9358@item
9359The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
9360version number.
9361
9362@item
ff5dcc92 9363What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @command{ld}---e.g.
252b5132
RH
9364``@code{gcc-2.7}''.
9365
9366@item
9367The command arguments you gave the linker to link your example and
9368observe the bug. To guarantee you will not omit something important,
9369list them all. A copy of the Makefile (or the output from make) is
9370sufficient.
9371
9372If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
9373and then we might not encounter the bug.
9374
9375@item
9376A complete input file, or set of input files, that will reproduce the
b553b183
NC
9377bug. It is generally most helpful to send the actual object files
9378provided that they are reasonably small. Say no more than 10K. For
9379bigger files you can either make them available by FTP or HTTP or else
9380state that you are willing to send the object file(s) to whomever
9381requests them. (Note - your email will be going to a mailing list, so
9382we do not want to clog it up with large attachments). But small
9383attachments are best.
252b5132
RH
9384
9385If the source files were assembled using @code{gas} or compiled using
9386@code{gcc}, then it may be OK to send the source files rather than the
9387object files. In this case, be sure to say exactly what version of
9388@code{gas} or @code{gcc} was used to produce the object files. Also say
9389how @code{gas} or @code{gcc} were configured.
9390
9391@item
9392A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
9393incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
9394
ff5dcc92 9395Of course, if the bug is that @command{ld} gets a fatal signal, then we
252b5132
RH
9396will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
9397not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
9398a chance to make a mistake.
9399
9400Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
9401say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
b45619c0 9402copy of @command{ld} is out of sync, or you have encountered a bug in the
252b5132
RH
9403C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might crash
9404and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when ours
9405fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for us. If
9406you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able to draw
9407any conclusion from our observations.
9408
9409@item
ff5dcc92 9410If you wish to suggest changes to the @command{ld} source, send us context
252b5132
RH
9411diffs, as generated by @code{diff} with the @samp{-u}, @samp{-c}, or
9412@samp{-p} option. Always send diffs from the old file to the new file.
ff5dcc92 9413If you even discuss something in the @command{ld} source, refer to it by
252b5132
RH
9414context, not by line number.
9415
9416The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
9417sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
9418@end itemize
9419
9420Here are some things that are not necessary:
9421
9422@itemize @bullet
9423@item
9424A description of the envelope of the bug.
9425
9426Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
9427which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
9428changes will not affect it.
9429
9430This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
9431will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
9432with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
9433We recommend that you save your time for something else.
9434
9435Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
9436of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
9437output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
9438less time, and so on.
9439
9440However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
9441report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
9442
9443@item
9444A patch for the bug.
9445
9446A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
9447the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
9448a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
9449to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
9450
ff5dcc92 9451Sometimes with a program as complicated as @command{ld} it is very hard to
252b5132
RH
9452construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
9453through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be
9454able to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is
9455fixed.
9456
9457And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
9458patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
9459help us to understand.
9460
9461@item
9462A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
9463
9464Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
9465things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
9466@end itemize
9467
9468@node MRI
9469@appendix MRI Compatible Script Files
9470@cindex MRI compatibility
ff5dcc92
SC
9471To aid users making the transition to @sc{gnu} @command{ld} from the MRI
9472linker, @command{ld} can use MRI compatible linker scripts as an
252b5132
RH
9473alternative to the more general-purpose linker scripting language
9474described in @ref{Scripts}. MRI compatible linker scripts have a much
9475simpler command set than the scripting language otherwise used with
ff5dcc92 9476@command{ld}. @sc{gnu} @command{ld} supports the most commonly used MRI
252b5132
RH
9477linker commands; these commands are described here.
9478
9479In general, MRI scripts aren't of much use with the @code{a.out} object
9480file format, since it only has three sections and MRI scripts lack some
9481features to make use of them.
9482
9483You can specify a file containing an MRI-compatible script using the
9484@samp{-c} command-line option.
9485
9486Each command in an MRI-compatible script occupies its own line; each
9487command line starts with the keyword that identifies the command (though
9488blank lines are also allowed for punctuation). If a line of an
ff5dcc92 9489MRI-compatible script begins with an unrecognized keyword, @command{ld}
252b5132
RH
9490issues a warning message, but continues processing the script.
9491
9492Lines beginning with @samp{*} are comments.
9493
9494You can write these commands using all upper-case letters, or all
9495lower case; for example, @samp{chip} is the same as @samp{CHIP}.
9496The following list shows only the upper-case form of each command.
9497
9498@table @code
9499@cindex @code{ABSOLUTE} (MRI)
9500@item ABSOLUTE @var{secname}
9501@itemx ABSOLUTE @var{secname}, @var{secname}, @dots{} @var{secname}
ff5dcc92 9502Normally, @command{ld} includes in the output file all sections from all
252b5132
RH
9503the input files. However, in an MRI-compatible script, you can use the
9504@code{ABSOLUTE} command to restrict the sections that will be present in
9505your output program. If the @code{ABSOLUTE} command is used at all in a
9506script, then only the sections named explicitly in @code{ABSOLUTE}
9507commands will appear in the linker output. You can still use other
9508input sections (whatever you select on the command line, or using
9509@code{LOAD}) to resolve addresses in the output file.
9510
9511@cindex @code{ALIAS} (MRI)
9512@item ALIAS @var{out-secname}, @var{in-secname}
9513Use this command to place the data from input section @var{in-secname}
9514in a section called @var{out-secname} in the linker output file.
9515
9516@var{in-secname} may be an integer.
9517
9518@cindex @code{ALIGN} (MRI)
9519@item ALIGN @var{secname} = @var{expression}
9520Align the section called @var{secname} to @var{expression}. The
9521@var{expression} should be a power of two.
9522
9523@cindex @code{BASE} (MRI)
9524@item BASE @var{expression}
9525Use the value of @var{expression} as the lowest address (other than
9526absolute addresses) in the output file.
9527
9528@cindex @code{CHIP} (MRI)
9529@item CHIP @var{expression}
9530@itemx CHIP @var{expression}, @var{expression}
9531This command does nothing; it is accepted only for compatibility.
9532
9533@cindex @code{END} (MRI)
9534@item END
9535This command does nothing whatever; it's only accepted for compatibility.
9536
9537@cindex @code{FORMAT} (MRI)
9538@item FORMAT @var{output-format}
9539Similar to the @code{OUTPUT_FORMAT} command in the more general linker
dc12032b 9540language, but restricted to S-records, if @var{output-format} is @samp{S}
252b5132
RH
9541
9542@cindex @code{LIST} (MRI)
9543@item LIST @var{anything}@dots{}
9544Print (to the standard output file) a link map, as produced by the
ff5dcc92 9545@command{ld} command-line option @samp{-M}.
252b5132
RH
9546
9547The keyword @code{LIST} may be followed by anything on the
9548same line, with no change in its effect.
9549
9550@cindex @code{LOAD} (MRI)
9551@item LOAD @var{filename}
9552@itemx LOAD @var{filename}, @var{filename}, @dots{} @var{filename}
9553Include one or more object file @var{filename} in the link; this has the
ff5dcc92 9554same effect as specifying @var{filename} directly on the @command{ld}
252b5132
RH
9555command line.
9556
9557@cindex @code{NAME} (MRI)
9558@item NAME @var{output-name}
ff5dcc92 9559@var{output-name} is the name for the program produced by @command{ld}; the
252b5132
RH
9560MRI-compatible command @code{NAME} is equivalent to the command-line
9561option @samp{-o} or the general script language command @code{OUTPUT}.
9562
9563@cindex @code{ORDER} (MRI)
9564@item ORDER @var{secname}, @var{secname}, @dots{} @var{secname}
9565@itemx ORDER @var{secname} @var{secname} @var{secname}
ff5dcc92 9566Normally, @command{ld} orders the sections in its output file in the
252b5132
RH
9567order in which they first appear in the input files. In an MRI-compatible
9568script, you can override this ordering with the @code{ORDER} command. The
9569sections you list with @code{ORDER} will appear first in your output
9570file, in the order specified.
9571
9572@cindex @code{PUBLIC} (MRI)
9573@item PUBLIC @var{name}=@var{expression}
9574@itemx PUBLIC @var{name},@var{expression}
9575@itemx PUBLIC @var{name} @var{expression}
9576Supply a value (@var{expression}) for external symbol
9577@var{name} used in the linker input files.
9578
9579@cindex @code{SECT} (MRI)
9580@item SECT @var{secname}, @var{expression}
9581@itemx SECT @var{secname}=@var{expression}
9582@itemx SECT @var{secname} @var{expression}
9583You can use any of these three forms of the @code{SECT} command to
9584specify the start address (@var{expression}) for section @var{secname}.
9585If you have more than one @code{SECT} statement for the same
9586@var{secname}, only the @emph{first} sets the start address.
9587@end table
9588
793c5807
NC
9589@node GNU Free Documentation License
9590@appendix GNU Free Documentation License
36f63dca 9591@include fdl.texi
704c465c 9592
370b66a1
CD
9593@node LD Index
9594@unnumbered LD Index
252b5132
RH
9595
9596@printindex cp
9597
9598@tex
7ca01ed9 9599% I think something like @@colophon should be in texinfo. In the
252b5132
RH
9600% meantime:
9601\long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
9602\centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
9603\centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
9604\centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
9605\centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
9606\centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/} and}
9607\centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
9608\centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
9609\page\colophon
7ca01ed9 9610% Blame: doc@@cygnus.com, 28mar91.
252b5132
RH
9611@end tex
9612
252b5132 9613@bye